f0bfd0eb8f431de99e4b7b9557379653ab98bcdb
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.92"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2018
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .cindex "documentation"
375 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
376 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
377 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
378 capable of showing a change indicator.
379
380 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
381 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
382 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
383 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
384 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
385 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
386 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
387 very wide interest.
388
389 .cindex "books about Exim"
390 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
391 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
392 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
393 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
394
395 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
396 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
397 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
398 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
399
400 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
401 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
402 Debian-specific features in the file
403 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
404 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
405 information.
406
407 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
408 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
409 .cindex "change log"
410 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
411 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
412 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
413 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
414 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
415
416 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
417 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
418 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
419 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
420
421 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
422 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
423
424 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
425 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
426 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
427 directory are:
428
429 .table2 100pt
430 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
431 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
432 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
433 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
434 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
435 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
437 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
438 .endtable
439
440 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
441 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
442 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
443
444
445
446 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
447 .cindex "website"
448 .cindex "FTP site"
449 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
450 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
451 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
452
453 .cindex "wiki"
454 .cindex "FAQ"
455 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
456 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
457 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
458 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
459 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
461 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
462
463 .cindex Bugzilla
464 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
465 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
468
469
470 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
473
474 .table2 140pt
475 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
476 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
477 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
478 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
479 .endtable
480
481 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
486 via this web page:
487 .display
488 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
489 .endd
490 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
491 lists.
492
493 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
494 .cindex "bug reports"
495 .cindex "reporting bugs"
496 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
497 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
498 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
499 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
500
501
502
503 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
504 .cindex "FTP site"
505 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
506 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
507 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
508 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
509 .display
510 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
511 .endd
512 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
513 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
514
515 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
516 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
517 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
518
519 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
520 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
521 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
522 here are top-level directories.
523
524 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
534 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535 .endd
536 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
537 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
538 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
539 most portable to old systems.
540
541 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
542 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
543 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
544 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
545 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
546 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
547 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
548 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
549 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
550 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
551 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
552
553 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
554 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
555 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
556 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
557
558 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
559 .display
560 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
561 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
563 .endd
564 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
565 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
566 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
567
568 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
569 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
570 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
571 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
572 .display
573 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 .endd
578 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
579 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
580
581
582 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
583 .ilist
584 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
585 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
586 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
587 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
588 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
589 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
590 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
591 .next
592 .cindex "domainless addresses"
593 .cindex "address" "without domain"
594 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
595 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
596 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
597 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
598 arrival.
599 .next
600 .cindex "transport" "external"
601 .cindex "external transports"
602 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
603 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
604 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
605 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
606 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
607 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
608 .next
609 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
610 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
611 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
612 other means.
613 .next
614 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
615 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
616 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
617 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
618 a number of common scanners are provided.
619 .endlist
620
621
622 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
623 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
624 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
625 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
626 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
627 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
628
629
630 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
631 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
632 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
633 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
634 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
635 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
636 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
637 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
638 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
639 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
640 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
641 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
642
643 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
644 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
645 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
646 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
647
648
649
650 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
651 .cindex "terminology definitions"
652 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
653 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
654 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
655 below) by a blank line.
656
657 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
658 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
659 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
660 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
661 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
662 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
663 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
664 rise to further bounce messages.
665
666 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
667 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
668 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
669 otherwise.
670
671 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
672 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
673 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
674 until a later time.
675
676 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
677 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
678 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
679
680 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
681 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
682 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
683 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
684 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
685 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
686 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
687 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
688
689 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
690 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
691 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
692 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
693 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
694 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
695 line.
696
697 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
698 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
699 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
700 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
701 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
702
703 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
704 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
705 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
706 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
707 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
708 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
709
710 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
711 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
712 message's envelope.
713
714 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
715 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
716 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
717 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
718 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
719
720 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
721 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
722 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
723 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
724 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
725
726 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
727 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
728 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
729 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
730 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
731 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
732
733
734
735
736
737
738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740
741 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
742 .cindex "incorporated code"
743 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
744 .cindex "PCRE"
745 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
746 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
747
748 .ilist
749 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
750 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
751 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
752 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
753 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
754 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
755 .next
756 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
757 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
758 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
759 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
760 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
761 following statements:
762
763 .blockquote
764 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
765
766 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
767 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
768 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
769 version.
770 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
771 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
772 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
773 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
774 restrictions applied to it).
775 .endblockquote
776 .next
777 .cindex "SPA authentication"
778 .cindex "Samba project"
779 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
780 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
781 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
782 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
783 under the Gnu GPL.
784 .next
785 .cindex "Cyrus"
786 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
787 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
788 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
789 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
790 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
791 conditions expressed therein.
792
793 .blockquote
794 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
795
796 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
797 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
798 are met:
799
800 .olist
801 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
802 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
803 .next
804 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
805 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
806 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
807 distribution.
808 .next
809 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
810 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
811 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
812 details, please contact
813 .display
814 Office of Technology Transfer
815 Carnegie Mellon University
816 5000 Forbes Avenue
817 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
818 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
819 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
820 .endd
821 .next
822 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
823 acknowledgment:
824
825 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
826 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
827
828 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
829 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
830 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
831 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
832 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
833 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
834 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
835 .endlist
836 .endblockquote
837
838 .next
839 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
840 .cindex "X-windows"
841 .cindex "Athena"
842 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
843 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
844 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
845 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
846
847 .blockquote
848 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
849 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
850
851 All Rights Reserved
852
853 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
854 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
855 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
856 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
857 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
858 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
859 software without specific, written prior permission.
860
861 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
862 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
863 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
864 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
865 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
866 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
867 SOFTWARE.
868 .endblockquote
869
870 .next
871 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
872 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
873 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
874 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
875 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
876 source code.
877
878 .next
879 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
880 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
881 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
882 .endlist
883
884
885
886
887
888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890
891 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
892 "Receiving and delivering mail"
893
894
895 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
896 .cindex "design philosophy"
897 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
898 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
899 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
900 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
901 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
902 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
903
904
905 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
906 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
907 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
908 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
909 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
910 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
911 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
912
913 .ilist
914 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
915 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
916 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
917 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
918 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
919 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
920 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
921 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
922 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
923 error code.
924 .next
925 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
926 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
927 .next
928 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
929 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
930 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
931 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
932 .next
933 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
934 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
935 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
936 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
937 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
938 .next
939 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
940 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
941 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
942 .next
943 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
944 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
945 runs at the start of every delivery process.
946 .endlist
947
948
949
950 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
951 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
952 .cindex "Sieve filter"
953 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
954 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
955 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
956 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
957 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
958 of filtering are available:
959
960 .ilist
961 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
962 by RFC 3028.
963 .next
964 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
965 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
966 .endlist
967
968 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
969
970
971
972 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
973 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
974 .cindex "format" "of message id"
975 .cindex "id of message"
976 .cindex "base62"
977 .cindex "base36"
978 .cindex "Darwin"
979 .cindex "Cygwin"
980 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
981 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
982 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
983 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
984 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
985 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
986 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
987 not always case-sensitive.
988
989 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
990 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
991 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
992 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
993 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
994 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
995 somewhat eccentric:
996
997 .ilist
998 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
999 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1000 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1001 way of representing the date and time of day).
1002 .next
1003 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1004 received the message.
1005 .next
1006 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1007 .olist
1008 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1009 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1010 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1011 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1012 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1013 .next
1014 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1015 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1016 (1/100) of a second.
1017 .endlist
1018 .endlist
1019
1020 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1025
1026
1027 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1028 .cindex "receiving mail"
1029 .cindex "message" "reception"
1030 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1031 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1032 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1033 there are several possibilities:
1034
1035 .ilist
1036 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1037 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1038 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1039 .next
1040 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1041 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1042 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1043 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1044 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1045 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1046 .next
1047 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1048 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1049 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1050 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1051 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1052 .next
1053 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1054 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1055 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1056 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1057 .endlist
1058
1059
1060 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1061 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1062 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1063 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1064 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1065 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1066 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1067 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1068 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1069 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1070 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1071 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1072 users to change sender addresses.
1073
1074 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1075 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1076 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1077 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1078 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1079 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1080 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1081
1082 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1083 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1084 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1085 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1086 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1087 message is received.
1088
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1094 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1095 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1096 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1097 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1098 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1099 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1100 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1101
1102 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1103 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1104 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1105 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1106 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1107 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1108 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1109 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1110 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1111 affect file system performance.
1112
1113 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1114 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1115 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1116 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1117 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1118
1119 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1120 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1121 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1122 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1123 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1124 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1125 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1126 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1127 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1128 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1129 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1130 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1131
1132
1133
1134 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1135 .cindex "message" "life of"
1136 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1137 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1138 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1139 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1140 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1141 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1142 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1143
1144 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1145 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1146 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1147 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1148 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1149 to be sent.
1150
1151 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1152 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1153 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1154 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1155 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1156
1157 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1158 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1159 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1160 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1161 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1162 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1163 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1164 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1165 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1166 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1167 systems.
1168
1169 .cindex "journal file"
1170 .cindex "file" "journal"
1171 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1172 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1173 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1174 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1175 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1176 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1177 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1178 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1179
1180 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1181 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1182 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1183 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1184 deliveries caused by crashes.
1185
1186
1187
1188 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1189 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1190 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1192 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1193 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1194 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1195 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1196 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1197
1198 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1199 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1200 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1201 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1202 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1203 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1204 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1205 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1206 the driver's features in general.
1207
1208 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1209 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1210 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1211 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1212 to be bounced.
1213
1214 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1215 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1216 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1217 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1218 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1219 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1220
1221 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1222 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1223 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1224 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1225 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1226 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1227
1228 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1229 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1230 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1231 configuration.
1232
1233 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1234 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1235 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1236 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1237 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1238 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1239 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1240 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1241 configured to fail the address.
1242
1243 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1244 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1245 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1246 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1247 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1248 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1249
1250 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1251 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1252 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1253 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1254 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1255 the address is bounced.
1256
1257
1258
1259 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1260 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1261 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1262 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1263 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1264 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1265 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1266 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1267
1268 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1269 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1270 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1271 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1272 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1273 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1274 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1275 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1276
1277
1278
1279
1280 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1281 .cindex "router" "running details"
1282 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1283 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1284 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1285 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1286 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1287 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1288 the following:
1289
1290 .ilist
1291 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1292 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1293 original address ceases
1294 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1295 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1296 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1297 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1298 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1299 end of routing.
1300
1301 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1302 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1303 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1304 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1305 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1306 .next
1307 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1308 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1309 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1310 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1311 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1312 .next
1313 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1314 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1315 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1316 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1317 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1318 .next
1319 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1320 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1321 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1322 .next
1323 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1324 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1325 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1326 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1327 .next
1328 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1329 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1330 .endlist
1331
1332 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1333 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1334 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1335 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1336 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1337
1338 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1339 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1340 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1341 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1342 facility for this purpose.
1343
1344
1345 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1346 .cindex "case of local parts"
1347 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1348 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1349 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1350 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1351 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1352 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1353 routed addresses are shown.
1354
1355
1356
1357 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1358 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1359 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1360 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1361 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1362 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1363
1364 .ilist
1365 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1403 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1410 .next
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1413 .vindex "&$home$&"
1414 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418 remaining preconditions.
1419 .next
1420 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424 could lead to confusion.
1425 .next
1426 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427 set of addresses that it defines.
1428 .next
1429 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430 specified files is tested.
1431 .next
1432 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1436 .endlist
1437
1438
1439 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1446
1447
1448
1449 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1452
1453 .ilist
1454 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1459 filtering'&.
1460 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1462
1463 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1469 filter.
1470 .next
1471 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1472 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475 processed entirely independently of each other.
1476 .next
1477 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1486 .next
1487 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494 addresses to the same domain.
1495 .next
1496 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1504 .next
1505 .cindex "queue runner"
1506 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1515 .next
1516 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1522 .next
1523 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526 messages to other addresses.
1527 .next
1528 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1531 &'deferred'&.
1532 .next
1533 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1536 .endlist
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544 .cindex "queue runner"
1545 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1551 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552 passed its retry time.
1553 You can run several queue runners at once.
1554
1555 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1560 as permanent.
1561
1562
1563
1564 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1573 also apply.
1574
1575 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1578 deferred,
1579 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1584 one connection.
1585
1586
1587
1588 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1599
1600 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1603 automatically.
1604
1605 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1612 of the list.
1613
1614
1615
1616 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1620 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1631
1632 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1634
1635 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1639
1640 .table2 140pt
1641 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1643 documented"
1644 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1648 instructions"
1649 .endtable
1650
1651 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652 following subdirectories are created:
1653
1654 .table2 140pt
1655 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1662 .endtable
1663
1664 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1665 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666 that may be useful to some sites.
1667
1668
1669 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1675 system.
1676 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680 overridden if necessary.
1681 .cindex compiler requirements
1682 .cindex compiler version
1683 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1684
1685
1686 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687 .cindex "PCRE library"
1688 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1690 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1691 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696 If your operating system has no
1697 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1700
1701 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1708
1709 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1717
1718 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725 Berkeley DB library.
1726
1727 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1729 possibilities:
1730
1731 .olist
1732 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1734 .next
1735 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739 filename is used unmodified.
1740 .next
1741 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1745 .next
1746 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1749 .next
1750 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1752 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1753 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1754 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1755 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1756 page with far newer versions listed.
1757 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1758 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1759 suited to Exim's usage model.
1760 .next
1761 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1762 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1763 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1764 operates on a single file.
1765 .endlist
1766
1767 .cindex "USE_DB"
1768 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1769 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1770 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1771 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1772 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1773 .code
1774 USE_DB=yes
1775 .endd
1776 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1777 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1778
1779 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1780 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1781 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1782 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1783 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1784 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1785
1786 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1787 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1788 in one of these lines:
1789 .code
1790 DBMLIB = -ldb
1791 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1792 .endd
1793 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1794 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1795 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1796 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1797 this example:
1798 .code
1799 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1800 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1801 .endd
1802 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1803 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1804
1805
1806
1807 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1808 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1809 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1810 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1811 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1812 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1813 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1814 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1815 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1816 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1817 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1818 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1819
1820 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1821 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1822 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1823 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1824 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1825 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1826
1827 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1828 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1829 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1830 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1831 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1832 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1833 be logged.
1834
1835 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1836 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1837 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1838 facilities, you need to set
1839 .code
1840 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1841 .endd
1842 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1843 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1844
1845
1846 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1847 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1848 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1849 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1850 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1851 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1852 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1853
1854 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1855 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1856 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1857 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1858 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1859 do this.
1860
1861
1862
1863 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1864 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1865 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1866 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1867 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1868 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1869 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1870 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1871 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1872 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1873
1874 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1875 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1876 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1877 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1878 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1879 .code
1880 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1881 .endd
1882 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1883
1884
1885
1886 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1887 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1888 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1889 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1890 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1891 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1892 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1893 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1894 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1895 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1896 line option).
1897
1898 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1899 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1900 implementing SSL.
1901
1902 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1903 .code
1904 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1905 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1906 .endd
1907 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1908 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1909 .code
1910 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1911 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1912 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1913 .endd
1914 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1915 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1916 .code
1917 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1918 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1919 .endd
1920 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1921 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1922 .code
1923 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1924 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1925 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1926 .endd
1927 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1928 library and include files. For example:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1933 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1934 .endd
1935 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1936 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1937 .code
1938 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1939 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1940 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1941 .endd
1942
1943 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1944 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1945 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1946
1947
1948
1949
1950 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1951
1952 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1953 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1954 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1955 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1956 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1957 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1958 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1959 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1960 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1961 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1962 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1963 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1964 you might have
1965 .code
1966 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1967 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1968 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1969 .endd
1970 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1971 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1972 .code
1973 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1974 .endd
1975 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1976 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1977 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1978 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1979 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1980 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1981 further details.
1982
1983
1984 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1985 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1986 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1987 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1988 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1989 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1990 library files.
1991
1992 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1993 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1994 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1995 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1996 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1997 Exim used to
1998 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1999 withdrawn.
2000
2001
2002
2003 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2004 .cindex "lookup modules"
2005 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2006 .cindex ".so building"
2007 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2008 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2009 on demand.
2010 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2011 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2012 dependencies.
2013 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2014
2015 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2016 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2017 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2018 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2019 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2020 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2021
2022 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2023 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2024 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2025 on demand:
2026 .code
2027 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2028 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2029 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2030 .endd
2031
2032
2033 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2034 .cindex "build directory"
2035 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2036 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2037 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2038 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2039 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2040 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2041 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2042
2043 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2044 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2045 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2046 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2047 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2048 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2049 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2050 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2051
2052 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2053 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2054 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2055
2056
2057
2058 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2059 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2060 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2061 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2062 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2063 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2064 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2065 .code
2066 FULLECHO='' make -e
2067 .endd
2068 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2069 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2070 given in addition to the short output.
2071
2072
2073
2074 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2075 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2076 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2077 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2078 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2079 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2080 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2081 order:
2082 .display
2083 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2084 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2085 &_Local/Makefile_&
2086 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2087 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2088 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2089 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2090 .endd
2091 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2092 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2093 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2094 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2095 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2096 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2097 and are often not needed.
2098
2099 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2100 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2101 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2102 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2103 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2104 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2105 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2106 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2107 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2108
2109
2110 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2111 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2112 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2113 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2114 default values are.
2115
2116
2117 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2118 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2119 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2120 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2121 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2122 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2123 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2124 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2125 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2126 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2127 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2128 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2129 containing the lines
2130 .code
2131 CC=cc
2132 CFLAGS=-std1
2133 .endd
2134 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2135 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2136
2137 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2138 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2139 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2140
2141
2142 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2143 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2144 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2145 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2146 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2147 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2148 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2149 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2150 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2151 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2152 .code
2153 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2154 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2155 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2156 .endd
2157 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2158 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2159 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2160 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2161 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2162 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2163 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2164 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2165 errors.
2166
2167 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2168 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2169 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2170 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2171 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2172 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2173 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2174 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2175 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2176 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2177 syntax. For instance:
2178 .code
2179 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2180 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2181 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2182 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2183 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2184 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2185 .endd
2186
2187 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2188 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2189 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2190 .code
2191 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2192 .endd
2193 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2194 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2195
2196 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2197 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2198 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2199 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2200 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2201 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2202 .code
2203 X11=/usr/X11R6
2204 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2205 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2206 .endd
2207 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2208 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2209 .code
2210 X11=/usr/openwin
2211 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2212 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2213 .endd
2214 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2215 definition of all three of these variables into your
2216 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2217
2218 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2219 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2220 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2221 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2222 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2223
2224 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2225 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2226 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2227 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2228 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2229 libraries.
2230
2231 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2232 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2233 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2234 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2235 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2236
2237
2238 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2239 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2240 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2241 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2242 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2243 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2244 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2245 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2246
2247
2248
2249 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2250 .cindex "building Eximon"
2251 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2252 where the files that are involved are
2253 .display
2254 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2256 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2257 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2258 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2259 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2260 .endd
2261 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2262 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2263 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2264 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2265 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2266 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2267 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2268 .ecindex IIDbuex
2269
2270
2271 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2272 .cindex "installing Exim"
2273 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2274 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2275 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2276 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2277 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2278 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2279 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2280 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2281 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2282 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2283 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2284 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2285
2286 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2287 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2288 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2289 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2290 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2291 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2292 alternative files, no default is installed.
2293
2294 .cindex "system aliases file"
2295 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2296 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2297 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2298 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2299 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2300 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2301 and outputs a comment to the user.
2302
2303 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2304 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2305 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2306 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2307 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2308
2309 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2310 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2311 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2312 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2313 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2314 over SMTP.
2315
2316 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2317 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2318 command such as
2319 .code
2320 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2321 .endd
2322 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2323 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2324 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2325 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2326 but this usage is deprecated.
2327
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2329 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2330 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2331 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2332 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2333 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2334
2335 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2336 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2337 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2338 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2339 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2340 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2341 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2342
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2344 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2345 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2346 command:
2347 .code
2348 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2349 .endd
2350 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2351 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2352 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2353 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2354 command:
2355 .code
2356 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2357 .endd
2358 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2359 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2360
2361 .ilist
2362 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2363 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2364 .next
2365 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2366 installed binary.
2367 .endlist
2368
2369 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2370 .code
2371 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2372 .endd
2373 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2374 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2375 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2376 .code
2377 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2378 .endd
2379
2380
2381
2382 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2383 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2384 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2385 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2386 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2387 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2388
2389 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2390 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2391 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2392
2393
2394
2395 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2396 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2397 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2398 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2399 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2400 necessary.
2401
2402
2403
2404
2405 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2406 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2407 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2408 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2409 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2410 .code
2411 exim -bV
2412 .endd
2413 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2414 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2415 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2416 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2417 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2418 example,
2419 .display
2420 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2421 .endd
2422 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2423 .display
2424 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2425 .endd
2426 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2427 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2428 user agent. For example:
2429 .code
2430 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2431 From: user@your.domain.example
2432 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2433 Subject: Testing Exim
2434
2435 This is a test message.
2436 ^D
2437 .endd
2438 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2439 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2440 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2441
2442 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2443 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2444 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2445 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2446 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2447 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2448 .display
2449 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2450 .endd
2451 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2452 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2453 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2454 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2455 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2456
2457 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2458 .cindex "lock files"
2459 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2460 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2461 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2462 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2463 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2464 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2465 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2466 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2467 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2468 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2469 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2470 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2471
2472 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2473 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2474 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2475 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2476 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2477 incoming SMTP mail.
2478
2479 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2480 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2481 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2482 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2483 production version.
2484
2485
2486 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2487 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2488 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2489 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2490 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2491 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2492 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2493 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2494 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2495 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2496 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2497 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2498 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2499
2500 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2501 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2502 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2503 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2504 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2505 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2506 as follows:
2507 .code
2508 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2509 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2510 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2511 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2512 .endd
2513 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2514 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2515 favourite user agent.
2516
2517 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2518 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2519 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2520 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2521 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2522 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2523
2524
2525
2526 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2527 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2528 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2529 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2530 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2531 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2532 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2533 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2534 configuration file.
2535
2536
2537
2538
2539 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2540 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2541 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2542 .code
2543 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2544 .endd
2545 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2546 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2547 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2548 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2549 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2550 .code
2551 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2552 .endd
2553 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2554
2555 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2556 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2557 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2558
2559
2560
2561
2562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2564
2565 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2566 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2567 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2568 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2569 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2570 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2571 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2572 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2573 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2574
2575
2576 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2577 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2578 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2579 were present before any other options.
2580 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2581 standard output.
2582 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2583 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2584 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2585
2586 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2587 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2588 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2589 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2590 format.
2591
2592 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2593 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2594 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2595 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2596
2597 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2598 .cindex "queue runner"
2599 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2600 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2601 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2602
2603 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2604 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2605 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2606 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2607 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2608 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2609 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2610 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2611
2612
2613 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2614 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2615 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2616 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2617 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2618 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2619
2620 .ilist
2621 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2622 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2623 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2624 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2625 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2626 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2627
2628 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2629 .cindex "envelope sender"
2630 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2631 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2632 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2633 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2634 users to set envelope senders.
2635
2636 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2637 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2638 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2639 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2640 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2641 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2642 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2643
2644 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2645 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2646 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2647 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2648 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2649 that are available to trusted users.
2650 .next
2651 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2652 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2653 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2654 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2655 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2656
2657 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2658 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2659 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2660 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2661
2662 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2663 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2664 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2665 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2666
2667 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2668 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2669 false.
2670 .endlist
2671
2672
2673 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2674 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2675 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2676 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2677
2678
2679
2680
2681 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2682 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2683 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2684 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2685 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2686 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2687 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2688 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2689
2690 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2691 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2692 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2693 . creates a man page for the options.
2694 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2695
2696 .literal xml
2697 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2698 .literal off
2699
2700
2701 .vlist
2702 .vitem &%--%&
2703 .oindex "--"
2704 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2705 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2706 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2707 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2708
2709 .vitem &%--help%&
2710 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2711 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2712 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2713 no arguments.
2714
2715 .vitem &%--version%&
2716 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2717 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2718 displayed.
2719
2720 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2721 &%-Am%&
2722 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2723 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2724 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2725 ignored by Exim.
2726
2727 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2728 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2729 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2730 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2731 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2732 clean; it ignores this option.
2733
2734 .vitem &%-bd%&
2735 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2736 .cindex "daemon"
2737 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2738 .cindex "queue runner"
2739 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2740 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2741 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2742
2743 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2744 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2745 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2746 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2747
2748 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2749 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2750 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2751 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2752
2753 When a listening daemon
2754 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2755 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2756 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2757 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2758 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2759 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2760 running as root.
2761
2762 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2763 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2764 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2765
2766 The SIGHUP signal
2767 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2768 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2769 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2770 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2771 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2772 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2773 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2774 because these are reread each time they are used.
2775
2776 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2777 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2778 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2779 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2780
2781 .vitem &%-be%&
2782 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2783 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2784 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2785 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2786 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2787 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2788 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2789
2790 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2791 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2792 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2793 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2794 test data. A line history is supported.
2795
2796 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2797 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2798 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2799 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2800 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2801 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2802 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2803
2804 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2805 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2806 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2807 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2808
2809 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2810 defined and macros will be expanded.
2811 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2812 available to admin users.
2813
2814 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2815 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2816 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2817 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2818 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2819 of a file. For example:
2820 .code
2821 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2822 .endd
2823 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2824 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2825 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2826 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2827 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2828 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2829 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2830 &%-be%&).
2831
2832 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2833 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2834 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2835 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2836 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2837 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2838 system filters are recognized.
2839
2840 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2841 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2842 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2843 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2844 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2845 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2846 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2847 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2848 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2849 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2850 supplied.
2851
2852 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2853 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2854 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2855 .code
2856 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2857 .endd
2858 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2859 variables that are used by the user filter.
2860
2861 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2862 .code
2863 # Exim filter
2864 # Sieve filter
2865 .endd
2866 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2867 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2868 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2869 redirection lists.
2870
2871 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2872 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2873 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2874 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2875
2876 When testing a filter file,
2877 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2878 .cindex "envelope sender"
2879 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2880 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2881 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2882 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2883 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2884 options).
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2888 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2889 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2890 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2891 &$qualify_domain$&.
2892
2893 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2894 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2895 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2896 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2897 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2898 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2899 actually being delivered.
2900
2901 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2902 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2903 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2904 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2905 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2906 prefix.
2907
2908 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2909 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2910 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2911 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2912 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2913 suffix.
2914
2915 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2916 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2917 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2918 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2919 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2920 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2921 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2922 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2923 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2924 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2925 after a full stop. For example:
2926 .code
2927 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2928 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2929 .endd
2930 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2931 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2932 conversion to the canonical form is
2933 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2934
2935 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2936 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2937 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2938 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2939 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2940
2941 &*Warning 1*&:
2942 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2943 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2944 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2945 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2946 connection.
2947
2948 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2949 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2950 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2951
2952 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2953 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2954 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2955 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2956 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2957 session were authenticated.
2958
2959 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2960 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2961 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2962
2963 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2964 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2965 specialized SMTP test program such as
2966 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2967
2968 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2969 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2970 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2971 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2972 updating the callout cache database.
2973
2974 .vitem &%-bi%&
2975 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2976 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2977 .cindex "building alias file"
2978 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2979 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2980 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2981 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2982 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2983 recognized.
2984
2985 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2986 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2987 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2988 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2989 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2990 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2991 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2992
2993 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2994 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2995 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2996 .cindex "querying exim information"
2997 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2998 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2999 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3000 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3001 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3002
3003 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3004 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3005 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3006 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3007 recognised DSCP names.
3008
3009 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3010 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3011 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3012 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3013 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3014 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3015 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3016 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3017 way to guarantee a correct response.
3018
3019 .vitem &%-bm%&
3020 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3021 .cindex "local message reception"
3022 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3023 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3024 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3025 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3026 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3027 if no other conflicting option is present.
3028
3029 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3030 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3031 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3032 suppressing this for special cases.
3033
3034 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3035 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3036
3037 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3038 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3039 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3040
3041 The format
3042 .cindex "message" "format"
3043 .cindex "format" "message"
3044 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3045 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3046 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3047 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3048 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3049 .code
3050 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3051 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3052 .endd
3053 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3054 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3055 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3056 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3057 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3058
3059 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3060 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3061 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3062 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3063 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3064
3065 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3066 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3067 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3068 .cindex "malware scan test"
3069 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3070 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3071 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3072 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3073 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3074 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3075 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3076
3077 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3078 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3079 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3080 This option requires admin privileges.
3081
3082 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3083 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3084 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3085
3086 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3087 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3088 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3089 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3090 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3091 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3092 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3093 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3094 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3095
3096 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3097 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3098 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3099 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3100 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3101
3102 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3103 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3104 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3105 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3106
3107
3108 .vitem &%-bP%&
3109 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3110 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3111 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3112 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3113 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3114 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3115 arguments, for example:
3116 .code
3117 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3118 .endd
3119 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3120 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3121 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3122 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3123 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3124 users, the output is as in this example:
3125 .code
3126 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3127 .endd
3128 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3129 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3130
3131 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3132 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3133 backward compatibility.)
3134 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3135 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3136
3137 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3138 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3139 name will not be output.
3140
3141 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3142 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3143 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3144 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3145 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3146 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3147 written directly into the spool directory.
3148
3149 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3150 .code
3151 exim -bP +local_domains
3152 .endd
3153 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3154 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3155
3156 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3157 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3158 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3159 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3160 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3161 that driver are output. For example:
3162 .code
3163 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3164 .endd
3165 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3166 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3167 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3168 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3169 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3170 &%authenticators%&.
3171
3172 .cindex "environment"
3173 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3174 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3175 variables.
3176
3177 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3178 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3179 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3180 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3181 The output format is one item per line.
3182 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3183 the exit status will be nonzero.
3184
3185 .vitem &%-bp%&
3186 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3187 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3188 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3189 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3190 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3191 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3192 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3193 to allow any user to see the queue.
3194
3195 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3196 .code
3197 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3198 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3199 <other addresses>
3200 .endd
3201 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3202 .cindex "size" "of message"
3203 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3204 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3205 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3206 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3207 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3208 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3209 before the sender address.
3210
3211 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3212 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3213 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3214
3215 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3216 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3217 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3218 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3219 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3220 complete.
3221
3222
3223 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3224 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3225 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3226 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3227 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3228 of just &"D"&.
3229
3230
3231 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3232 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3233 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3234 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3235 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3236 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3237
3238
3239 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3240 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3241 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3242 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3243 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3244 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3245
3246 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3247 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3248 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3249
3250 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3251 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3252 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3253
3254
3255 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3256 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3257 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3258 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3259 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3260 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3261
3262
3263 .vitem &%-brt%&
3264 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3265 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3266 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3267 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3268 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3269 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3270 .code
3271 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3272 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3273 .endd
3274 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3275 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3276 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3277 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3278 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3279 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3280 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3281 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3282 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3283 .code
3284 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3285 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3286 .endd
3287
3288 .vitem &%-brw%&
3289 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3290 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3291 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3292 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3293 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3294 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3295 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3296 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3297
3298 .vitem &%-bS%&
3299 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3300 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3301 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3302 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3303 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3304 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3305 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3306 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3307 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3308 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3309
3310 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3311 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3312 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3313
3314 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3315 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3316 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3317 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3318
3319 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3320 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3321 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3322
3323 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3324 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3325 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3326 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3327 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3328
3329 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3330 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3331
3332 .vitem &%-bs%&
3333 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3334 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3335 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3336 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3337 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3338 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3339 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3340 messages to the MTA.
3341
3342 In
3343 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3344 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3345 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3346 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3347 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3348 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3349 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3350
3351 .cindex "inetd"
3352 The
3353 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3354 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3355 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3356 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3357 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3358 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3359 the listening daemon.
3360
3361 .vitem &%-bt%&
3362 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3363 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3364 .cindex "address" "testing"
3365 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3366 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3367 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3368 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3369 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3370
3371 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3372 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3373
3374 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3375 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3376 security issues.
3377
3378 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3379 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3380 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3381 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3382 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3383 program.
3384
3385 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3386 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3387 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3388 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3389
3390 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3391 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3392 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3393 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3394 always shown.
3395
3396 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3397 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3398 message,
3399 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3400 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3401 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3402 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3403 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3404 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3405 doing such tests.
3406
3407 .vitem &%-bV%&
3408 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3409 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3410 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3411 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3412 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3413 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3414 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3415
3416 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3417 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3418 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3419 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3420 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3421 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3422 dynamic testing facilities.
3423
3424 .vitem &%-bv%&
3425 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3426 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3427 .cindex "address" "verification"
3428 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3429 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3430 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3431 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3432 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3433 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3434
3435 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3436 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3437 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3438
3439 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3440 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3441
3442 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3443 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3444 security issues.
3445
3446 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3447 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3448 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3449 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3450 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3451
3452 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3453 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3454 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3455 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3456 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3457 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3458 to succeed.
3459
3460 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3461 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3462 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3463
3464 The
3465 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3466 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3467 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3468 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3469
3470 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3471 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3472 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3473 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3474
3475 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3476 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3477 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3478 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3479 might happen.
3480
3481 .vitem &%-bw%&
3482 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3483 .cindex "daemon"
3484 .cindex "inetd"
3485 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3486 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3487 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3488 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3489
3490 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3491 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3492 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3493 each port only when the first connection is received.
3494
3495 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3496 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3497
3498 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3499 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3500 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3501 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3502 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3503 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3504 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3505 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3506 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3507 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3508 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3509
3510 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3511 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3512 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3513 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3514 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3515 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3516 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3517 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3518 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3519
3520 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3521 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3522 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3523 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3524 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3525 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3526 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3527
3528 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3529 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3530 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3531 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3532 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3533 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3534 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3535
3536 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3537 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3538 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3539 configuration file.
3540
3541 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3542 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3543 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3544 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3545 specified by this option.
3546
3547
3548 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3549 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3550 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3551 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3552 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3553 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3554 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3555 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3556
3557 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3558 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3559 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3560 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3561 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3562 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3563 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3564
3565 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3566 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3567 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3568 synonymous:
3569 .code
3570 exim -DABC ...
3571 exim -DABC= ...
3572 .endd
3573 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3574 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3575 example:
3576 .code
3577 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3578 .endd
3579 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3580 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3581
3582
3583 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3584 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3585 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3586 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3587 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3588 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3589 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3590 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3591 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3592 return code.
3593
3594 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3595 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3596 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3597 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3598 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3599 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3600 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3601 are:
3602 .display
3603 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3604 &`auth `& authenticators
3605 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3606 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3607 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3608 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3609 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3610 &`filter `& filter handling
3611 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3612 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3613 &`ident `& ident lookup
3614 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3615 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3616 &`load `& system load checks
3617 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3618 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3619 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3620 &`memory `& memory handling
3621 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3622 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3623 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3624 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3625 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3626 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3627 &`retry `& retry handling
3628 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3629 &`route `& address routing
3630 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3631 &`tls `& TLS logic
3632 &`transport `& transports
3633 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3634 &`verify `& address verification logic
3635 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3636 .endd
3637 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3638 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3639 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3640 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3641 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3642 turn everything off.
3643
3644 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3645 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3646 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3647 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3648 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3649 rather than stderr.
3650
3651 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3652 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3653 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3654 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3655 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3656 run in parallel.
3657
3658 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3659 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3660 in processing.
3661
3662 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3663 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3664 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3665 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3666 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3667 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3668
3669 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3670 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3671
3672 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3673 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3674 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3675 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3676 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3677 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3678
3679 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3680 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3681 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3682 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3683 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3684
3685 .vitem &%-E%&
3686 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3687 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3688 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3689 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3690 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3691 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3692 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3693 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3694 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3695
3696 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3697 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3698 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3699 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3700 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3701 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3702
3703 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3704 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3705 .cindex "sender" "name"
3706 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3707 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3708 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3709 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3710 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3711 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3712
3713 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3714 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3715 .cindex "sender" "address"
3716 .cindex "address" "sender"
3717 .cindex "trusted users"
3718 .cindex "envelope sender"
3719 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3720 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3721 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3722 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3723 users to use it.
3724
3725 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3726 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3727 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3728 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3729 domain.
3730
3731 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3732 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3733 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3734 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3735 examples of shell commands:
3736 .code
3737 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3738 exim -f "" user@domain
3739 .endd
3740 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3741 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3742 &%-bv%& options.
3743
3744 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3745 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3746 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3747 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3748
3749 White
3750 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3751 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3752 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3753 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3754 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3755 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3756
3757 .vitem &%-G%&
3758 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3759 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3760 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3761 .code
3762 control = suppress_local_fixups
3763 .endd
3764 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3765 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3766 in future.
3767
3768 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3769 this option.
3770
3771 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3772 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3773 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3774 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3775 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3776 headers.)
3777
3778 .vitem &%-i%&
3779 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3780 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3781 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3782 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3783 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3784 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3785 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3786
3787 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3788 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3789 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3790 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3791 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3792 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3793 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3794 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3795
3796 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3797
3798 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3799 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3800 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3801 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3802 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3803 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3804 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3805 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3806 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3807
3808 Retry
3809 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3810 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3811 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3812 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3813 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3814 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3815
3816 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3817 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3818 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3819 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3820
3821 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3822 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3823 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3824 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3825 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3826 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3827 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3828 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3829 can be used only by an admin user.
3830
3831 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3832 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3833 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3834 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3835 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3836 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3837 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3838 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3839 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3840 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3841 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3842
3843 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3844 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3845 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3846 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3847 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3848
3849 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3850 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3851 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3852 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3853 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3854
3855 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3856 .oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3857 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3858 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3859 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3860
3861 .vitem &%-MCK%&
3862 .oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3863 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3864 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3865 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3866
3867 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3868 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3869 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3870 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3871 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3872
3873 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3874 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3875 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3876 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3877 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3878 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3879 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3880 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3881
3882 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3883 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3884 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3885 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3886 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3887 connection.
3888
3889 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3890 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3891 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3892 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3893 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3894
3895 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3896 .oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3897 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3898 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3899 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3900 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3901
3902 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3903 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3904 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3905 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3906 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3907 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3908 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3909 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3910 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3911 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3912 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3913 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3914 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3915 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3916 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3917
3918 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3919 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3920 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3921 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3922 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3923 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3924 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3925 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3926 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3927 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3928
3929 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3930 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3931 .cindex "freezing messages"
3932 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3933 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3934 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3935 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3936 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3937 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3938 user.
3939
3940 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3941 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3942 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3943 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3944 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3945 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3946 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3947 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3948 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3949 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3950 user.
3951
3952 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3953 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3954 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3955 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3956 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3957 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3958 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3959
3960 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3961 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3962 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3963 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3964 .cindex "removing recipients"
3965 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3966 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3967 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3968 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3969 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3970 can be used only by an admin user.
3971
3972 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3973 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3974 .cindex "removing messages"
3975 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3976 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3977 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3978 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3979 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3980 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3981 placed in the queue.
3982
3983 . .new
3984 . .vitem &%-MS%&
3985 . .oindex "&%-MS%&"
3986 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
3987 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
3988 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
3989 . a bounce message.
3990 . .wen
3991
3992 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3993 .oindex "&%-Mset%&"
3994 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3995 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3996 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3997 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3998 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3999 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4000 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4001 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4002 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4003
4004 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4005 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4006 .cindex "thawing messages"
4007 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4008 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4009 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4010 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4011 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4012 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4013 by an admin user.
4014
4015 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4016 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4017 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4018 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4019 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4020 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4021
4022 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4023 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4024 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4025 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4026 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4027 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4028 only by an admin user.
4029
4030 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4031 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4032 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4033 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4034 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4035 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4036 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4037
4038 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4039 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4040 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4041 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4042 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4043 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4044
4045 .vitem &%-m%&
4046 .oindex "&%-m%&"
4047 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4048 treats it that way too.
4049
4050 .vitem &%-N%&
4051 .oindex "&%-N%&"
4052 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4053 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4054 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4055 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4056 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4057 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4058 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4059 than &"=>"&.
4060
4061 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4062 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4063 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4064 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4065 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4066 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4067 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4068 for that message.
4069
4070 .vitem &%-n%&
4071 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4072 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4073 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4074 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4075 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4076
4077 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4078 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4079 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4080 Exim.
4081
4082 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4083 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4084 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4085 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4086 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4087 description above.
4088
4089 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4090 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4091 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4092 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4093 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4094 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4095 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4096 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4097
4098 .vitem &%-odb%&
4099 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4100 .cindex "background delivery"
4101 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4102 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4103 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4104 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4105 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4106 processes to finish.
4107
4108 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4109 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4110 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4111 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4112
4113 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4114 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4115 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4116 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4117
4118 .vitem &%-odf%&
4119 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4120 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4121 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4122 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4123 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4124 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4125 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4126
4127 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4128 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4129 during deliveries.
4130
4131 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4132 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4133
4134 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4135 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4136 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4137 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4138
4139
4140 .vitem &%-odi%&
4141 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4142 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4143 Sendmail.
4144
4145 .vitem &%-odq%&
4146 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4147 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4148 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4149 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4150 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4151 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4152 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4153 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4154 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4155 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4156 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4157 forces queueing.
4158
4159 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4160 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4161 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4162 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4163 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4164 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4165 configuration file is in effect.
4166
4167 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4168 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4169 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4170 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4171 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4172 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4173 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4174 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4175 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4176 &%-qq%& option.
4177
4178 .vitem &%-oee%&
4179 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4180 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4181 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4182 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4183 message.
4184
4185 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4186 Provided
4187 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4188 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4189 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4190 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4191
4192 .vitem &%-oem%&
4193 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4194 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4195 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4196 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4197 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4198 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4199
4200 .vitem &%-oep%&
4201 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4202 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4203 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4204 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4205 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4206 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4207
4208 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4209 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4210 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4211 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4212 effect as &%-oep%&.
4213
4214 .vitem &%-oew%&
4215 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4216 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4217 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4218 effect as &%-oem%&.
4219
4220 .vitem &%-oi%&
4221 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4222 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4223 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4224 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4225 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4226 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4227 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4228
4229 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4230 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4231 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4232
4233 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4234 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4235 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4236 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4237 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4238 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4239 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4240 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4241
4242 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4243 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4244 .code
4245 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4246 .endd
4247 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4248 followed by a colon and the port number:
4249 .code
4250 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4251 .endd
4252 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4253 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4254 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4255 whichever one is last.
4256
4257 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4258 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4259 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4260 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4261 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4262 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4263 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4264 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4265
4266 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4267 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4268 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4269 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4270 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4271 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4272 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4273 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4274
4275 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4276 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4277 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4278 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4279 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4280 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4281 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4282 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4283 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4284 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4285
4286 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4287 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4288 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4289 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4290 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4291 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4292 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4293
4294 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4295 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4296 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4297 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4298 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4299 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4300 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4301 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4302 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4303
4304 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4305 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4306 is sending the bounce.
4307
4308 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4309 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4310 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4311 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4312 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4313 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4314 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4315 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4316 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4317 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4318 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4319 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4320
4321 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4322 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4323 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4324 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4325 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4326 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4327 uses the name it is given.
4328
4329 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4330 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4331 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4332 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4333 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4334 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4335 used, when there is no default.
4336
4337 .vitem &%-om%&
4338 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4339 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4340 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4341 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4342 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4343
4344 .vitem &%-oo%&
4345 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4346 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4347 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4348 whatever that means.
4349
4350 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4351 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4352 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4353 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4354 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4355 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4356 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4357 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4358 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4359
4360 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4361 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4362 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4363 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4364 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4365 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4366 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4367
4368 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4369 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4370 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4371 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4372 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4373 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4374 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4375 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4376
4377 .vitem &%-ov%&
4378 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4379 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4380
4381 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4382 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4383 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4384 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4385 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4386 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4387 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4388 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4389 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4390 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4391
4392 .vitem &%-pd%&
4393 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4394 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4395 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4396 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4397 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4398 needed.
4399
4400 .vitem &%-ps%&
4401 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4402 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4403 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4404 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4405 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4406 started.
4407
4408 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4409 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4410 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4411 .display
4412 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4413 .endd
4414 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4415 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4416 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4417 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4418 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4419 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4420
4421 .vitem &%-q%&
4422 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4423 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4424 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4425 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4426 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4427 and &%-S%& options).
4428
4429 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4430 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4431 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4432 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4433 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4434 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4435 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4436
4437 If
4438 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4439 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4440 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4441 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4442 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4443 proceeding.
4444
4445 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4446 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4447 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4448 this to be repeated periodically.
4449
4450 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4451 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4452 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4453 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4454
4455 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4456 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4457 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4458
4459 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4460 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4461 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4462 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4463
4464 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4465 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4466 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4467 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4468 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4469 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4470 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4471 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4472 transports are run.
4473
4474 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4475 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4476 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4477 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4478 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4479 delivered down a single SMTP
4480 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4481 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4482 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4483 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4484 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4485 intermittently.
4486
4487 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4488 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4489 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4490 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4491 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4492 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4493 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4494
4495 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4496 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4497 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4498 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4499 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4500 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4501 their retry times are tried.
4502
4503 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4504 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4505 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4506 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4507 frozen or not.
4508
4509 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4510 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4511 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4512 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4513 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4514 for later delivery.
4515
4516 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4517 .oindex "&%-qG%&"
4518 .cindex queue named
4519 .cindex "named queues"
4520 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4521 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4522 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4523 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4524 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4525 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4526
4527 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4528 will specify a queue to operate on.
4529 For example:
4530 .code
4531 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4532 mailq -qGquarantine
4533 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4534 .endd
4535
4536 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4537 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4538 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4539 starting message id. For example:
4540 .code
4541 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4542 .endd
4543 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4544 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4545 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4546 .code
4547 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4548 .endd
4549 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4550 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4551 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4552 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4553 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4554 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4555
4556 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4557 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4558 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4559 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4560 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4561 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4562 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4563 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4564 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4565 .code
4566 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4567 .endd
4568 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4569 process every 30 minutes.
4570
4571 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4572 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4573
4574 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4575 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4576 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4577 compatibility.
4578
4579 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4580 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4581 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4582
4583 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4584 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4585 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4586 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4587 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4588 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4589 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4590 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4591 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4592
4593 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4594 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4595 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4596 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4597 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4598 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4599
4600 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4601 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4602 .code
4603 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4604 .endd
4605 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4606 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4607 applied to each queue run.
4608
4609 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4610 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4611 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4612 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4613 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4614 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4615 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4616 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4617 address will be skipped.
4618
4619 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4620 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4621 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4622 &'ff'& is present.
4623
4624 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4625 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4626 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4627 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4628 an arbitrary command instead.
4629
4630 .vitem &%-r%&
4631 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4632 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4633
4634 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4635 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4636 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4637 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4638 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4639 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4640 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4641 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4642
4643 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4644 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4645 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4646 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4647 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4648
4649 .vitem &%-t%&
4650 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4651 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4652 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4653 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4654 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4655 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4656 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4657 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4658 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4659 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4660
4661 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4662 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4663 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4664 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4665 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4666 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4667 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4668 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4669 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4670 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4671 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4672
4673 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4674 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4675 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4676 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4677 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4678 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4679
4680 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4681 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4682 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4683 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4684 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4685 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4686 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4687 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4688 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4689
4690 .vitem &%-ti%&
4691 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4692 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4693 compatibility with Sendmail.
4694
4695 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4696 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4697 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4698 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4699 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4700 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4701 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4702 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4703
4704
4705 .vitem &%-U%&
4706 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4707 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4708 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4709 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4710 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4711 set. Exim ignores this option.
4712
4713 .vitem &%-v%&
4714 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4715 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4716 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4717 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4718 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4719 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4720 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4721 unconditional.
4722
4723 .vitem &%-x%&
4724 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4725 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4726 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4727 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4728 this option.
4729
4730 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4731 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4732 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4733 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4734
4735 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4736 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4737 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4738 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4739 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4740 under most shells.
4741 .endlist
4742
4743 .ecindex IIDclo1
4744 .ecindex IIDclo2
4745
4746
4747 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4748 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4749 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4750 . creates a man page for the options.
4751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4752
4753 .literal xml
4754 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4755 .literal off
4756
4757
4758
4759
4760
4761 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4762 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4763
4764
4765 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4766 "The runtime configuration file"
4767
4768 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4769 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4770 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4771 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4772 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4773 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4774 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4775 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4776 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4777 control.
4778
4779 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4780 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4781 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4782 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4783 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4784 actually alter the string.
4785
4786 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4787 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4788 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4789 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4790 existing file in the list.
4791
4792 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4793 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4794 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4795 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4796 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4797 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4798 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4799 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4800 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4801 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4802 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4803
4804 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4805 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4806 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4807 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4808 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4809
4810 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4811 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4812 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4813 compromise the Exim user account.
4814
4815 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4816 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4817 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4818 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4819 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4820 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4821 configuration.
4822
4823
4824
4825 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4826 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4827 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4828 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4829 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4830 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4831 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4832 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4833 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4834 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4835 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4836
4837 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4838 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4839 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4840 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4841 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4842 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4843 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4844 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4845 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4846 &%-M%&).
4847
4848 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4849 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4850 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4851 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4852 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4853
4854 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4855 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4856 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4857 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4858 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4859 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4860
4861 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4862 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4863 necessarily be discarded.
4864 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4865 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4866 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4867 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4868 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4869 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4870
4871 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4872 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4873 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4874 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4875 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4876 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4877 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4878
4879 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4880 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4881 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4882
4883
4884
4885 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4886 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4887 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4888 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4889 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4890 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4891 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4892 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4893
4894 .ilist
4895 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4896 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4897 .next
4898 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4899 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4900 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4901 .next
4902 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4903 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4904 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4905 .next
4906 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4907 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4908 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4909 .next
4910 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4911 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4912 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4913 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4914 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4915 .next
4916 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4917 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4918 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4919 .next
4920 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4921 want to use this feature, you must set
4922 .code
4923 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4924 .endd
4925 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4926 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4927 .endlist
4928
4929 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4930 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4931 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4932 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4933
4934 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4935 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4936 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4937 and does not introduce a comment.
4938
4939 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4940 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4941 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4942 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4943 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4944
4945 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4946 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4947 change settings as required.
4948
4949 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4950 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4951 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4952 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4953 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4954 described.
4955
4956
4957
4958 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4959 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4960 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4961 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4962 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4963 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
4964 using this syntax:
4965 .display
4966 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
4967 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
4968 .endd
4969 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
4970 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4971 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4972 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4973 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
4974 is required.
4975
4976 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4977 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4978 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4979 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4980
4981 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4982 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4983 for example:
4984 .code
4985 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4986 .include /some/file
4987 .endd
4988 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4989 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4990 inclusion appears.
4991
4992
4993
4994 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4995 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4996 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4997 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4998 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4999 definition, and must be of the form
5000 .display
5001 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5002 .endd
5003 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5004 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5005 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5006 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5007 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5008
5009 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5010 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5011 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5012
5013 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5014 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5015 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5016 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5017 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5018 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5019 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5020 define
5021 .display
5022 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5023 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5024 .endd
5025 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5026 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5027 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5028 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5029 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5030 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5031
5032
5033 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5034 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5035 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5036 &'='&. For example:
5037 .code
5038 MAC = initial value
5039 ...
5040 MAC == updated value
5041 .endd
5042 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5043 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5044 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5045 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5046 .code
5047 MAC = initial value
5048 ...
5049 MAC == MAC and something added
5050 .endd
5051 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5052 from a number of other files.
5053
5054 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5055 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5056 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5057 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5058 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5059 file to be ignored.
5060
5061
5062
5063 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5064 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5065 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5066 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5067 .code
5068 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5069 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5070 .endd
5071 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5072 .code
5073 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5074 .endd
5075 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5076 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5077 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5078
5079
5080 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5081 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5082 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5083 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5084 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5085 (see below).
5086
5087 The following classes of macros are defined:
5088 .display
5089 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5090 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5091 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5092 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5093 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5094 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5095 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5096 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5097 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5098 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5099 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5100 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5101 .endd
5102
5103 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5104
5105
5106 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5107 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5108 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5109 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5110 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5111 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5112 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5113
5114 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5115 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5116 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5117 line. Thus:
5118 .code
5119 .ifdef AAA
5120 message_size_limit = 50M
5121 .else
5122 message_size_limit = 100M
5123 .endif
5124 .endd
5125 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5126 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5127 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5128 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5129 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5130
5131 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5132 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5133 in this line"& will always be true.
5134
5135 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5136 to clarify complicated nestings.
5137
5138
5139
5140 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5141 .cindex "common option syntax"
5142 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5143 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5144 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5145 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5146 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5147 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5148 space) and then the value. For example:
5149 .code
5150 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5151 .endd
5152 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5153 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5154 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5155 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5156 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5157 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5158 word &"hide"&. For example:
5159 .code
5160 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5161 .endd
5162 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5163 .code
5164 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5165 .endd
5166 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5167 all instances of the same driver.
5168
5169 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5170 that are found in option settings.
5171
5172
5173 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5174 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5175 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5176 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5177 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5178 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5179 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5180 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5181 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5182 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5183 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5184 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5185 .code
5186 queue_only
5187 queue_only = true
5188 .endd
5189 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5190 .code
5191 no_queue_only
5192 queue_only = false
5193 .endd
5194 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5195
5196
5197
5198
5199 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5200 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5201 .cindex "format" "integer"
5202 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5203 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5204 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5205 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5206 hexadecimal number.
5207
5208 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5209 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5210 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5211 When the values
5212 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5213 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5214 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5215 used.
5216
5217
5218 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5219 .cindex "integer format"
5220 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5221 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5222 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5223 Such options are always output in octal.
5224
5225
5226 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5227 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5228 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5229 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5230 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5231
5232
5233
5234 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5235 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5236 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5237 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5238 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5239
5240 .table2 30pt
5241 .irow &%s%& seconds
5242 .irow &%m%& minutes
5243 .irow &%h%& hours
5244 .irow &%d%& days
5245 .irow &%w%& weeks
5246 .endtable
5247
5248 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5249 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5250 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5251
5252
5253
5254 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5255 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5256 .cindex "format" "string"
5257 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5258 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5259 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5260 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5261 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5262 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5263 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5264 therefore equivalent:
5265 .code
5266 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5267 trusted_users = uucp:\
5268 # This comment line is ignored
5269 mail
5270 .endd
5271 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5272 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5273 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5274 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5275 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5276
5277 .table2 100pt
5278 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5279 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5280 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5281 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5282 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5283 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5284 character"
5285 .endtable
5286
5287 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5288 character, that character replaces the pair.
5289
5290 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5291 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5292 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5293 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5294 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5295 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5296
5297
5298 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5299 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5300 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5301 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5302 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5303 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5304 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5305 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5306 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5307 within a quoted configuration string.
5308
5309
5310 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5311 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5312 .cindex "format" "user name"
5313 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5314 .cindex "format" "group name"
5315 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5316 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5317 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5318 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5319
5320
5321 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5322 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5323 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5324 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5325 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5326 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5327 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5328 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5329 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5330 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5331 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5332
5333 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5334 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5335 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5336 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5337 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5338 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5339 example, the list
5340 .code
5341 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5342 .endd
5343 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5344
5345 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5346 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5347 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5348 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5349
5350 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5351 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5352 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5353 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5354 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5355 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5356 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5357 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5358 .code
5359 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5360 .endd
5361 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5362 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5363 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5364
5365 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5366 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5367 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5368 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5369 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5370 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5371 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5372 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5373 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5374 .code
5375 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5376 .endd
5377 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5378 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5379 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5380 the value in quotes. For example:
5381 .code
5382 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5383 .endd
5384 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5385 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5386 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5387 enclosing an empty list item.
5388
5389
5390
5391 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5392 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5393 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5394 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5395 .code
5396 senders = user@domain :
5397 .endd
5398 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5399 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5400 items, the second of which is empty:
5401 .code
5402 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5403 .endd
5404 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5405 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5406 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5407 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5408 .code
5409 senders = :
5410 .endd
5411 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5412 is at the end of the list.
5413
5414
5415
5416
5417 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5418 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5419 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5420 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5421 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5422 a sequence of lines like this:
5423 .display
5424 <&'instance name'&>:
5425 <&'option'&>
5426 ...
5427 <&'option'&>
5428 .endd
5429 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5430 followed by three options settings:
5431 .code
5432 localuser:
5433 driver = accept
5434 check_local_user
5435 transport = local_delivery
5436 .endd
5437 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5438 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5439 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5440 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5441 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5442 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5443
5444 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5445 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5446
5447 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5448 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5449 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5450 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5451 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5452 server.
5453
5454 .cindex "generic options"
5455 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5456 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5457 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5458 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5459 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5460 .cindex "private options"
5461 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5462 they all have default values.
5463
5464 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5465 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5466 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5467
5468 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5469 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5470 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5471 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5472 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5473 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5474 configuration lines:
5475 .code
5476 remote_smtp:
5477 driver = smtp
5478 .endd
5479 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5480 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5481 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5482 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5483 thus:
5484 .code
5485 special_smtp:
5486 driver = smtp
5487 port = 1234
5488 command_timeout = 10s
5489 .endd
5490 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5491 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5492 lines.
5493
5494 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5495 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5496 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5497 option.
5498
5499
5500
5501
5502
5503
5504 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5506
5507 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5508 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5509 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5510 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5511 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5512 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5513 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5514 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5515 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5516 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5517 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5518
5519
5520
5521 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5522 All macros should be defined before any options.
5523
5524 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5525 .code
5526 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5527 .endd
5528 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5529 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5530 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5531 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5532
5533 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5534 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5535 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5536
5537
5538 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5539 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5540 in the file, after the macros.
5541 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5542 .code
5543 # primary_hostname =
5544 .endd
5545 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5546 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5547 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5548 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5549
5550 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5551 .code
5552 domainlist local_domains = @
5553 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5554 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5555 .endd
5556 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5557 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5558 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5559 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5560
5561 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5562 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5563 on the local host.
5564
5565 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5566 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5567 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5568 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5569 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5570 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5571
5572 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5573 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5574 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5575 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5576 domain is permitted.
5577
5578 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5579 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5580 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5581 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5582 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5583 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5584
5585 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5586 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5587 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5588
5589 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5590 .code
5591 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5592 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5593 .endd
5594 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5595 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5596 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5597 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5598 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5599 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5600 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5601 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5602 contents of a message to be checked.
5603
5604 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5605 .code
5606 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5607 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5608 .endd
5609 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5610 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5611 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5612 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5613
5614 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5615 .code
5616 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5617 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5618 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5619 .endd
5620 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5621 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5622 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5623 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5624 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5625 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5626 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5627
5628 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5629 .code
5630 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5631 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5632 .endd
5633 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5634 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5635 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5636 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5637 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5638 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5639 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5640 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5641 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5642 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5643 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5644 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5645 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5646 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5647 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5648 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5649 consequences).
5650 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5651 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5652 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5653 which should be used in preference to 587.
5654 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5655 these ports.
5656 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5657
5658 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5659 .code
5660 # qualify_domain =
5661 # qualify_recipient =
5662 .endd
5663 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5664 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5665 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5666 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5667 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5668 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5669
5670 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5671 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5672 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5673 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5674 .code
5675 # allow_domain_literals
5676 .endd
5677 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5678 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5679 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5680 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5681 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5682 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5683
5684 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5685 .code
5686 never_users = root
5687 .endd
5688 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5689 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5690 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5691 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5692 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5693 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5694 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5695 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5696
5697 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5698 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5699 line,
5700 .code
5701 host_lookup = *
5702 .endd
5703 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5704 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5705 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5706 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5707 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5708 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5709 unreachable.
5710
5711 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5712 1413 (hence their names):
5713 .code
5714 rfc1413_hosts = *
5715 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5716 .endd
5717 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5718 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5719 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5720 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5721 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5722 information, you can change this.
5723
5724 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5725 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5726 .code
5727 prdr_enable = true
5728 .endd
5729
5730 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5731 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5732 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5733 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5734 .code
5735 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5736 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5737 .endd
5738 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5739 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5740
5741 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5742 over the default:
5743 .code
5744 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5745 +tls_certificate_verified
5746 .endd
5747
5748 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5749 .code
5750 # percent_hack_domains =
5751 .endd
5752 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5753 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5754 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5755
5756 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5757 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5758 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5759 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5760 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5761 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5762 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5763 always bounce messages.
5764 .code
5765 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5766 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5767 .endd
5768 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5769 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5770 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5771 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5772 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5773
5774 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5775 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5776 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5777 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5778 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5779 not often needed).
5780 .code
5781 # split_spool_directory = true
5782 .endd
5783
5784 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5785 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5786 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5787 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5788 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5789 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5790 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5791 .code
5792 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5793 .endd
5794
5795 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5796 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5797 that are not 8-bit clean.
5798 .code
5799 # accept_8bitmime = false
5800 .endd
5801
5802 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5803 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5804 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5805 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5806 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5807 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5808 .code
5809 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5810 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5811 .endd
5812
5813
5814 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5815 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5816 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5817 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5818 It starts with the line
5819 .code
5820 begin acl
5821 .endd
5822 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5823 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5824 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5825
5826 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5827 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5828 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5829 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5830 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5831 result of the ACL processing.
5832 .code
5833 acl_check_rcpt:
5834 .endd
5835 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5836 ACL, and names it.
5837 .code
5838 accept hosts = :
5839 .endd
5840 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5841 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5842 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5843 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5844 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5845 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5846
5847 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5848 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5849 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5850 manner.
5851 .code
5852 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5853 domains = +local_domains
5854 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5855
5856 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5857 domains = !+local_domains
5858 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5859 .endd
5860 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5861 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5862 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5863 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5864 in Internet mail addresses.
5865
5866 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5867 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5868 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5869 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5870 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5871 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5872 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5873 policy of being as safe as possible.
5874
5875 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5876 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5877 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5878 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5879 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5880 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5881
5882 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5883 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5884 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5885 have to modify this rule.
5886
5887 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5888 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5889 common convention of local parts constructed as
5890 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5891 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5892 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5893 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5894 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5895 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5896
5897 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5898 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5899 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5900 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5901 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5902 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5903 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5904 .code
5905 accept local_parts = postmaster
5906 domains = +local_domains
5907 .endd
5908 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5909 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5910 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5911 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5912 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5913
5914 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5915 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5916 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5917 .code
5918 require verify = sender
5919 .endd
5920 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5921 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5922 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5923 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5924 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5925 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5926 discusses the details of address verification.
5927 .code
5928 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5929 control = submission
5930 .endd
5931 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5932 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5933 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5934 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5935 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5936 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5937 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5938 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5939 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5940 .code
5941 accept authenticated = *
5942 control = submission
5943 .endd
5944 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5945 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5946 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5947 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5948 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5949 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5950 .code
5951 require message = relay not permitted
5952 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5953 .endd
5954 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5955 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5956 .code
5957 require verify = recipient
5958 .endd
5959 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5960 fails, the address is rejected.
5961 .code
5962 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5963 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5964 # $dnslist_text
5965 # dnslists = black.list.example
5966 #
5967 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5968 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5969 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5970 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5971 .endd
5972 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5973 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5974 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5975 line.
5976 .code
5977 # require verify = csa
5978 .endd
5979 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5980 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5981 records.
5982 .code
5983 accept
5984 .endd
5985 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5986 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5987 .code
5988 acl_check_data:
5989 .endd
5990 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5991 of this ACL are commented out:
5992 .code
5993 # deny malware = *
5994 # message = This message contains a virus \
5995 # ($malware_name).
5996 .endd
5997 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5998 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5999 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6000 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6001 .code
6002 # warn spam = nobody
6003 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6004 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6005 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6006 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6007 .endd
6008 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6009 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6010 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6011 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6012 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6013 whatever the spam score.
6014 .code
6015 accept
6016 .endd
6017 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6018
6019
6020 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6021 .cindex "default" "routers"
6022 .cindex "routers" "default"
6023 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6024 by the line
6025 .code
6026 begin routers
6027 .endd
6028 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6029 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6030 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6031 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6032 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6033 .code
6034 # domain_literal:
6035 # driver = ipliteral
6036 # domains = !+local_domains
6037 # transport = remote_smtp
6038 .endd
6039 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6040 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6041 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6042 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6043 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6044
6045 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6046 macro has been defined, per
6047 .code
6048 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6049 smarthost:
6050 #...
6051 .else
6052 dnslookup:
6053 #...
6054 .endif
6055 .endd
6056
6057 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6058 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6059 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6060 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6061
6062 .code
6063 smarthost:
6064 driver = manualroute
6065 domains = ! +local_domains
6066 transport = smarthost_smtp
6067 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6068 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6069 no_more
6070 .endd
6071 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6072 specified by the line
6073 .code
6074 domains = ! +local_domains
6075 .endd
6076 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6077 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6078 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6079 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6080 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6081 passed on to the following routers.
6082
6083 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6084 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6085 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6086 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6087
6088 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6089 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6090 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6091 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6092 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6093 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6094 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6095
6096 .code
6097 dnslookup:
6098 driver = dnslookup
6099 domains = ! +local_domains
6100 transport = remote_smtp
6101 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6102 no_more
6103 .endd
6104 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6105
6106 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6107 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6108 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6109 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6110 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6111
6112 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6113 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6114 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6115 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6116 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6117 the address fails and is bounced.
6118
6119 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6120 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6121 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6122 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6123 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6124 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6125 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6126 out.
6127 .code
6128 system_aliases:
6129 driver = redirect
6130 allow_fail
6131 allow_defer
6132 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6133 # user = exim
6134 file_transport = address_file
6135 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6136 .endd
6137 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6138 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6139 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6140 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6141 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6142 the next router.
6143
6144 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6145 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6146 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6147 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6148 .code
6149 userforward:
6150 driver = redirect
6151 check_local_user
6152 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6153 # local_part_suffix_optional
6154 file = $home/.forward
6155 # allow_filter
6156 no_verify
6157 no_expn
6158 check_ancestor
6159 file_transport = address_file
6160 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6161 reply_transport = address_reply
6162 .endd
6163 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6164 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6165 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6166 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6167 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6168 namely:
6169 .code
6170 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6171 # local_part_suffix_optional
6172 .endd
6173 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6174 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6175 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6176 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6177 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6178 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6179 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6180
6181 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6182 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6183 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6184 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6185
6186 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6187 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6188 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6189 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6190 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6191 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6192 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6193
6194 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6195 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6196 There are two reasons for doing this:
6197
6198 .olist
6199 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6200 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6201 unnecessary work.
6202 .next
6203 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6204 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6205 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6206 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6207 this time.
6208 .endlist
6209
6210 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6211 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6212 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6213 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6214
6215 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6216 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6217 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6218 .code
6219 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6220 .endd
6221 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6222 transport.
6223 .code
6224 localuser:
6225 driver = accept
6226 check_local_user
6227 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6228 # local_part_suffix_optional
6229 transport = local_delivery
6230 .endd
6231 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6232 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6233 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6234 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6235 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6236
6237
6238 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6239 .cindex "default" "transports"
6240 .cindex "transports" "default"
6241 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6242 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6243 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6244 .code
6245 begin transports
6246 .endd
6247 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6248 .code
6249 remote_smtp:
6250 driver = smtp
6251 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6252 .ifdef _HAVE_DANE
6253 dnssec_request_domains = *
6254 hosts_try_dane = *
6255 .endif
6256 .ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6257 hosts_try_prdr = *
6258 .endif
6259 .endd
6260 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6261 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6262 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6263 with over-long lines. The built-in macro _HAVE_DANE guards configuration
6264 to try to use DNSSEC for all queries and to use DANE for delivery;
6265 see section &<<SECDANE>>& for more details.
6266
6267 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6268 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6269 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6270 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6271
6272 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6273 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6274 usual federated system.
6275
6276 .code
6277 smarthost_smtp:
6278 driver = smtp
6279 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6280 multi_domain
6281 #
6282 .ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6283 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6284 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6285 hosts_require_tls = *
6286 tls_verify_hosts = *
6287 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6288 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6289 # or not:
6290 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6291 #
6292 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6293 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6294 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6295 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6296 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6297 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6298 #
6299 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6300 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6301 .endif
6302 .ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6303 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6304 .endif
6305 .endif
6306 .ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6307 hosts_try_prdr = *
6308 .endif
6309 .endd
6310 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6311 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6312 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6313 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6314 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6315 then no other options are defined.
6316 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6317 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6318 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6319 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6320 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6321 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6322 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6323 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6324 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6325 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6326 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6327
6328 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6329
6330 All other options are defaulted.
6331 .code
6332 local_delivery:
6333 driver = appendfile
6334 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6335 delivery_date_add
6336 envelope_to_add
6337 return_path_add
6338 # group = mail
6339 # mode = 0660
6340 .endd
6341 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6342 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6343 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6344 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6345 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6346 show how this can be done.
6347
6348 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6349 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6350 similarly-named options above.
6351 .code
6352 address_pipe:
6353 driver = pipe
6354 return_output
6355 .endd
6356 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6357 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6358 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6359 be returned to the sender.
6360 .code
6361 address_file:
6362 driver = appendfile
6363 delivery_date_add
6364 envelope_to_add
6365 return_path_add
6366 .endd
6367 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6368 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6369 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6370 .code
6371 address_reply:
6372 driver = autoreply
6373 .endd
6374 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6375 filter files.
6376
6377
6378
6379 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6380 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6381 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6382 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6383 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6384 introduced by the line
6385 .code
6386 begin retry
6387 .endd
6388 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6389 errors:
6390 .code
6391 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6392 .endd
6393 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6394 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6395 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6396 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6397 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6398
6399 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6400 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6401 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6402
6403
6404 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6405 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6406 .code
6407 begin rewrite
6408 .endd
6409 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6410 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6411
6412
6413
6414 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6415 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6416 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6417 .code
6418 begin authenticators
6419 .endd
6420 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6421 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6422 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6423 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6424 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6425 to support most MUA software.
6426
6427 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6428 .code
6429 #PLAIN:
6430 # driver = plaintext
6431 # server_set_id = $auth2
6432 # server_prompts = :
6433 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6434 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6435 .endd
6436 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6437 .code
6438 #LOGIN:
6439 # driver = plaintext
6440 # server_set_id = $auth1
6441 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6442 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6443 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6444 .endd
6445
6446 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6447 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6448 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6449 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6450 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6451 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6452 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6453 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6454
6455 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6456 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6457 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6458 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6459
6460 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6461 usercode and password are in different positions.
6462 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6463
6464 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6465
6466
6467
6468 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6469 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6470
6471 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6472
6473 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6474 .cindex "PCRE"
6475 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6476 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6477 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6478 regular expressions is discussed in
6479 online Perl manpages, in
6480 many Perl reference books, and also in
6481 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6482 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6483 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6484 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6485 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6486
6487 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6488 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6489 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6490 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6491 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6492 case-insensitive.
6493
6494 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6495 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6496 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6497 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6498 .code
6499 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6500 .endd
6501 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6502 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6503 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6504 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6505 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6506 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6507 matched.
6508
6509 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6510 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6511 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6512 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6513 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6514 match anywhere in the subject string.
6515
6516 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6517 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6518 .code
6519 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6520 .endd
6521 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6522 You need to use:
6523 .code
6524 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6525 .endd
6526 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6527 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6528
6529
6530
6531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6532 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6533
6534 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6535 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6536 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6537 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6538 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6539 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6540
6541 .olist
6542 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6543 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6544 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6545 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6546 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6547 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6548 .next
6549 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6550 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6551 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6552 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6553 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6554 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6555 .endlist
6556
6557 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6558 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6559 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6560 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6561 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6562 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6563
6564 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6565 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6566 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6567 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6568 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6569 .code
6570 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6571 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6572 .endd
6573 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6574 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6575 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6576 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6577 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6578 .code
6579 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6580 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6581 .endd
6582 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6583 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6584
6585 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6586 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6587 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6588 .code
6589 domain1:
6590 domain2:
6591 .endd
6592 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6593 matches the list item.
6594
6595 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6596 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6597 .code
6598 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6599 .endd
6600 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6601 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6602 causes a second lookup to occur.
6603
6604 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6605 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6606 lookup is permitted.
6607
6608
6609 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6610 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6611 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6612 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6613
6614 .ilist
6615 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6616 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6617 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6618 .next
6619 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6620 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6621 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6622 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6623 .endlist
6624
6625 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6626 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6627 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6628 .code
6629 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6630 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6631 .endd
6632 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6633 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6634 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6635
6636
6637
6638
6639 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6640 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6641 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6642 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6643
6644 .ilist
6645 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6646 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6647 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6648 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6649 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6650 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6651 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6652 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6653 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6654 .display
6655 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6656 &url(http://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6657 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6658 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6659 .endd
6660 . --- 2018-09-07: corpit.ru http:-only
6661 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6662 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6663 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6664 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6665 .next
6666 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6667 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6668 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6669 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6670 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6671 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6672 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6673
6674 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6675 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6676 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6677 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6678 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6679 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6680 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6681 .next
6682 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6683 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6684 .cindex "sasldb2"
6685 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6686 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6687 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6688 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6689 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6690 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6691 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6692 .next
6693 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6694 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6695 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6696 .cindex "Courier"
6697 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6698 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6699 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6700 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6701 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6702 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6703 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6704 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6705 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6706 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6707 .next
6708 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6709 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6710 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6711 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6712 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6713 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6714 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6715 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6716 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6717 .next
6718 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6719 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6720 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6721 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6722 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6723 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6724 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6725 .code
6726 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6727 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6728 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6729 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6730 .endd
6731 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6732 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6733 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6734 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6735 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6736
6737 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6738 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6739 lookup types support only literal keys.
6740
6741 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6742 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6743 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6744
6745 .new
6746 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6747 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6748 notation before executing the lookup.)
6749 .wen
6750 .next
6751 .new
6752 .cindex lookup json
6753 .cindex json "lookup type"
6754 .cindex JSON expansions
6755 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6756 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6757 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6758 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6759 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6760 of the JSON structure.
6761 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6762 nunbered array element is selected.
6763 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6764 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6765 or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6766 is returned.
6767 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6768 .wen
6769 .next
6770 .cindex "linear search"
6771 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6772 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6773 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6774 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6775 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6776 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6777 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6778 in the file is used.
6779
6780 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6781 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6782 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6783 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6784 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6785 colon, for example:
6786 .code
6787 baduser: :fail:
6788 .endd
6789 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6790 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6791 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6792 wildcarding of any kind.
6793
6794 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6795 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6796 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6797 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6798 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6799 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6800 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6801 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6802 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6803
6804 .next
6805 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6806 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6807 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6808 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6809 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6810 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6811 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6812 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6813
6814 .next
6815 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6816 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6817 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6818 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6819 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6820 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6821 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6822 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6823 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6824
6825 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6826 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6827 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6828 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6829
6830 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6831 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6832
6833 .olist
6834 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6835 .code
6836 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6837 *fish data for anythingfish
6838 .endd
6839 .next
6840 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6841 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6842 .code
6843 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6844 .endd
6845 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6846 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6847 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6848 .code
6849 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6850 .endd
6851 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6852 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6853 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6854 .code
6855 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6856 .endd
6857
6858 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6859 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6860 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6861 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6862 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6863
6864 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6865 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6866 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6867 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6868 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6869
6870 .next
6871 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6872 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6873 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6874 example:
6875 .code
6876 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6877 .endd
6878 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6879 .endlist olist
6880
6881 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6882 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6883 be followed by optional colons.
6884
6885 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6886 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6887 lookup types support only literal keys.
6888
6889 .next
6890 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6891 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6892 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6893 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6894 .endlist ilist
6895
6896
6897 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6898 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6899 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6900 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6901 many of them are given in later sections.
6902
6903 .ilist
6904 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6905 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6906 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6907 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6908 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6909 .next
6910 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6911 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6912 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6913 .next
6914 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6915 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6916 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6917 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6918 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6919 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6920 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6921 .next
6922 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6923 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6924 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6925 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6926 .next
6927 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6928 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6929 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6930 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6931 .next
6932 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6933 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6934 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6935 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6936 .next
6937 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6938 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6939 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6940 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6941 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6942 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6943 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6944 password value. For example:
6945 .code
6946 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6947 .endd
6948 .next
6949 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6950 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6951 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6952 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6953
6954 .next
6955 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6956 .cindex lookup Redis
6957 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6958 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6959
6960 .next
6961 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6962 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6963 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6964 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6965
6966 .next
6967 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6968 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6969 .next
6970 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6971 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6972 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6973 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6974 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6975 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6976 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6977 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6978 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6979 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6980 .code
6981 require condition = \
6982 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6983 .endd
6984 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6985 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6986 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6987 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6988 .endlist
6989
6990
6991
6992 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6993 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6994 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6995 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6996 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6997 options such as a list of local domains.
6998
6999 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7000 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7001 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7002 or may give up altogether.
7003
7004
7005
7006 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7007 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7008 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7009 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7010 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7011 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7012 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7013 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7014
7015 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7016 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7017 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7018
7019 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7020 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7021 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7022
7023 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7024 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7025 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7026 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7027 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7028 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7029 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7030 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7031 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7032 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7033 .code
7034 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7035 .endd
7036 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7037 looks up these keys, in this order:
7038 .code
7039 jane@eyre.example
7040 *@eyre.example
7041 *
7042 .endd
7043 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7044 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7045 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7046 Exim move on to try the next key.
7047
7048
7049
7050 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7051 .cindex "partial matching"
7052 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7053 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7054 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7055 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7056 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7057 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7058 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7059 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7060 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7061 a key in a DBM file is
7062 .code
7063 *.dates.fict.example
7064 .endd
7065 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7066 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7067 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7068 file.
7069
7070 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7071 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7072 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7073
7074 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7075 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7076 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7077 partial matching keys
7078 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7079 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7080 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7081
7082 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7083 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7084 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7085 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7086 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7087 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7088 remains.
7089
7090 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7091 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7092 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7093 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7094 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7095 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7096 .code
7097 2250.dates.fict.example
7098 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7099 *.dates.fict.example
7100 *.fict.example
7101 .endd
7102 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7103 finishes.
7104
7105 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7106 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7107 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7108 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7109 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7110 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7111 .code
7112 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7113 .endd
7114 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7115 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7116 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7117 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7118 .code
7119 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7120 .endd
7121 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7122 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7123
7124 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7125 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7126 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7127
7128 .ilist
7129 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7130 .next
7131 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7132 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7133 .next
7134 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7135 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7136 for &"*"& on its own.
7137 .next
7138 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7139 .endlist
7140
7141
7142 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7143 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7144 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7145 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7146 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7147 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7148 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7149
7150 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7151 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7152 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7153 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7154 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7155
7156
7157
7158
7159 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7160 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7161 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7162 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7163 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7164 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7165 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7166
7167 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7168 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7169 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7170 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7171 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7172 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7173
7174 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7175 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7176 complete.
7177
7178
7179
7180
7181 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7182 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7183 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7184 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7185 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7186 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7187 .code
7188 [name=$local_part]
7189 .endd
7190 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7191 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7192 .code
7193 [name="$local_part"]
7194 .endd
7195 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7196 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7197 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7198 of the following form is provided:
7199 .code
7200 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7201 .endd
7202 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7203 .code
7204 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7205 .endd
7206 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7207 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7208 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7209
7210
7211
7212
7213 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7214 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7215 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7216 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7217 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7218 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7219 an expansion string could contain:
7220 .code
7221 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7222 .endd
7223 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7224 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7225 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7226 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7227
7228 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7229 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7230 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7231
7232 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7233 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7234 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7235 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7236 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7237 .code
7238 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7239 .endd
7240 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7241 white space is ignored.
7242 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7243 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7244 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7245
7246 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7247 When the type is PTR,
7248 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7249 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7250 .code
7251 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7252 .endd
7253 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7254 altered and nothing is added.
7255
7256 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7257 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7258 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7259 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7260 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7261 The field separator can be modified as above.
7262
7263 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7264 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7265 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7266 unless a field separator is specified.
7267 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7268 For SPF records the
7269 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7270 .code
7271 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7272 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7273 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7274 .endd
7275 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7276 white space is ignored.
7277
7278 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7279 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7280 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7281 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7282 specified.
7283 .code
7284 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7285 .endd
7286
7287 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7288 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7289 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7290 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7291 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7292 each followed by a comma,
7293 that may appear before the record type.
7294
7295 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7296 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7297 a defer-option modifier.
7298 The possible keywords are
7299 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7300 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7301 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7302 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7303 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7304 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7305 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7306 .code
7307 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7308 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7309 .endd
7310 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7311 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7312
7313 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7314 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7315 The possible keywords are
7316 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7317 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7318 with the lookup.
7319 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7320 is not labelled as authenticated data
7321 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7322 The default is &"never"&.
7323
7324 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7325
7326 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7327 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7328 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7329 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7330 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7331 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7332
7333 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7334 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7335 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7336
7337 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7338 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7339 .cindex DNS TTL
7340 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7341 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7342 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7343
7344
7345 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7346 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7347 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7348 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7349 the pseudo-type MXH:
7350 .code
7351 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7352 .endd
7353 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7354 returned.
7355
7356 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7357 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7358 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7359 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7360 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7361 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7362 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7363 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7364 .code
7365 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7366 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7367 .endd
7368 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7369 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7370 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7371
7372 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7373 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7374 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7375 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7376 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7377 such a list.
7378
7379 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7380 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7381 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7382 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7383 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7384 result of a successful lookup such as:
7385 .code
7386 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7387 .endd
7388 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7389 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7390 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7391
7392 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7393 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7394 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7395 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7396 .code
7397 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7398 .endd
7399
7400
7401 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7402 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7403 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7404 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7405 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7406 .code
7407 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7408 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7409 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7410 .endd
7411 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7412 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7413 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7414 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7415
7416 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7417 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7418 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7419
7420
7421
7422
7423 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7424 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7425 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7426 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7427 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7428 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7429 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7430 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7431 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7432 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7433 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7434 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7435 .code
7436 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7437 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7438 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7439 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7440 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7441 .endd
7442 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7443 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7444
7445 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7446 the way they handle the results of a query:
7447
7448 .ilist
7449 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7450 gives an error.
7451 .next
7452 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7453 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7454 .next
7455 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7456 from all of them are returned.
7457 .endlist
7458
7459
7460 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7461 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7462 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7463 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7464
7465
7466 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7467 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7468 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7469 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7470 .code
7471 data = ${lookup ldap \
7472 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7473 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7474 .endd
7475 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7476 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7477 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7478 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7479
7480 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7481 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7482 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7483
7484 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7485 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7486 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7487 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7488 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7489 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7490 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7491 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7492 &_exim.conf_&.
7493
7494
7495 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7496 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7497 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7498 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7499 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7500 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7501
7502 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7503 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7504 the string:
7505 .code
7506 * => \2A
7507 ( => \28
7508 ) => \29
7509 \ => \5C
7510 .endd
7511 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7512 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7513 .code
7514 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7515 .endd
7516 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7517 .code
7518 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7519 .endd
7520 yields
7521 .code
7522 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7523 .endd
7524 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7525 .code
7526 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7527 .endd
7528 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7529 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7530 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7531 .code
7532 , + " \ < > ;
7533 .endd
7534 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7535 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7536 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7537 .code
7538 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7539 .endd
7540 yields
7541 .code
7542 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7543 .endd
7544 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7545 .code
7546 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7547 .endd
7548 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7549 authentication below.
7550
7551
7552 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7553 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7554 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7555 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7556 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7557 by starting it with
7558 .code
7559 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7560 .endd
7561 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7562 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7563 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7564 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7565 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7566 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7567 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7568 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7569 failures, and timeouts.
7570
7571 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7572 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7573 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7574 doubled. For example
7575 .code
7576 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7577 .endd
7578 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7579 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7580 the local host) is used.
7581
7582 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7583 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7584 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7585 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7586 not available.
7587
7588 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7589 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7590 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7591 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7592 .code
7593 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7594 .endd
7595 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7596 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7597 .code
7598 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7599 .endd
7600 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7601 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7602 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7603 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7604 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7605 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7606 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7607 backup host.
7608
7609 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7610 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7611 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7612
7613 .ilist
7614 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7615 interface.
7616 .next
7617 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7618 .endlist
7619
7620
7621 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7622 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7623
7624
7625
7626 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7627 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7628 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7629 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7630 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7631 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7632 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7633 them. The following names are recognized:
7634 .display
7635 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7636 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7637 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7638 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7639 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7640 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7641 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7642 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7643 .endd
7644 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7645 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7646 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7647 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7648
7649 .cindex LDAP timeout
7650 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7651 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7652 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7653 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7654 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7655 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7656 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7657 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7658 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7659 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7660
7661 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7662 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7663
7664 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7665 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7666 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7667 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7668 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7669 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7670 alternate list (colon-separated).
7671
7672 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7673 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7674 .code
7675 ${lookup ldap
7676 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7677 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7678 {$value}fail}
7679 .endd
7680 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7681 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7682 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7683 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7684
7685 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7686 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7687 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7688
7689 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7690 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7691 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7692 quoting has two advantages:
7693
7694 .ilist
7695 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7696 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7697 .next
7698 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7699 .endlist
7700
7701 For example, a setting such as
7702 .code
7703 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7704 .endd
7705 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7706
7707 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7708 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7709 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7710 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7711 .code
7712 PASS=${quote:$3}
7713 .endd
7714 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7715 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7716 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7717
7718
7719
7720 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7721 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7722 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7723 as a sequence of values, for example
7724 .code
7725 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7726 .endd
7727 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7728 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7729 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7730 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7731 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7732 directory.
7733
7734 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7735 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7736 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7737 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7738
7739 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7740 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7741 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7742 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7743 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7744 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7745 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7746 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7747 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7748
7749 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7750 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7751 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7752 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7753 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7754
7755 .code
7756 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7757 value1.1,value1,,2
7758
7759 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7760 value two
7761
7762 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7763 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7764
7765 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7766 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7767
7768 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7769 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7770 .endd
7771 You can
7772 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7773 results of LDAP lookups.
7774 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7775 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7776 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7777 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7778 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7779 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7780
7781
7782
7783
7784 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7785 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7786 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7787 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7788 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7789 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7790 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7791 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7792 .code
7793 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7794 .endd
7795 might return the string
7796 .code
7797 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7798 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7799 .endd
7800 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7801 .code
7802 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7803 .endd
7804 would just return
7805 .code
7806 Martin Guerre
7807 .endd
7808 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7809 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7810 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7811
7812
7813
7814 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7815 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7816 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7817 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7818 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7819 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7820 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7821 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7822 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7823 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7824 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7825 .cindex lookup Redis
7826 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7827 and SQLite
7828 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7829 might be
7830 .code
7831 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7832 {$value}fail}
7833 .endd
7834 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7835 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7836 .code
7837 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7838 {$value}}
7839 .endd
7840 might be
7841 .code
7842 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7843 .endd
7844 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7845 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7846 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7847 .code
7848 Mister X
7849 .endd
7850 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7851 with a newline between the data for each row.
7852
7853
7854 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7855 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7856 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7857 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7858 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7859 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7860 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7861 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7862 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7863 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7864 .cindex lookup Redis
7865 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7866 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7867 or &%redis_servers%&
7868 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7869 information.
7870 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7871 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7872 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7873 For all but Redis
7874 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7875 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7876 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7877 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7878 .code
7879 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7880 .endd
7881 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7882 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7883 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7884 .code
7885 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7886 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7887 .endd
7888 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7889 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7890 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7891 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7892 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7893 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7894
7895 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7896 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7897 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7898 information.
7899 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7900 host, database number, and password.
7901 .olist
7902 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7903 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7904 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7905 .next
7906 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7907 .next
7908 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7909 .endlist
7910
7911 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7912 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7913 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7914 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7915
7916 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7917 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7918
7919 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7920 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7921 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7922 done by starting the query with
7923 .display
7924 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7925 .endd
7926 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7927 .olist
7928 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7929 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7930 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7931 taken from there.
7932 .next
7933 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7934 .endlist
7935 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7936 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7937 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7938
7939 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7940 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7941 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7942 like this:
7943 .code
7944 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7945 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7946 master/db/name/pw
7947 .endd
7948 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7949 .code
7950 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7951 .endd
7952 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7953 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7954 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7955 .code
7956 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7957 .endd
7958
7959
7960 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7961 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7962 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7963 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7964 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7965 the default value is &"exim"&.
7966 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7967 .display
7968 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7969 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7970 .endd
7971 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7972 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7973
7974 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7975 the queries.
7976
7977 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7978 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7979
7980 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7981 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7982 is zero because no rows are affected.
7983
7984
7985 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7986 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7987 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7988 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7989 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7990 looks like this:
7991 .code
7992 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7993 .endd
7994 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7995 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7996 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7997
7998 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7999 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8000 affected.
8001
8002 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8003 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8004 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8005 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8006 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8007 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8008 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8009 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8010 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8011 .code
8012 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8013 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8014 .endd
8015 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8016 .code
8017 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8018 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8019 .endd
8020 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8021 quote, which it doubles.
8022
8023 .cindex timeout SQLite
8024 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8025 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8026 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8027 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8028 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8029 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8030 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8031 option.
8032
8033 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8034 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8035 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8036 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8037 Examples:
8038 .code
8039 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8040 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8041 .endd
8042
8043 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8044 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8045 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8046 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8047 servers.
8048
8049 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8050 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8051 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8052 reached.
8053
8054 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
8055 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
8056
8057
8058 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8059 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8060
8061 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8062 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8063 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8064 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8065 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8066 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8067 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8068 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8069 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8070
8071 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8072 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8073 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8074 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8075
8076 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8077 support all the complexity available in
8078 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8079
8080
8081
8082 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8083 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8084 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8085
8086 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8087 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8088
8089 The result of
8090 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8091 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8092 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8093 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8094 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8095
8096
8097 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8098 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8099 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8100
8101 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8102 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8103 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8104 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8105 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8106 .code
8107 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8108 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8109 .endd
8110 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8111 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8112 senders based on the receiving domain.
8113
8114
8115
8116
8117 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8118 .cindex "list" "negation"
8119 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8120 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8121 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8122 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8123 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8124 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8125
8126 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8127 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8128 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8129 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8130 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8131 .code
8132 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8133 .endd
8134 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8135 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8136 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8137 .code
8138 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8139 .endd
8140 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8141 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8142 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8143
8144 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8145 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8146 item.
8147
8148
8149
8150 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8151 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8152 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8153 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8154 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8155 filenames are not allowed,
8156 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8157 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8158 lines:
8159
8160 .ilist
8161 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8162 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8163 .next
8164 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8165 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8166 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8167 .code
8168 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8169 .endd
8170 .endlist
8171
8172 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8173 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8174 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8175 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8176
8177 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8178 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8179 .code
8180 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8181 .endd
8182 and the file contains the lines
8183 .code
8184 !a.b.c
8185 *.b.c
8186 .endd
8187 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8188 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8189
8190
8191
8192 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8193 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8194 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8195 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8196 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8197 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8198 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8199 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8200
8201 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8202 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8203 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8204 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8205
8206
8207
8208
8209 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8210 .cindex "named lists"
8211 .cindex "list" "named"
8212 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8213 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8214 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8215 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8216 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8217 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8218 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8219 .code
8220 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8221 .endd
8222 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8223 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8224 configured with the line
8225 .code
8226 domains = +local_domains
8227 .endd
8228 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8229 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8230 .code
8231 dnslookup:
8232 driver = dnslookup
8233 domains = ! +local_domains
8234 transport = remote_smtp
8235 no_more
8236 .endd
8237 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8238 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8239 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8240 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8241 .code
8242 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8243 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8244 .endd
8245 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8246 .code
8247 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8248 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8249 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8250 .endd
8251 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8252 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8253 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8254 .code
8255 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8256 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8257 .endd
8258 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8259 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8260 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8261 .code
8262 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8263 .endd
8264 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8265 referenced lists if you can.
8266
8267 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8268 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8269 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8270 .code
8271 domains = +local_domains
8272 .endd
8273 on several of your routers
8274 or in several ACL statements,
8275 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8276 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8277 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8278 the same each time they are referenced.
8279
8280 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8281 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8282 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8283 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8284
8285
8286
8287 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8288 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8289 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8290 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8291 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8292 write
8293 .code
8294 ALIST = host1 : host2
8295 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8296 .endd
8297 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8298 .code
8299 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8300 .endd
8301 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8302 list, and write
8303 .code
8304 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8305 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8306 .endd
8307 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8308 .code
8309 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8310 .endd
8311
8312
8313 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8314 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8315 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8316 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8317 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8318 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8319 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8320 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8321 message. For example:
8322 .code
8323 domainlist special_domains = \
8324 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8325 .endd
8326 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8327 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8328 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8329 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8330 same list each time.
8331
8332 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8333 cache the result anyway. For example:
8334 .code
8335 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8336 .endd
8337 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8338 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8339
8340
8341
8342 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8343 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8344 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8345 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8346 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8347
8348 .ilist
8349 .cindex "primary host name"
8350 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8351 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8352 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8353 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8354 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8355 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8356 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8357 differ only in their names.
8358 .next
8359 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8360 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8361 .cindex "domain literal"
8362 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8363 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8364 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8365 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8366 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8367 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8368 .next
8369 .cindex "@mx_any"
8370 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8371 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8372 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8373 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8374 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8375 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8376 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8377 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8378 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8379 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8380 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8381
8382 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8383 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8384 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8385 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8386 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8387
8388 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8389 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8390 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8391 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8392 on a router). For example:
8393 .code
8394 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8395 .endd
8396 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8397 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8398
8399 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8400 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8401 contain negative items.
8402
8403 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8404 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8405 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8406 .code
8407 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8408 an.other.domain : ...
8409 .endd
8410 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8411 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8412 .code
8413 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8414 an.other.domain ? ...
8415 .endd
8416 .next
8417 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8418 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8419 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8420 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8421 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8422 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8423 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8424 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8425 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8426 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8427
8428 .next
8429 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8430 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8431 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8432 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8433 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8434 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8435 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8436 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8437 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8438
8439 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8440 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8441 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8442 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8443 expression by expansion, of course).
8444 .next
8445 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8446 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8447 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8448 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8449 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8450 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8451 .code
8452 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8453 .endd
8454 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8455 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8456 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8457 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8458 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8459 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8460 other statements in the same ACL.
8461
8462 .next
8463 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8464 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8465 .code
8466 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8467 .endd
8468 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8469 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8470
8471 .next
8472 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8473 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8474 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8475 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8476 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8477 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8478 expansion variable.
8479 .next
8480 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8481 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8482 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8483 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8484 .code
8485 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8486 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8487 .endd
8488 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8489 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8490 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8491 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8492 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8493 .next
8494 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8495 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8496 between the pattern and the domain.
8497 .endlist
8498
8499 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8500 .code
8501 domainlist funny_domains = \
8502 @ : \
8503 lib.unseen.edu : \
8504 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8505 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8506 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8507 nis;domains.byname : \
8508 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8509 .endd
8510 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8511 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8512 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8513 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8514 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8515 patterns earlier.
8516
8517
8518
8519 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8520 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8521 .cindex "list" "host list"
8522 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8523 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8524 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8525 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8526 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8527 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8528 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8529
8530
8531 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8532 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8533 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8534 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8535 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8536 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8537 not used.
8538
8539 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8540 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8541 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8542
8543
8544
8545 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8546 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8547 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8548 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8549 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8550 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8551 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8552 concerns.)
8553
8554 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8555 inspecting its IP address:
8556
8557 .ilist
8558 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8559 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8560 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8561 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8562 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8563 with the IP address of the subject host.
8564
8565 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8566 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8567 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8568 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8569 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8570
8571 .next
8572 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8573 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8574 domain name, as just described.
8575
8576 .next
8577 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8578 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8579 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8580 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8581 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8582 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8583 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8584 that can never match a client host.
8585
8586 .next
8587 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8588 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8589 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8590 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8591 .code
8592 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8593 accept hosts = @[]
8594 .endd
8595 .next
8596 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8597 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8598 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8599 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8600 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8601 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8602 significant end of the address.
8603
8604 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8605 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8606 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8607 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8608 .code
8609 192.168.23.236/31
8610 .endd
8611 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8612 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8613 matches.
8614
8615 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8616 .code
8617 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8618 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8619 .endd
8620 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8621 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8622 For example:
8623 .code
8624 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8625 .endd
8626 could make use of a file containing
8627 .code
8628 172.16.0.0/12
8629 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8630 .endd
8631 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8632 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8633 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8634 .code
8635 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8636 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8637 .endd
8638 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8639 list.
8640 .endlist
8641
8642
8643
8644 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8645 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8646 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8647 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8648 address, the pattern takes this form:
8649 .display
8650 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8651 .endd
8652 For example:
8653 .code
8654 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8655 .endd
8656 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8657 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8658 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8659 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8660 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8661 returned by the lookup is not used.
8662
8663 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8664 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8665 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8666 patterns of this form:
8667 .display
8668 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8669 .endd
8670 For example:
8671 .code
8672 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8673 .endd
8674 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8675 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8676 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8677 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8678 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8679
8680 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8681 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8682 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8683 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8684 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8685 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8686 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8687 converted using colons and not dots.
8688 .new
8689 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8690 addresses are always used.
8691 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8692 .wen
8693
8694 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8695 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8696 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8697 configurations.
8698
8699 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8700 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8701 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8702 case the IP address is used on its own.
8703
8704
8705
8706 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8707 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8708 .cindex "unknown host name"
8709 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8710 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8711 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8712 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8713 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8714 above.)
8715
8716 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8717 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8718 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8719 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8720 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8721 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8722 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8723
8724 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8725 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8726
8727 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8728 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8729 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8730 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8731 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8732 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8733 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8734 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8735 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8736
8737 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8738 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8739
8740 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8741 .cindex "alias for host"
8742 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8743 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8744
8745 .ilist
8746 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8747 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8748 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8749 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8750 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8751 expression.
8752 .next
8753 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8754 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8755 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8756 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8757 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8758 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8759 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8760 example,
8761 .code
8762 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8763 .endd
8764 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8765 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8766 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8767 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8768 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8769 .code
8770 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8771 .endd
8772 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8773 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8774 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8775 required.
8776 .endlist
8777
8778
8779
8780
8781 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8782 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8783 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8784 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8785 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8786 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8787
8788 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8789 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8790
8791 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8792 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8793 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8794 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8795 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8796 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8797 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8798 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8799 not recognized in an indirected file).
8800
8801 .ilist
8802 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8803 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8804 .code
8805 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8806 .endd
8807 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8808 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8809
8810 .next
8811 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8812 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8813 example:
8814 .code
8815 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8816 192.168.4.5
8817 .endd
8818 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8819 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8820 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8821 .endlist
8822
8823 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8824 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8825 list.
8826
8827 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8828 "SECTmixwilhos"
8829 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8830
8831 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8832 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8833 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8834
8835 .ilist
8836 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8837 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8838 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8839 .code
8840 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8841 .endd
8842 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8843 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8844 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8845 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8846 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8847 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8848 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8849
8850 .next
8851 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8852 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8853 .code
8854 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8855 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8856 .endd
8857 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8858 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8859 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8860 this section.
8861 .endlist
8862
8863
8864 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8865 "SECTtemdnserr"
8866 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8867 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8868 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8869 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8870 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8871 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8872 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8873 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8874 host lists such as whitelists.
8875
8876
8877
8878 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8879 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8880 .cindex "unknown host name"
8881 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8882 If a pattern is of the form
8883 .display
8884 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8885 .endd
8886 for example
8887 .code
8888 dbm;/host/accept/list
8889 .endd
8890 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8891 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8892 is not used.
8893
8894 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8895 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8896 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8897 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8898 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8899 lookup, both using the same file.
8900
8901
8902
8903 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8904 If a pattern is of the form
8905 .display
8906 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8907 .endd
8908 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8909 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8910 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8911 .code
8912 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8913 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8914 .endd
8915 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8916 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8917 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8918 operator.
8919
8920 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8921 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8922 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8923
8924 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8925 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8926 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8927 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8928 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8929 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8930
8931
8932
8933
8934
8935 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8936 .cindex "list" "address list"
8937 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8938 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8939 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8940 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8941 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8942 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8943 using this option setting:
8944 .code
8945 senders = :
8946 .endd
8947 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8948 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8949 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8950 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8951
8952 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8953 example:
8954 .code
8955 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8956 .endd
8957 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8958 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8959 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8960 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8961 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8962 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8963 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8964 .code
8965 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8966 *@+hostile_domains:\
8967 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8968 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8969 .endd
8970 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8971 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8972 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8973 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8974 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8975
8976 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8977 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8978 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8979 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8980 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8981 .code
8982 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8983 .endd
8984
8985 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8986 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8987 senders:
8988
8989 .ilist
8990 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8991 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8992 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8993 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8994 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8995 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8996 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8997 .code
8998 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8999 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9000 .endd
9001 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9002 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9003
9004 .next
9005 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9006 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9007 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9008 example:
9009 .code
9010 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9011 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9012 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9013 .endd
9014 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9015 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9016 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9017 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9018
9019 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9020 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9021 panic log.
9022 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9023 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9024 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9025 default. For example, with this lookup:
9026 .code
9027 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9028 .endd
9029 the file could contains lines like this:
9030 .code
9031 user1@domain1.example
9032 *@domain2.example
9033 .endd
9034 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9035 that are tried is:
9036 .code
9037 nimrod@jaeger.example
9038 *@jaeger.example
9039 *
9040 .endd
9041 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9042 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9043
9044 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9045 .code
9046 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9047 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9048 .endd
9049 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9050 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9051 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9052 .endlist
9053
9054
9055 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9056 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9057 always fails.
9058
9059
9060 .ilist
9061 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9062 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9063 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9064 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9065 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9066 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9067 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9068 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9069 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9070
9071 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9072 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9073 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9074 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9075 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9076 with
9077 .code
9078 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9079 .endd
9080 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9081 .code
9082 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9083 .endd
9084 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9085
9086 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9087 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9088 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9089 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9090 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9091 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9092 .code
9093 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9094 spammer3 : spammer4
9095 .endd
9096 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9097 doubling.
9098
9099 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9100 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9101 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9102 might have entries like
9103 .code
9104 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9105 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9106 *: ^\d{8}$
9107 .endd
9108 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9109 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9110 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9111 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9112
9113 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9114 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9115 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9116
9117 .next
9118 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9119 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9120 can only return a single list of local parts.
9121 .endlist
9122
9123 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9124 in these two examples:
9125 .code
9126 senders = +my_list
9127 senders = *@+my_list
9128 .endd
9129 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9130 example it is a named domain list.
9131
9132
9133
9134
9135 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9136 .cindex "case of local parts"
9137 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9138 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9139 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9140 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9141 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9142 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9143 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9144 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9145 default.
9146
9147 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9148 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9149 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9150 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9151 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9152 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9153 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9154 case-independent.
9155
9156 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9157 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9158 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9159 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9160 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9161 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9162 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9163 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9164
9165
9166
9167 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9168 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9169 .cindex "local part" "list"
9170 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9171 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9172 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9173 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9174 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9175 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9176 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9177 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9178
9179 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9180 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9181 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9182 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9183 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9184 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9185 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9186 types.
9187 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9188
9189
9190
9191
9192 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9193 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9194
9195 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9196 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9197 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9198 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9199
9200 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9201 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9202 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9203 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9204 escape character, as described in the following section.
9205
9206 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9207 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9208 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9209 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9210 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9211 reasons.
9212
9213
9214
9215 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9216 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9217 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9218 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9219 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9220 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9221 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9222 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9223
9224 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9225 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9226 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9227 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9228 .code
9229 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9230 .endd
9231 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9232 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9233 string.
9234
9235
9236
9237 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9238 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9239 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9240 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9241 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9242 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9243 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9244 encoding.
9245
9246 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9247 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9248 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9249
9250
9251 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9252 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9253 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9254 .oindex "&%-be%&"
9255 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9256 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9257 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9258 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9259 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9260 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9261 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9262 and &%nhash%&.
9263
9264 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9265 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9266 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9267
9268 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
9269 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9270 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9271 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9272 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9273 .code
9274 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9275 .endd
9276 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9277 Exim message identifier. For example:
9278 .code
9279 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9280 .endd
9281 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9282 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9283
9284
9285 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9286 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9287 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9288 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9289 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9290 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9291 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9292 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9293 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9294 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9295 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9296 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9297 being expanded.
9298
9299
9300
9301
9302 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9303 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9304 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9305 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9306 white space is significant.
9307
9308 .vlist
9309 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9310 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9311 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9312 .code
9313 $local_part
9314 ${domain}
9315 .endd
9316 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9317 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9318 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9319 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9320 given, the expansion fails.
9321
9322 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9323 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9324 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9325 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9326 .code
9327 ${lc:$local_part}
9328 .endd
9329 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9330 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9331 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9332 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9333 string easier to understand.
9334
9335 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9336 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9337 expansion item below.
9338
9339
9340 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9341 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9342 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9343 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9344 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9345 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9346 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9347 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9348 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9349 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9350 the result of the expansion.
9351 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9352 the expansion result is an empty string.
9353 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9354
9355
9356 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9357 .cindex authentication "results header"
9358 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9359 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9360 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9361 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9362 header line.
9363 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9364 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9365 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9366 .code
9367 none
9368 iprev
9369 auth
9370 spf
9371 dkim
9372 .endd
9373
9374 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9375 .code
9376 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9377 .endd
9378 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9379
9380
9381 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9382 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9383 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9384 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9385 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9386 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9387 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9388 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9389 .display
9390 &`version `&
9391 &`serial_number `&
9392 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9393 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9394 &`notbefore `& time
9395 &`notafter `& time
9396 &`sig_algorithm `&
9397 &`signature `&
9398 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9399 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9400 &`crl_uri `& list
9401 .endd
9402 If the field is found,
9403 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9404 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9405 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9406 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9407
9408 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9409 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9410 extracted is used.
9411
9412 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9413
9414 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9415 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9416 not quite
9417 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9418 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9419 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9420 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9421 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9422 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9423 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9424 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9425
9426 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9427 take an optional modifier of "int"
9428 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9429 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9430 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9431
9432 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9433 newline-separated by default,
9434 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9435 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9436 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9437
9438 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9439 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9440 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9441 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9442 if so the element tags are omitted.
9443
9444 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9445
9446 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9447 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9448 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9449 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9450 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9451 .code
9452 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9453 .endd
9454 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9455 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9456 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9457
9458 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9459 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9460 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9461 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9462 must have the following type:
9463 .code
9464 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9465 .endd
9466 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9467 function should return one of the following values:
9468
9469 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9470 into the expanded string that is being built.
9471
9472 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9473 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9474
9475 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9476 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9477
9478 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9479
9480 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9481 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9482 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9483
9484
9485 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9486 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9487 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9488 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9489 removed.
9490 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9491 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9492 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9493
9494 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9495 appear, for example:
9496 .code
9497 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9498 .endd
9499 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9500 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9501
9502 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9503 search failure.
9504 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9505 search success.
9506
9507 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9508 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9509
9510
9511 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9512 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9513 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9514 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9515 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9516 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9517 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9518 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9519 .display
9520 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9521 .endd
9522 .vindex "&$value$&"
9523 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9524 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9525 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9526 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9527 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9528 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9529 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9530 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9531 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9532
9533 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9534 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9535 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9536 yield &"2001"&:
9537 .code
9538 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9539 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9540 .endd
9541 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9542 appear, for example:
9543 .code
9544 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9545 .endd
9546 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9547 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9548
9549 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9550 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9551 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9552 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9553 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9554 .cindex JSON expansions
9555 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9556 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9557 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9558 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9559 .display
9560 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9561 .endd
9562 .vindex "&$value$&"
9563 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9564 the spaces are optional.
9565 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9566 For the &"json"& variant,
9567 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9568 trailing quotes.
9569 .new
9570 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9571 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9572 .wen
9573 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9574
9575 The results of matching are handled as above.
9576
9577
9578 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9579 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9580 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9581 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9582 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9583 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9584 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9585 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9586 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9587 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9588 <&'string3'&> as before.
9589
9590 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9591 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9592 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9593 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9594 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9595 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9596 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9597 provided. For example:
9598 .code
9599 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9600 .endd
9601 yields &"42"&, and
9602 .code
9603 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9604 .endd
9605 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9606 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9607
9608
9609 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9610 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9611 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9612 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9613 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9614 .cindex JSON expansions
9615 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9616 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9617
9618 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9619 there is no choice of field separator.
9620 For the &"json"& variant,
9621 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9622 trailing quotes.
9623 .new
9624 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9625 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9626 .wen
9627
9628
9629 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9630 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9631 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9632 .vindex "&$item$&"
9633 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9634 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9635 For each item
9636 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9637 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9638 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9639 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9640 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9641 .code
9642 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9643 .endd
9644 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9645 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9646
9647
9648 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9649 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9650 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9651 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9652 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9653 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9654
9655 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9656 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9657 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9658 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9659 .code
9660 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9661 .endd
9662 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9663 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9664 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9665 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9666 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9667 .code
9668 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9669 .endd
9670 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9671 letters appear. For example:
9672 .display
9673 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9674 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9675 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9676 .endd
9677
9678 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9679 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9680 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9681 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9682 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9683 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9684 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9685 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9686 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9687 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9688 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9689 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9690 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9691 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9692 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9693 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9694 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9695 .code
9696 $header_reply-to:
9697 .endd
9698 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9699 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9700 lines) may be present.
9701
9702 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9703 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9704
9705 .ilist
9706 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9707 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9708 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9709
9710 .next
9711 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9712 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9713 are multiple headers with a given name.
9714 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9715 list-processing facilities can be used.
9716 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9717 the content is &"raw"&.
9718
9719 .next
9720 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9721 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9722 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9723 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9724 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9725 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9726 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9727 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9728
9729 .next
9730 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9731 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9732 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9733 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9734 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9735 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9736 .endlist ilist
9737
9738 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9739 command of the following form:
9740 .code
9741 headers charset "UTF-8"
9742 .endd
9743 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9744 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9745 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9746 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9747 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9748 ISO-8859-1.
9749
9750 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9751 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9752 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9753 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9754
9755 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9756 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9757 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9758 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9759 router or transport are not accessible.
9760
9761 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9762 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9763 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9764 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9765 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9766 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9767 point they are added.
9768 When any of the above ACLs ar
9769 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9770
9771 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9772 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9773 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9774 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9775 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9776 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9777 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9778 header.)
9779
9780 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9781 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9782 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9783 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9784 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9785 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9786 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9787 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9788
9789
9790 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9791 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9792 .cindex &%hmac%&
9793 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9794 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9795 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9796 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9797 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9798 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9799 present. For example:
9800 .code
9801 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9802 .endd
9803 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9804 produces:
9805 .code
9806 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9807 .endd
9808 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9809 an Exim configuration:
9810 .code
9811 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9812 .endd
9813 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9814 .code
9815 headers_add = \
9816 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9817 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9818 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9819 .endd
9820 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9821 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9822 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9823 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9824 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9825 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9826
9827
9828 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9829 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9830 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9831 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9832 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9833 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9834 .code
9835 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9836 .endd
9837 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9838 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9839 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9840 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9841 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9842
9843 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9844 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9845 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9846 .code
9847 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9848 .endd
9849 you can use
9850 .code
9851 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9852 .endd
9853
9854
9855
9856 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9857 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9858 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9859 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9860 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9861 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9862
9863
9864
9865 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9866 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9867 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9868 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9869 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9870 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9871 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9872 some of the braces:
9873 .code
9874 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9875 .endd
9876 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9877 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9878 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9879 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9880
9881
9882 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9883 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9884 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9885 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9886 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9887 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9888 apart from an optional leading minus,
9889 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9890
9891 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9892 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9893
9894 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9895 If the number is negative, the fields are
9896 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9897 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9898 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9899
9900 If the modulus of the
9901 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9902 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9903
9904 For example:
9905 .code
9906 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9907 .endd
9908 yields &"42"&, and
9909 .code
9910 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9911 .endd
9912 yields &"result: 42"&.
9913
9914 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9915 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9916 extracted is used.
9917 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9918
9919
9920 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9921 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9922 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9923 described in the next item.
9924
9925 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9926 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9927 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9928 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9929 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9930 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9931 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9932 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9933 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9934
9935 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9936 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9937 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9938 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9939 out by the system administrator.
9940
9941 .vindex "&$value$&"
9942 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9943 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9944 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9945 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9946 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9947 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9948 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9949 original lookup fails.
9950
9951 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9952 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9953 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9954 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9955 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9956 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9957 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9958 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9959
9960 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9961 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9962 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9963 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9964
9965 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9966 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9967 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9968 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9969
9970 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9971 .code
9972 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9973 .endd
9974 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9975 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9976 .code
9977 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9978 {$value}fail}
9979 .endd
9980
9981
9982 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9983 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9984 .vindex "&$item$&"
9985 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9986 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9987 For each item
9988 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9989 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9990 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9991 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9992 .code
9993 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9994 .endd
9995 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9996 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9997 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9998
9999 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10000 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10001 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10002 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10003 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10004 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10005 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10006 .code
10007 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10008 .endd
10009 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10010 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10011 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10012 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10013 example,
10014 .code
10015 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10016 .endd
10017 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10018
10019
10020
10021 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10022 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10023 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10024 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10025 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10026 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10027 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10028 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10029
10030 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10031 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10032 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10033 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10034 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10035 not its contents.
10036
10037 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10038 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10039 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10040
10041 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10042 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10043
10044
10045 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10046 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10047 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10048 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10049 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10050 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10051 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10052 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10053
10054 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10055 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10056 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10057 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10058 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10059 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10060 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10061 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10062 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10063 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10064
10065 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10066 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10067 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10068 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10069
10070 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10071 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10072 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10073 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10074 is the expansion of the third argument.
10075
10076 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10077 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10078 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10079
10080 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10081 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10082 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10083 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10084 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10085 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10086 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10087 newlines are left in the string.
10088 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10089 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10090 the string expansion fails.
10091
10092 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10093 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10094
10095
10096
10097 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10098 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10099 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10100 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10101 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10102 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10103 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10104 examples:
10105 .code
10106 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10107 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10108 .endd
10109 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10110 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10111 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10112 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10113 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10114 example:
10115 .code
10116 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10117 .endd
10118 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10119 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10120 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10121 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10122 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10123 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10124 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10125 .code
10126 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10127 .endd
10128
10129 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10130 and must be present if the argument is given.
10131 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10132 Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10133 The first defines whether (the default)
10134 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10135 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10136 .code
10137 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10138 .endd
10139 The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10140 .code
10141 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10142 .endd
10143 The default is to not use TLS.
10144 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10145
10146 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10147 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10148 turns them into spaces:
10149 .code
10150 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10151 .endd
10152 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10153 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10154 addition, the following errors can occur:
10155
10156 .ilist
10157 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10158 .next
10159 Failure to connect the socket;
10160 .next
10161 Failure to write the request string;
10162 .next
10163 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10164 .endlist
10165
10166 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10167 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10168 errors occurs. For example:
10169 .code
10170 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10171 {socket failure}}
10172 .endd
10173 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10174 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10175 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10176 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10177 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10178
10179 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10180 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10181
10182
10183 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10184 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10185 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10186 .vindex "&$value$&"
10187 .vindex "&$item$&"
10188 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10189 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10190 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10191 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10192 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10193 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10194 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10195 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10196 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
10197 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10198 .code
10199 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10200 .endd
10201 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10202 can be found:
10203 .code
10204 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10205 .endd
10206 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10207 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
10208 expansion items.
10209
10210 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10211 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10212 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10213
10214 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10215 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10216 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10217 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10218 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10219 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10220 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10221 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10222 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10223
10224 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10225 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10226 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10227 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10228 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10229 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10230 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10231 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10232 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10233 character.
10234
10235 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10236 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10237 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10238 .vindex "&$value$&"
10239 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10240 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10241 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10242 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10243 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10244 &$value$&.
10245
10246 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10247 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10248 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10249 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10250
10251 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10252 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10253 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10254 troubleshoot:
10255 .code
10256 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10257 log_message = Output of id: $value
10258 .endd
10259 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10260 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10261 .code
10262 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10263 .endd
10264
10265 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10266 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10267 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10268 .code
10269 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10270 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10271 ...
10272 endif
10273 .endd
10274 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10275 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10276 commands.
10277
10278 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10279 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10280 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10281 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10282
10283 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10284 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10285
10286
10287 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10288 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10289 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10290 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10291 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10292 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10293 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10294 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10295 .code
10296 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10297 .endd
10298 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10299 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10300 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10301 .code
10302 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10303 .endd
10304 yields &"defabc"&, and
10305 .code
10306 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10307 .endd
10308 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10309 the regular expression from string expansion.
10310
10311 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10312 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10313
10314
10315 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10316 .cindex sorting "a list"
10317 .cindex list sorting
10318 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10319 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10320 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10321 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10322 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10323 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10324 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10325 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10326 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10327 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10328 to give values for comparison.
10329
10330 The item result is a sorted list,
10331 with the original list separator,
10332 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10333
10334 Examples:
10335 .code
10336 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10337 .endd
10338 sorts a list of numbers, and
10339 .code
10340 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10341 .endd
10342 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10343
10344
10345 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10346 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10347 .cindex "substring extraction"
10348 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10349 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10350 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10351 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10352 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10353 .code
10354 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10355 .endd
10356 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10357 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10358 omitted.
10359
10360 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10361 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10362 length required. For example
10363 .code
10364 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10365 .endd
10366 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10367 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10368 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10369 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10370
10371 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10372 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10373 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10374 .code
10375 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10376 .endd
10377 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10378 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10379 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10380 .code
10381 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10382 .endd
10383 yields an empty string, but
10384 .code
10385 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10386 .endd
10387 yields &"1"&.
10388
10389 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10390 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10391 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10392 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10393 .code
10394 ${substr_-1:abcde}
10395 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10396 .endd
10397 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10398
10399 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10400
10401
10402
10403 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10404 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10405 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10406 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10407 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10408 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10409 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10410 replacement list. For example
10411 .code
10412 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10413 .endd
10414 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10415 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10416 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10417 place.
10418
10419 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10420
10421 .endlist
10422
10423
10424
10425 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10426 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10427 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10428 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10429 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10430 following operations can be performed:
10431
10432 .vlist
10433 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10434 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10435 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10436 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10437 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10438 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10439
10440 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10441
10442
10443 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10444 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10445 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10446 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10447 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10448 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10449 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10450 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10451 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10452
10453 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10454 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10455 character. For example:
10456 .code
10457 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10458 .endd
10459 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10460 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10461 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10462 separator explicitly:
10463 .code
10464 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10465 .endd
10466
10467 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10468 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10469 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10470 processing lists.
10471
10472 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10473 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10474 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10475 email address separator. For the example header line:
10476 .code
10477 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10478 .endd
10479 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10480 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10481 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10482 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10483 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10484 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10485 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10486 .code
10487 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10488 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10489 user@example.com
10490 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10491 Last:user@example.com
10492 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10493 user@example.com
10494 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10495 フィリップ@example.jp
10496 .endd
10497
10498 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10499 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10500 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10501 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10502 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10503 Only lowercase letters are used.
10504
10505 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10506 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10507 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10508 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10509 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10510
10511 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10512 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10513 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10514 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10515 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10516 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10517 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10518 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10519 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10520
10521 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10522 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10523 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10524 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10525 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10526 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10527 string.
10528
10529 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10530 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10531 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10532 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10533 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10534 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10535
10536 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10537 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10538
10539
10540 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10541 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10542 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10543 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10544 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10545
10546
10547 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10548 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10549 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10550 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10551 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10552
10553
10554 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10555 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10556 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10557 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10558 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10559 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10560 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10561
10562 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10563 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10564 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10565 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10566 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10567 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10568
10569
10570 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10571 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10572 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10573 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10574 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10575 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10576 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10577 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10578 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10579 C programming language):
10580 .table2 70pt 300pt
10581 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10582 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10583 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10584 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10585 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10586 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10587 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10588 .endtable
10589 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10590 space is permitted before or after operators.
10591
10592 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10593 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10594 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10595 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10596 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10597
10598 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10599 or 1024*1024*1024,
10600 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10601 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10602
10603 .display
10604 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10605 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10606 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10607 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10608 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10609 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10610 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10611 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10612 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10613 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10614 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10615 .endd
10616
10617 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10618 .code
10619 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10620 condition = \
10621 ${if and { \
10622 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10623 { \
10624 < \
10625 {$recipients_count} \
10626 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10627 } \
10628 }{yes}{no}}
10629 .endd
10630 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10631 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10632
10633
10634 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10635 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10636 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10637 example,
10638 .code
10639 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10640 .endd
10641 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10642 and then re-expands what it has found.
10643
10644
10645 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10646 .cindex "Unicode"
10647 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10648 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10649 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10650 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10651 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10652 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10653 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10654 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10655 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10656
10657 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10658 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10659 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10660 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10661 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10662 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10663 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10664
10665
10666 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10667 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10668 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10669 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10670 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10671 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10672 .code
10673 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10674 .endd
10675 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10676 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10677
10678
10679
10680 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10681 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10682 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10683 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10684 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10685 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10686
10687
10688
10689 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10690 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10691 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10692 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10693 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10694 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10695 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10696
10697
10698 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10699 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10700 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10701 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10702 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10703 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10704 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10705
10706 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10707 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10708 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10709 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10710 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10711 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10712 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10713 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10714 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10715
10716
10717 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10718 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10719 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10720 .cindex "lower casing"
10721 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10722 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10723 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10724 .code
10725 ${lc:$local_part}
10726 .endd
10727 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10728
10729 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10730 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10731 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10732 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10733 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10734 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10735 .code
10736 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10737 .endd
10738 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10739 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10740 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10741 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10742
10743
10744 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10745 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10746 .cindex "list" "item count"
10747 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10748 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10749 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10750
10751
10752 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10753 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10754 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10755 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10756 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10757 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10758 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10759 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10760 matching list is returned.
10761
10762
10763 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10764 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10765 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10766 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10767 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10768 empty.
10769 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10770
10771
10772 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10773 .cindex "masked IP address"
10774 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10775 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10776 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10777 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10778 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10779 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10780 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10781 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10782 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10783 .code
10784 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10785 .endd
10786 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10787 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10788 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10789 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10790 .code
10791 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10792 .endd
10793 returns the string
10794 .code
10795 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10796 .endd
10797 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10798
10799
10800 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10801 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10802 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10803 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10804 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10805 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10806 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10807
10808 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10809 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10810
10811
10812 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10813 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10814 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10815 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10816 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10817 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10818 .code
10819 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10820 .endd
10821 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10822
10823
10824 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10825 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10826 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10827 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10828 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10829 is an empty string or
10830 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10831 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10832 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10833 respectively For example,
10834 .code
10835 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10836 .endd
10837 becomes
10838 .code
10839 "ab\"*\"cd"
10840 .endd
10841 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10842 variable or a message header.
10843
10844 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10845 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10846 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10847 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10848 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10849 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10850 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10851
10852 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10853 will likely use the quoting form.
10854 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10855
10856
10857 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10858 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10859 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10860 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10861 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10862 .code
10863 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10864 .endd
10865 returns
10866 .code
10867 two%20%5C2A%20two
10868 .endd
10869 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10870 yields an unchanged string.
10871
10872
10873 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10874 .cindex "random number"
10875 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10876 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10877 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10878 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10879 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10880 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10881 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10882 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10883 random().
10884
10885
10886 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10887 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10888 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10889 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10890 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10891 for DNS. For example,
10892 .code
10893 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10894 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10895 .endd
10896 returns
10897 .code
10898 4.2.0.192
10899 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10900 .endd
10901
10902
10903 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10904 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10905 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10906 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10907 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10908 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10909 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10910 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10911 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10912 characters
10913 .code
10914 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10915 .endd
10916 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10917 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10918 characters.
10919
10920
10921 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10922 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10923 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10924 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10925 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10926 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10927 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10928 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10929
10930 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10931 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10932 to use this operator as well.
10933
10934
10935
10936 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10937 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10938 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10939 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10940 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10941 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10942 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10943
10944
10945 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10946 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10947 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10948 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10949 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10950 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10951 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10952
10953 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10954 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10955
10956
10957 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10958 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10959 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10960 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10961 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10962 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10963 and returns
10964 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10965
10966 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10967 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10968
10969
10970 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10971 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10972 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10973 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10974 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10975 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10976 and returns
10977 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10978
10979 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10980 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10981 with 256 being the default.
10982
10983 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10984 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10985 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10986 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10987
10988
10989 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10990 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10991 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10992 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10993 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10994 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10995 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10996 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10997 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10998 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10999 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11000 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11001 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11002
11003 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11004 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11005 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11006
11007 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11008 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11009 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11010
11011
11012
11013 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11014 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11015 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11016 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11017 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11018 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11019 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11020
11021
11022 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11023 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11024 .cindex "substring extraction"
11025 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11026 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11027 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11028 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11029 .code
11030 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11031 .endd
11032 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11033 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11034 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11035
11036 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11037 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11038 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11039 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11040 seconds.
11041
11042 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11043 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11044 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11045 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11046 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11047 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11048 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11049
11050 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11051 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11052 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11053 .cindex "upper casing"
11054 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11055 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11056 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11057 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11058
11059 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11060 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11061 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11062 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11063 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11064 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11065 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11066 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11067 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11068 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11069 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11070 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11071 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11072 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11073 .code
11074 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11075 .endd
11076 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11077 literal question mark).
11078
11079 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11080 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11081 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11082 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11083 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11084 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11085 .cindex EAI
11086 .cindex internationalisation
11087 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11088 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11089 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11090 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11091 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11092 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11093 .endlist
11094
11095
11096
11097
11098
11099
11100 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11101 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11102 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11103 while expanding strings:
11104
11105 .vlist
11106 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11107 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11108 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11109 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11110 condition.
11111
11112 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11113 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11114 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11115 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11116 are:
11117 .display
11118 &`= `& equal
11119 &`== `& equal
11120 &`> `& greater
11121 &`>= `& greater or equal
11122 &`< `& less
11123 &`<= `& less or equal
11124 .endd
11125 For example:
11126 .code
11127 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11128 .endd
11129 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11130 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11131 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11132 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11133 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11134 zero.
11135
11136 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11137 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11138 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11139
11140
11141 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11142 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11143 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11144 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11145 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11146 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11147 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11148 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11149 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11150 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11151 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11152 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11153 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11154 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11155
11156 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11157 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11158 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11159 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11160 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11161 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11162 false if zero.
11163 An empty string is treated as false.
11164 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11165 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11166 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11167
11168 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11169 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11170 For example:
11171 .code
11172 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11173 .endd
11174
11175
11176 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11177 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11178 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11179 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11180 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11181 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11182 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11183 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11184
11185 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11186
11187 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11188 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11189 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11190 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11191 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11192 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11193 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11194 included in the binary.
11195
11196 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11197 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11198 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11199 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11200 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11201 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11202 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11203 string in LDAP form is:
11204 .code
11205 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11206 .endd
11207 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11208 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11209 .code
11210 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11211 .endd
11212 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11213 supported:
11214
11215 .ilist
11216 .cindex "MD5 hash"
11217 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11218 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11219 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11220 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11221 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11222 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11223 comparison fails.
11224
11225 .next
11226 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11227 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11228 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11229 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11230 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11231 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11232
11233 .next
11234 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11235 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11236 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11237 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11238 whatever its length.
11239
11240 .next
11241 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11242 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11243 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11244 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11245 .endlist
11246 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11247 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11248 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11249 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11250 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11251 support &[crypt16()]&.
11252
11253 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11254 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11255 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11256 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11257 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11258
11259 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11260 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11261 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11262
11263 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11264 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11265 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11266 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11267 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11268
11269 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11270 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11271 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11272 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11273 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11274 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11275 .code
11276 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11277 .endd
11278 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11279 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11280
11281 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11282 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11283 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11284 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11285 exists in the message. For example,
11286 .code
11287 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11288 .endd
11289 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11290 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11291
11292 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11293 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11294 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11295 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11296 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11297 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11298 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11299 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11300 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11301 case is defined per the system C locale.
11302
11303 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11304 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11305 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11306 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11307 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11308 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11309 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11310 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11311
11312 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11313 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11314 .cindex "first delivery"
11315 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11316 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11317 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11318 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11319
11320
11321 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11322 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11323 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11324 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11325 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11326 .vindex "&$item$&"
11327 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11328 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11329 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11330 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11331 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11332 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11333 .ilist
11334 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11335 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11336 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11337 .next
11338 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11339 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11340 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11341 .endlist
11342 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11343 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11344 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11345 list separator is changed to a comma:
11346 .code
11347 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11348 .endd
11349 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11350 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11351
11352 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11353
11354 .new
11355 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11356 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11357 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11358 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11359 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11360 .cindex JSON expansions
11361 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11362 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11363 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11364 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11365 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11366 be a JSON array.
11367 The array separator is not changeable.
11368 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11369 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11370 .wen
11371
11372
11373
11374 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11375 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11376 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11377 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11378 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11379 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11380 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11381 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11382 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11383 case-independent.
11384 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11385
11386 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11387 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11388 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11389 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11390 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11391 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11392 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11393 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11394 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11395 case-independent.
11396 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11397
11398 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11399 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11400 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11401 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11402 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11403 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11404 is true.
11405 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11406
11407 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11408 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11409 .code
11410 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11411 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11412 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11413 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11414 .endd
11415
11416 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11417 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11418 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11419 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11420 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11421 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11422 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11423 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11424 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11425 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11426 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11427
11428 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11429 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11430 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11431 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11432 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11433
11434 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11435 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11436 check.
11437 This is no longer the case.
11438
11439 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11440 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11441 .code
11442 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11443 .endd
11444 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11445
11446 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11447 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11448 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11449 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11450 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11451 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11452 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11453 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11454 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11455 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11456 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11457 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11458 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11459 this can be used.
11460
11461
11462 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11463 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11464 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11465 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11466 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11467 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11468 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11469 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11470 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11471 case-independent.
11472 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11473
11474 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11475 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11476 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11477 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11478 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11479 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11480 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11481 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11482 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11483 case-independent.
11484 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11485
11486
11487 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11488 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11489 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11490 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11491 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11492 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11493 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11494 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11495 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11496 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11497 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11498 For example,
11499 .code
11500 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11501 .endd
11502 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11503 backslashes is also required.
11504
11505 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11506 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11507 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11508 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11509 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11510 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11511 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11512 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11513
11514 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11515 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11516 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11517 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11518 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11519 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11520 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11521 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11522
11523 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11524 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11525 See &*match_local_part*&.
11526
11527 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11528 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11529 See &*match_local_part*&.
11530
11531 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11532 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11533 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11534 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11535 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11536 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11537 .code
11538 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11539 .endd
11540 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11541
11542 .ilist
11543 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11544 .next
11545 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11546 .next
11547 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11548 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11549 in a single test such as
11550 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11551 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11552 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11553 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11554 .code
11555 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11556 .endd
11557 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11558 .next
11559 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11560 .next
11561 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11562 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11563 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11564 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11565 masks. For example:
11566 .code
11567 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11568 .endd
11569 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11570 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11571 address mask, for example:
11572 .code
11573 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11574 .endd
11575 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11576 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11577 .code
11578 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11579 .endd
11580 .endlist ilist
11581
11582 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11583 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11584
11585 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11586
11587 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11588 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11589 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11590 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11591 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11592 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11593 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11594 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11595 example is:
11596 .code
11597 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11598 .endd
11599 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11600 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11601 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11602 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11603 .code
11604 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11605 .endd
11606 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11607 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11608 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11609 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11610 caselessly.
11611
11612 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11613 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11614
11615 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11616 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11617 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11618 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11619
11620 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11621 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11622 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11623 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11624 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11625 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11626 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11627 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11628 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11629 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11630 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11631 .code
11632 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11633 .endd
11634 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11635 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11636
11637 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11638 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11639 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11640 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11641 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11642 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11643 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11644
11645 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11646 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11647 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11648 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11649 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11650 .code
11651 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11652 .endd
11653 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11654 .code
11655 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11656 .endd
11657 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11658 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11659 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11660 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11661
11662
11663 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11664 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11665 .cindex "Cyrus"
11666 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11667 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11668 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11669 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11670 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11671 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11672
11673 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11674 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11675 building Exim. For example:
11676 .code
11677 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11678 .endd
11679 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11680 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11681 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11682 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11683
11684 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11685 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11686 configuration, you might have this:
11687 .code
11688 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11689 .endd
11690 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11691 .code
11692 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11693 .endd
11694 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11695 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11696 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11697 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11698 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11699 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11700
11701
11702 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11703 .cindex "Radius"
11704 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11705 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11706 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11707 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11708 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11709 support.
11710
11711 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11712 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11713 this library, you need to set
11714 .code
11715 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11716 .endd
11717 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11718 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11719 .code
11720 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11721 .endd
11722 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11723 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11724 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11725
11726 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11727 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11728 the authentication is successful. For example:
11729 .code
11730 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11731 .endd
11732
11733
11734 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11735 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11736 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11737 .cindex "Cyrus"
11738 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11739 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11740 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11741 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11742 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11743 by a process that is not running as root.
11744
11745 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11746 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11747 building Exim. For example:
11748 .code
11749 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11750 .endd
11751 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11752 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11753 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11754
11755 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11756 two are mandatory. For example:
11757 .code
11758 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11759 .endd
11760 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11761 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11762 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11763 .endlist vlist
11764
11765
11766
11767 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11768 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11769 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11770 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11771 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11772 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11773 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11774
11775
11776 .vlist
11777 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11778 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11779 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11780 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11781 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11782 For example,
11783 .code
11784 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11785 .endd
11786 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11787 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11788 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11789
11790 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11791 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11792 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11793 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11794 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11795 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11796 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11797 parsed but not evaluated.
11798 .endlist
11799 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11800
11801
11802
11803
11804 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11805 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11806 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11807 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11808 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11809
11810 .vlist
11811 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11812 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11813 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11814 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11815 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11816 In the expansion condition case
11817 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11818 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11819 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11820 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11821 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11822 matching condition.
11823
11824 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11825 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11826 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11827 any unused variables being made empty.
11828
11829 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11830 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11831 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11832 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11833 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11834 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11835 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11836 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11837 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11838 during subsequent delivery.
11839
11840 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11841 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11842 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11843 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11844 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11845 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11846 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11847 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11848 delivery.
11849
11850 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11851 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11852 this variable has the number of arguments.
11853
11854 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11855 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11856 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11857 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11858 be preserved by coding like this:
11859 .code
11860 warn !verify = sender
11861 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11862 .endd
11863 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11864 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11865 failure.
11866
11867 .vitem &$address_data$&
11868 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11869 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11870 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11871 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11872 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11873 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11874 user filter files.
11875
11876 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11877 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11878 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11879 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11880 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11881 from the child's routing.
11882
11883 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11884 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11885 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11886 address.
11887
11888 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11889 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11890 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11891
11892 .vitem &$address_file$&
11893 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11894 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11895 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11896 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11897 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11898 .code
11899 /home/r2d2/savemail
11900 .endd
11901 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11902 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11903 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11904 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11905 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11906 to the relevant file.
11907
11908 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11909 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11910 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11911 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11912
11913 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11914 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11915 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11916 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11917
11918 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11919 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11920 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11921 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11922 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11923 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11924 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11925 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11926 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11927
11928 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11929 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11930 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11931 command line option.
11932 This second case also sets up information used by the
11933 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11934
11935 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11936 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11937 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11938 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11939 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11940 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11941 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11942 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11943 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11944 the ACL's as well.
11945
11946
11947 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11948 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11949 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11950 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11951 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11952 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11953 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11954 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11955 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11956 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11957 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11958
11959 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11960 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11961 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11962 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11963 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11964
11965
11966 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11967 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11968 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11969 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11970 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11971 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11972 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11973 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11974 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11975 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11976 an undefined mechanism.
11977
11978 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11979 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11980 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11981 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11982 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11983 the ACL malware condition.
11984
11985 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11986 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11987 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11988 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11989 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11990 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11991
11992 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11993 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11994 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11995 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11996 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11997 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11998 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11999
12000 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12001 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12002 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12003 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12004 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12005
12006 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12007 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12008 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12009 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12010 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12011
12012 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12013 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12014 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12015 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12016 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12017 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12018 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12019
12020 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12021 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12022 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12023 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12024 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12025 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12026 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12027
12028 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12029 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12030 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12031 address that was connected to.
12032
12033 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12034 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12035 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12036 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12037 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12038
12039 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12040 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12041 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12042 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12043 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12044 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12045
12046 .vitem &$config_file$&
12047 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12048 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12049
12050 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12051 Results of DKIM verification.
12052 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12053
12054 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12055 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12056 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12057 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12058 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12059 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12060 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12061 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12062 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12063 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12064 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12065 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12066 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12067 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12068 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12069 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12070 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12071 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12072 &$dkim_key_length$&
12073 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12074 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12075
12076 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12077 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12078 When a message has been received this variable contains
12079 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12080 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12081
12082 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12083 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12084 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12085 &$dnslist_value$&
12086 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12087 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12088 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12089 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12090 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12091 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12092 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12093 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12094 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12095
12096 .vitem &$domain$&
12097 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12098 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12099 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12100 case for &$domain$&.
12101
12102 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12103 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12104 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12105 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12106
12107 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12108 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12109 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12110 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12111 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12112 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12113
12114 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12115 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12116 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12117
12118 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12119
12120 .ilist
12121 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12122 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12123 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12124 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12125 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12126 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12127 the &(smtp)& transport.
12128
12129 .next
12130 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12131 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12132 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12133 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12134
12135 .next
12136 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12137 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12138 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12139 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12140 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12141 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12142
12143 .next
12144 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12145 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12146 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12147 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12148 .endlist
12149
12150
12151 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12152 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12153 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12154 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12155 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12156 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12157 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12158 used.
12159
12160 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12161 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12162 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12163 to nothing.
12164
12165 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12166 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12167 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12168
12169 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12170 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12171 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12172
12173 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12174 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12175 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12176
12177 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12178 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12179 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12180 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12181 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12182 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12183
12184 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12185 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12186 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12187 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12188 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12189 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12190
12191 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12192 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12193 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12194 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12195 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12196
12197 .vitem &$home$&
12198 .vindex "&$home$&"
12199 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12200 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12201 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12202 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12203 by a setting on the transport itself.
12204
12205 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12206 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12207 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12208
12209 .vitem &$host$&
12210 .vindex "&$host$&"
12211 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12212 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12213 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12214 to local and remote transports.
12215
12216 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12217 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12218 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12219 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12220 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12221 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12222 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12223 is connected.
12224
12225 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12226 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12227 client is connected.
12228
12229
12230 .vitem &$host_address$&
12231 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12232 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12233 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12234 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12235
12236 .vitem &$host_data$&
12237 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12238 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12239 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12240 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12241 .code
12242 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12243 message = $host_data
12244 .endd
12245 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12246 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12247 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12248 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12249 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12250 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12251 variables is set to &"1"&.
12252
12253 .ilist
12254 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12255 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12256
12257 .next
12258 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12259 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12260 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12261 .endlist ilist
12262
12263 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12264 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12265 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12266 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12267 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12268 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12269 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12270 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12271 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12272 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12273
12274 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12275 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12276 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12277
12278
12279 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12280 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12281 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12282
12283 .vitem &$host_port$&
12284 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12285 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12286 for an outbound connection.
12287
12288 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12289 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12290 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12291 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12292 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12293 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12294
12295 .vitem &$inode$&
12296 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12297 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12298 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12299 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12300 a unique name for the file.
12301
12302 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12303 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12304 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12305
12306 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12307 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12308 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12309
12310 .vitem &$item$&
12311 .vindex "&$item$&"
12312 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12313 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12314 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12315 empty.
12316
12317 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12318 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12319 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12320 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12321 lookup.
12322
12323 .vitem &$load_average$&
12324 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12325 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12326 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12327 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12328
12329 .vitem &$local_part$&
12330 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12331 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12332 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12333 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12334 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12335
12336 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12337 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12338 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12339 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12340 once.
12341
12342 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12343 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12344 .cindex affix variables
12345 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12346 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12347 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12348 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12349
12350 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12351 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12352 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12353 &$address_pipe$&).
12354
12355 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12356 local part of the recipient address.
12357
12358 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12359 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12360 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12361
12362 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12363 the addresses
12364 .code
12365 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12366 abc\:xyz@test.example
12367 .endd
12368 the value of &$local_part$& is
12369 .code
12370 abc:xyz
12371 .endd
12372 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12373 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12374 have:
12375 .code
12376 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12377 .endd
12378 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12379 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12380 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12381
12382 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12383 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12384 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12385 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12386 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12387 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12388 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12389
12390 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12391 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12392 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12393 variable expands to nothing.
12394
12395 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12396 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12397 .cindex affix variables
12398 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12399 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12400 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12401
12402 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12403 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12404 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12405 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12406 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12407
12408 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12409 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12410 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12411 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12412
12413 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12414 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12415 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12416
12417 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12418 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12419 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12420 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12421 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12422 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12423 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12424 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12425
12426 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12427 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12428 This contains the expanded value of the
12429 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12430 been read.
12431
12432 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12433 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12434 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12435 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12436 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12437 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12438
12439 .vitem &$log_space$&
12440 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12441 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12442 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12443 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12444 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12445 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12446
12447
12448 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12449 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12450 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12451 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12452 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12453 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12454 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12455 and &"yes"& if it was.
12456 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12457 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12458 as authenticated data.
12459
12460 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12461 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12462 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12463 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12464 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12465 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12466 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12467 variable is empty.
12468
12469 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12470 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12471 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12472 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12473 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12474
12475 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12476 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12477 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12478 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12479 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12480 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12481 character(s).
12482 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12483
12484 .vitem &$message_age$&
12485 .cindex "message" "age of"
12486 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12487 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12488 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12489 delivery attempt.
12490
12491 .vitem &$message_body$&
12492 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12493 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12494 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12495 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12496 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12497 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12498 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12499 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12500 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12501
12502 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12503 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12504 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12505 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12506 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12507
12508 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12509 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12510 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12511 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12512 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12513 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12514 &$message_body$&.
12515
12516 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12517 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12518 .cindex "message body" "size"
12519 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12520 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12521 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12522 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12523 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12524
12525 If the spool file is wireformat
12526 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12527 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12528
12529 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12530 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12531 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12532 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12533 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12534 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12535 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12536 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12537
12538 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12539 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12540 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12541 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12542 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12543 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12544
12545 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12546 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12547 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12548 contents of header lines is done.
12549
12550 .vitem &$message_id$&
12551 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12552
12553 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12554 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12555 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12556 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12557 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12558 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12559 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12560 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12561 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12562 from the body is not counted.
12563
12564 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12565 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12566 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12567 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12568 header and the body).
12569
12570 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12571 .code
12572 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12573 condition = \
12574 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12575 .endd
12576 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12577 message has not yet been received.
12578
12579 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12580
12581 .vitem &$message_size$&
12582 .cindex "size" "of message"
12583 .cindex "message" "size"
12584 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12585 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12586 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12587 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12588 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12589 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12590 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12591 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12592 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12593
12594 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12595 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12596 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12597 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12598
12599 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12600 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12601 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12602 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12603
12604 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12605 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12606 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12607
12608 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12609 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12610 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12611 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12612 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12613 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12614 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12615 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12616 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12617 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12618
12619 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12620 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12621 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12622
12623 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12624 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12625 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12626 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12627 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12628 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12629 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12630 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12631 the original address.
12632
12633 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12634 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12635 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12636 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12637 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12638
12639 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12640 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12641 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12642
12643 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12644 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12645 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12646 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12647 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12648 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12649 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12650 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12651 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12652
12653 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12654 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12655 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12656 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12657 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12658 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12659 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12660 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12661 user.
12662
12663 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12664 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12665 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12666 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12667
12668 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12669 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12670 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12671 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12672
12673 .vitem &$pid$&
12674 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12675 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12676 This variable contains the current process id.
12677
12678 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12679 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12680 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12681 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12682 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12683 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12684 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12685 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12686 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12687 variable"& error if encountered.
12688
12689 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12690 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12691 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12692 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12693 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12694 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12695 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12696
12697
12698 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12699 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12700 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12701 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12702 &$proxy_session$&
12703 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12704 or SOCKS5 support.
12705 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12706
12707 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12708 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12709 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12710 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12711
12712 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12713 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12714 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12715 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12716
12717 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12718 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12719 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12720 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12721
12722 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12723 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12724 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12725 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12726
12727 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12728 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12729 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12730
12731 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12732 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12733 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12734 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12735
12736 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12737 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12738 .cindex "named queues"
12739 .cindex queues named
12740 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12741
12742 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12743 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12744 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12745 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12746 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12747
12748 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12749 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12750 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12751 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12752 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12753 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12754
12755 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12756 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12757 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12758 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12759 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12760
12761 .vitem &$received_count$&
12762 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12763 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12764 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12765 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12766 delivering.
12767
12768 .vitem &$received_for$&
12769 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12770 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12771 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12772 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12773 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12774
12775 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12776 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12777 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12778 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12779 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12780 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12781 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12782 option.
12783
12784 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12785 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12786 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12787 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12788 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12789 time.
12790 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12791
12792 .vitem &$received_port$&
12793 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12794 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12795
12796 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12797 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12798 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12799 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12800 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12801 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12802 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12803 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12804 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12805
12806 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12807 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12808 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12809 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12810 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12811 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12812
12813 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12814 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12815 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12816
12817 .vitem &$received_time$&
12818 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12819 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12820 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12821
12822 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12823 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12824 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12825 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12826 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12827 .display
12828 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12829 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12830 .endd
12831 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12832 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12833 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12834 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12835
12836 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12837 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12838 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12839 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12840
12841 .ilist
12842 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12843 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12844
12845 .next
12846 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12847
12848 .next
12849 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12850 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12851 MAIL).
12852
12853 .next
12854 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12855 .next
12856
12857 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12858 .endlist
12859
12860 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12861 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12862
12863 .vitem &$recipients$&
12864 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12865 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12866 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12867 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12868 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12869 cases:
12870
12871 .olist
12872 In a system filter file.
12873 .next
12874 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12875 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12876 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12877 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12878 .next
12879 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12880 .endlist
12881
12882
12883 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12884 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12885 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12886 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12887 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12888 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12889
12890
12891 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12892 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12893 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12894 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12895
12896 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12897 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12898 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12899 these variables contain the
12900 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12901
12902
12903 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12904 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12905 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12906 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12907 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12908 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12909 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12910
12911 .vitem &$return_path$&
12912 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12913 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12914 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12915 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12916 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12917 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12918 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12919 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12920 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12921 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12922 envelope sender.
12923
12924 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12925 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12926 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12927
12928 .vitem &$router_name$&
12929 .cindex "router" "name"
12930 .cindex "name" "of router"
12931 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12932 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12933
12934 .vitem &$runrc$&
12935 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12936 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12937 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12938 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12939 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12940 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12941 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12942 another.
12943
12944 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12945 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12946 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12947 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12948 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12949 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12950 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12951 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12952
12953 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12954 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12955 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12956 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12957 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12958 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12959
12960 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12961 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12962 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12963 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12964 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12965 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12966 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12967 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12968
12969 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12970 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12971 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12972
12973 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12974 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12975 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12976
12977 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12978 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12979 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12980 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12981 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12982 this:
12983 .display
12984 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12985 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12986 .endd
12987 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12988 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12989 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12990 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12991
12992 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12993 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12994 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12995 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12996 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12997 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12998 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12999 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13000 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13001 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13002 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13003 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13004 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13005
13006 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13007 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13008 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13009 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13010 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13011
13012 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13013 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13014 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13015 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13016 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13017 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13018
13019 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13020 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13021 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13022 this variable contains that
13023 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13024
13025 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13026 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13027 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13028 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13029 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13030 &$authenticated_id$&.
13031
13032 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13033 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13034 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13035 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13036 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13037 resolver library states that both
13038 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13039 other times, this variable is false.
13040
13041 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13042 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13043 library, by setting:
13044 .code
13045 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13046 .endd
13047
13048 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13049 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13050
13051 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13052 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13053
13054 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13055 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13056 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13057 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13058
13059
13060 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13061 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13062 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13063 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13064 other means, this variable is empty.
13065
13066 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13067 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13068 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13069 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13070 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13071 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13072 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13073
13074 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13075 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13076 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13077 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13078
13079 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13080 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13081 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13082 is set to &"1"&.
13083
13084 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13085 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13086 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13087 following are true:
13088
13089 .ilist
13090 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13091 .next
13092 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13093 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13094 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13095 .next
13096 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13097 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13098 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13099 .next
13100 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13101 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13102 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13103 .next
13104 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13105 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13106 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13107 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13108 .code
13109 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13110 .endd
13111 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13112 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13113 .endlist
13114
13115
13116 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13117 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13118 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13119 number that was used on the remote host.
13120
13121 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13122 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13123 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13124 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13125 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13126 called Exim.
13127
13128 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13129 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13130 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13131 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13132
13133 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13134 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13135 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13136 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13137 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13138 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13139 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13140 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13141 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13142 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13143 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13144 the parentheses.
13145
13146 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13147 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13148 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13149 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13150 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13151
13152 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13153 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13154 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13155 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13156 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13157
13158 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13159 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13160 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13161 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13162 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13163 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13164 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13165
13166 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13167 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13168 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13169 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13170 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13171
13172 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13173 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13174 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13175 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13176 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13177 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13178
13179 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13180 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13181 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13182 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13183 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13184 .code
13185 MAIL FROM:<>
13186 MAIL FROM: <>
13187 .endd
13188 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13189 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13190 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13191 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13192
13193 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13194 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13195 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13196 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13197 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13198 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13199 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13200
13201 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13202 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13203 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13204 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13205 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13206 are remembered.
13207
13208 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13209 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13210 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13211 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13212 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13213 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13214 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13215 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13216 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13217 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13218 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13219
13220 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13221 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13222 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13223 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13224 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13225 message is junk mail.
13226
13227 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13228 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13229 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13230 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13231
13232 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13233 &$spf_received$& &&&
13234 &$spf_result$& &&&
13235 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13236 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13237 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13238 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13239
13240 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13241 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13242 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13243
13244 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13245 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13246 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13247 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13248 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13249 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13250
13251 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13252 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13253 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13254 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13255 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13256 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13257 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13258 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13259 .code
13260 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13261 .endd
13262 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13263
13264
13265 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13266 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13267 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13268 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13269 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13270 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13271
13272 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13273 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13274 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13275 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13276 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13277 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13278 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13279 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13280
13281 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13282 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13283 the outbound.
13284
13285 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13286 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13287 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13288 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13289 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13290 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13291
13292 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13293 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13294 .cindex certificate variables
13295 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13296 inbound connection when the message was received.
13297 It is only useful as the argument of a
13298 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13299 or a &%def%& condition.
13300
13301 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13302 when a list of more than one
13303 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13304
13305 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13306 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13307 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13308 inbound connection when the message was received.
13309 It is only useful as the argument of a
13310 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13311 or a &%def%& condition.
13312 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13313 which is not the leaf.
13314
13315 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13316 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13317 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13318 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13319 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13320 or a &%def%& condition.
13321
13322 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13323 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13324 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13325 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13326 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13327 or a &%def%& condition.
13328 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13329 which is not the leaf.
13330
13331 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13332 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13333 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13334 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13335
13336 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13337 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13338 the outbound.
13339
13340 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13341 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13342 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13343 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13344 and &"0"& otherwise.
13345
13346 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13347 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13348 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13349 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13350 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13351 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13352 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13353 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13354 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13355
13356 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13357 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13358 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13359
13360 .new
13361 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13362 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13363 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13364 .wen
13365
13366 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13367 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13368 This variable is
13369 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13370 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13371 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13372 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13373
13374 ,new
13375 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13376 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13377 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13378 .wen
13379
13380 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13381 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13382 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13383
13384 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13385 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13386 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13387 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13388 .code
13389 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13390 1 No response to request
13391 2 Response not verified
13392 3 Verification failed
13393 4 Verification succeeded
13394 .endd
13395
13396 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13397 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13398 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13399 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13400 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13401
13402 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13403 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13404 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13405 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13406 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13407 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13408 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13409 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13410 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13411 which is not the leaf.
13412
13413 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13414 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13415 the outbound.
13416
13417 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13418 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13419 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13420 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13421 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13422 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13423 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13424 which is not the leaf.
13425
13426 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13427 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13428 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13429 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13430 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13431 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13432 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13433 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13434 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13435 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13436 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13437
13438 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13439 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13440 the outbound.
13441
13442 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13443 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13444 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13445 During outbound
13446 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13447 the transport.
13448
13449 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13450 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13451 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13452
13453 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13454 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13455 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13456 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13457
13458 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13459 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13460 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13461
13462 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13463 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13464 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13465
13466 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13467 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13468 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13469 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13470 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13471 values for those that are behind (west).
13472
13473 .vitem &$tod_log$&
13474 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13475 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13476 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13477
13478 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13479 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13480 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13481 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13482 flag.
13483
13484 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13485 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13486 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13487 -0500.
13488
13489 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13490 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13491 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13492 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13493
13494 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13495 .cindex "transport" "name"
13496 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13497 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13498 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13499
13500 .vitem &$value$&
13501 .vindex "&$value$&"
13502 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13503 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13504 &*reduce*& expansion.
13505
13506 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13507 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13508 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13509 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13510 Otherwise, empty.
13511
13512 .vitem &$version_number$&
13513 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13514 The version number of Exim.
13515
13516 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13517 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13518 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13519 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13520
13521 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13522 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13523 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13524 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13525 .endlist
13526 .ecindex IIDstrexp
13527
13528
13529
13530 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13532
13533 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13534 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13535 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13536 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13537 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13538 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13539 the line
13540 .code
13541 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13542 .endd
13543 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13544
13545
13546 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13547 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13548 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13549 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13550 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13551 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13552 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13553 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13554 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13555
13556 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13557 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13558 should usually be something like
13559 .code
13560 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13561 .endd
13562 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13563 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13564 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13565 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13566 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13567 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13568 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13569 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13570 two ways:
13571
13572 .ilist
13573 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13574 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13575 a startup when Exim is entered.
13576 .next
13577 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13578 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13579 .endlist
13580
13581 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13582 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13583
13584 .ilist
13585 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13586 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13587 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13588 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13589 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13590 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13591 defaults to false.
13592
13593
13594 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13595 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13596 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13597 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13598 forms:
13599 .code
13600 ${perl{foo}}
13601 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13602 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13603 .endd
13604 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13605 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13606 with an error message of the form
13607 .code
13608 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13609 .endd
13610 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13611 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13612 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13613 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13614 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13615 that was passed to &%die%&.
13616
13617
13618 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13619 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13620 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13621 the Perl code
13622 .code
13623 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13624 .endd
13625 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13626 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13627 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13628
13629 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13630 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13631 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13632 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13633
13634 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13635 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13636 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13637 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13638 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13639 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13640 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13641
13642
13643 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13644 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13645 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13646 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13647 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13648 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13649 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13650 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13651 avoided, but the output is lost.
13652
13653 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13654 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13655 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13656 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13657 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13658 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13659 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13660 .code
13661 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13662 .endd
13663 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13664 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13665 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13666 as the first subroutine argument.
13667 .ecindex IIDperl
13668
13669
13670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13672
13673 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13674 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13675 "Starting the daemon"
13676 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13677 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13678 .cindex "network interface"
13679 .cindex "interface" "network"
13680 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13681 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13682 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13683 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13684 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13685 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13686 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13687 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13688 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13689 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13690 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13691
13692 .olist
13693 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13694 and ports to listen on.
13695 .next
13696 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13697 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13698 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13699 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13700 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13701 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13702 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13703 as an error situation.
13704 .next
13705 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13706 for the outgoing connection.
13707 .endlist
13708
13709
13710 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13711 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13712 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13713 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13714 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13715
13716 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13717 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13718 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13719 chapter describes how they operate.
13720
13721 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13722 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13723
13724
13725
13726 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13727 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13728 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13729 following options:
13730
13731 .ilist
13732 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13733 or service names.
13734 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13735 .next
13736 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13737 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13738 .endlist
13739
13740 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13741 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13742 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13743 colons. For example:
13744 .code
13745 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13746 192.168.23.65 ; \
13747 ::1 ; \
13748 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13749 .endd
13750 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13751 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13752
13753 .olist
13754 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13755 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13756 .code
13757 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13758 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13759 .endd
13760 .next
13761 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13762 with a colon separator, for example:
13763 .code
13764 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13765 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13766 .endd
13767 .endlist
13768
13769 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13770 default setting contains just one port:
13771 .code
13772 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13773 .endd
13774 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13775 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13776 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13777 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13778 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13779
13780
13781
13782 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13783 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13784 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13785 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13786 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13787 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13788 .code
13789 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13790 .endd
13791 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13792 .code
13793 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13794 .endd
13795 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13796
13797
13798
13799 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13800 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13801 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13802 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13803 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13804 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13805 exim.
13806
13807 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13808 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13809 If there are any items that do not
13810 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13811 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13812 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13813 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13814 .code
13815 -oX 1225
13816 .endd
13817 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13818 whereas
13819 .code
13820 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13821 .endd
13822 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13823 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13824 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13825
13826
13827
13828 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13829 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13830 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13831 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13832 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13833 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13834 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13835 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13836 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13837 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13838 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13839 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13840 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13841 the 465 TCP ports.
13842
13843 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13844 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13845 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13846
13847 The common use of this option is expected to be
13848 .code
13849 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13850 .endd
13851 per RFC 8314.
13852 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13853 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13854
13855 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13856 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13857 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13858 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13859 connections via the daemon.)
13860
13861
13862
13863
13864 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13865 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13866 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13867 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13868 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13869 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13870 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13871 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13872 .code
13873 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13874 .endd
13875 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13876 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13877 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13878 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13879 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13880 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13881 .code
13882 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13883 .endd
13884 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13885 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13886 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13887 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13888 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13889
13890 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13891 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13892 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13893 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13894 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13895 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13896 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13897 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13898 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13899 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13900 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13901 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13902
13903 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13904 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13905 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13906 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13907 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13908
13909
13910
13911 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13912 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13913 .code
13914 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13915 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13916 .endd
13917 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13918 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13919 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13920 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13921
13922 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13923 .code
13924 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13925 .endd
13926 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13927 .code
13928 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13929 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13930 .endd
13931 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13932 IPv4 loopback address only:
13933 .code
13934 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13935 .endd
13936 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13937 .code
13938 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13939 .endd
13940 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13941
13942
13943
13944 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13945 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13946 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13947 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13948 treated as local.
13949
13950 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13951 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13952 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13953 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13954
13955 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13956 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13957 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13958 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13959 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13960 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13961 used for listening. Consider this example:
13962 .code
13963 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13964 192.168.53.235 ; \
13965 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13966
13967 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13968 .endd
13969 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13970 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13971 Exim is routing.
13972
13973 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13974 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13975 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13976 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13977 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13978 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13979 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13980 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13981
13982
13983
13984 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13985 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13986 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13987 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13988 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13989 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13990 details.
13991
13992
13993
13994
13995 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13996 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13997
13998 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13999 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14000 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14001 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14002
14003 .ilist
14004 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14005 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14006 .next
14007 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14008 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14009 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14010 .next
14011 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14012 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14013 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14014 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14015 settings.
14016 .endlist
14017
14018 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14019 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14020 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14021 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14022 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14023 listed in more than one group.
14024
14025 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14026 .table2
14027 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14028 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14029 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14030 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14031 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14032 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14033 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14034 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14035 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14036 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14037 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14038 .endtable
14039
14040
14041 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14042 .table2
14043 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14044 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14045 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14046 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14047 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14048 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14049 .endtable
14050
14051
14052
14053 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14054 .table2
14055 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14056 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14057 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14058 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14059 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14060 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14061 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14062 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14063 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14064 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14065 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14066 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14067 .endtable
14068
14069
14070
14071 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14072 .table2
14073 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14074 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14075 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14076 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14077 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14078 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14079 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14080 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14081 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14082 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14083 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14084 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14085 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14086 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14087 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14088 .endtable
14089
14090
14091
14092 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14093 .table2
14094 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14095 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14096 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14097 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14098 .endtable
14099
14100
14101
14102 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14103 .table2
14104 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14105 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14106 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14107 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14108 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14109 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14110 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14111 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14112 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14113 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14114 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14115 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14116 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14117 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14118 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14119 .endtable
14120
14121
14122
14123 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14124 .table2
14125 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14126 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14127 .endtable
14128
14129
14130
14131 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14132 .table2
14133 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14134 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14135 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14136 .endtable
14137
14138
14139
14140 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14141 .table2
14142 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14143 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14144 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14145 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14146 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14147 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14148 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14149 .endtable
14150
14151
14152
14153 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14154 .table2
14155 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14156 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14157 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14158 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14159 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14160 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14161 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14162 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14163 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14164 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14165 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14166 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14167 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14168 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14169 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14170 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14171 connection"
14172 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14173 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14174 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14175 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14176 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14177 .endtable
14178
14179
14180
14181 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14182 .table2
14183 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14184 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14185 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14186 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14187 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14188 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14189 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14190 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14191 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14192 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14193 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14194 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14195 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14196 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14197 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14198 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14199 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14200 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14201 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14202 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14203 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14204 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14205 words""&"
14206 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14207 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14208 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14209 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14210 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14211 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14212 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14213 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14214 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14215 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14216 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14217 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14218 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14219 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14220 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14221 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14222 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14223 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14224 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14225 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14226 .endtable
14227
14228
14229
14230 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14231 .table2
14232 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14233 item"
14234 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14235 item"
14236 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14237 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14238 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14239 .endtable
14240
14241
14242
14243 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14244 .table2
14245 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14246 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14247 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14248 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14249 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14250 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14251 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14252 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14253 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14254 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14255 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14256 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14257 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14258 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14259 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14260 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14261 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14262 .endtable
14263
14264
14265
14266 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14267 .table2
14268 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14269 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14270 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14271 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14272 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14273 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14274 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14275 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14276 .endtable
14277
14278
14279
14280 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14281 .table2
14282 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14283 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14284 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14285 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14286 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14287 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14288 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14289 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14290 .endtable
14291
14292
14293
14294
14295 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14296 .table2
14297 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14298 .endtable
14299
14300
14301
14302
14303
14304 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14305 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14306
14307 .table2
14308 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
14309 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14310 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14311 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14312 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14313 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14314 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14315 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14316 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14317 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14318 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14319 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14320 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14321 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14322 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14323 connection"
14324 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14325 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14326 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14327 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14328 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14329 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14330 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14331 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14332 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14333 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14334 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14335 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14336 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14337 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14338 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14339 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14340 .endtable
14341
14342
14343
14344 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14345 .table2
14346 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14347 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14348 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14349 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14350 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14351 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14352 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14353 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14354 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14355 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14356 .endtable
14357
14358
14359
14360 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14361 .table2
14362 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14363 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14364 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14365 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14366 words""&"
14367 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14368 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14369 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14370 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14371 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14372 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14373 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14374 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14375 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14376 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14377 .endtable
14378
14379
14380
14381 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14382 .table2
14383 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14384 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14385 directory"
14386 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14387 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14388 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14389 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14390 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14391 .endtable
14392
14393
14394
14395 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14396 .table2
14397 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14398 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14399 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14400 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14401 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14402 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14403 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14404 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14405 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14406 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14407 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14408 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14409 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14410 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14411 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14412 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14413 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14414 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14415 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14416 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14417 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14418 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14419 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14420 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14421 .endtable
14422
14423
14424
14425 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14426 .table2
14427 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14428 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14429 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14430 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14431 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14432 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14433 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14434 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14435 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14436 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14437 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14438 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14439 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14440 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14441 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14442 .endtable
14443
14444
14445
14446 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14447 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14448 &dagger;.
14449
14450 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14451 .cindex "8BITMIME"
14452 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14453 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14454 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14455 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14456 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14457 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14458 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14459
14460 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14461 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14462 It now defaults to true.
14463 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14464 .display
14465 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14466 .endd
14467
14468 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14469 .code
14470 log_selector = +8bitmime
14471 .endd
14472
14473 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14474 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14475 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14476 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14477 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14478 further details.
14479
14480 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14481 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14482 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14483 SMTP messages.
14484
14485 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14486 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14487 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14488 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14489 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14490
14491 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14492 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14493 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14494 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14495 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14496
14497 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14498 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14499 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14500 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14501
14502 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14503 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14504 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14505 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14506 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14507
14508 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14509 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14510 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14511 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14512 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14513 This option defines the ACL that,
14514 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14515 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14516 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14517 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14518
14519 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14520 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14521 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14522 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14523 of a received message.
14524 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14525
14526 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14527 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14528 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14529 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14530
14531 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14532 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14533 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14534 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14535
14536 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14537 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14538 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14539 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14540 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14541
14542
14543 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14544 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14545 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14546 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14547
14548 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14549 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14550 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14551 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14552 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14553
14554 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14555 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14556 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14557 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14558 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14559
14560 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14561 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14562 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14563 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14564 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14565
14566 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14567 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14568 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14569 further details.
14570
14571 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14572 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14573 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14574 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14575
14576 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14577 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14578 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14579 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14580
14581 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14582 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14583 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14584 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14585
14586 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14587 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14588 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14589 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14590
14591 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14592 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14593 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14594 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14595 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14596
14597 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14598 .cindex "admin user"
14599 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14600 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14601 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14602 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14603 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14604 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14605 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14606
14607 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14608 .cindex "domain literal"
14609 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14610 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14611 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14612 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14613
14614 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14615 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14616 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14617 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14618 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14619 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14620 the local host's IP addresses.
14621
14622
14623 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14624 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14625 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14626 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14627 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14628 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14629 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14630 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14631 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14632
14633 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14634 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14635 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14636 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14637 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14638 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14639 experiment if they wish.
14640
14641 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14642 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14643 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14644 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14645 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14646 suitable setting is:
14647 .code
14648 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14649 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14650 .endd
14651 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14652 .code
14653 dns_check_names_pattern =
14654 .endd
14655 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14656
14657
14658 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14659 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14660 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14661 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14662 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14663 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14664 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14665 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14666 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14667 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14668 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14669
14670 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14671 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14672 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14673 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14674 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14675 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14676
14677 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14678 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14679 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14680 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14681 .code
14682 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14683 .endd
14684 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14685 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14686 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14687 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14688
14689
14690 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14691 .cindex "thawing messages"
14692 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14693 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14694 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14695 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14696 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14697 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14698
14699 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14700 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14701 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14702
14703
14704 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14705 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14706 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14707 .code
14708 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14709 .endd
14710 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14711 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14712
14713
14714 .option bi_command main string unset
14715 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14716 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14717 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14718 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14719 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14720
14721
14722 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14723 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14724 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14725 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14726 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14727 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14728
14729
14730 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14731 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14732 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14733 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14734
14735 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14736 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14737 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14738 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14739 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14740 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14741 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14742 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14743 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14744 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14745
14746 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14747 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14748 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14749 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14750 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14751 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14752 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14753 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14754 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14755 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14756
14757 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14758 during reception of a message.
14759 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14760
14761 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14762
14763
14764 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14765 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14766 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14767 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14768
14769
14770 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14771 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14772 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14773 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14774 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14775 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14776 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14777 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14778 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14779
14780 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14781 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14782 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14783 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14784 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14785 messages.
14786
14787 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14788 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14789 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14790 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14791 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14792 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14793 connection. A typical setting might be:
14794 .code
14795 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14796 .endd
14797 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14798 .code
14799 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14800 .endd
14801 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14802 address.
14803
14804 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14805 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14806 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14807 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14808 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14809 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14810
14811
14812 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14813 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14814 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14815 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14816
14817
14818 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14819 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14820 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14821 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14822
14823
14824 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14825 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14826 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14827 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14828
14829
14830 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14831 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14832 callout verification. The default value is
14833 .code
14834 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14835 .endd
14836 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14837
14838
14839 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14840 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14841
14842
14843 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14844 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14845
14846 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14847 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14848 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14849 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14850 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14851 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14852 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14853 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14854 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14855 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14856
14857
14858 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14859 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14860
14861
14862 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14863 .cindex "checking disk space"
14864 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14865 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14866 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14867 message is accepted.
14868
14869 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14870 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14871 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14872 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14873 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14874 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14875 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14876 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14877
14878
14879 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14880 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14881 .code
14882 check_spool_space = 100M
14883 check_spool_inodes = 100
14884 .endd
14885 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14886 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14887 transit.
14888
14889 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14890 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14891 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14892
14893 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14894 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14895 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14896 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14897 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14898 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14899
14900 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14901 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14902 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14903
14904 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14905 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14906 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14907
14908 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14909 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14910 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14911 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14912
14913 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14914 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14915 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14916 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14917 these hosts.
14918 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14919
14920 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14921 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14922 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14923 administrative user.
14924 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14925
14926 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14927 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14928 .cindex memory debugging
14929 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14930 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14931 it should normally be left as default.
14932
14933 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14934 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14935 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14936 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14937 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14938 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14939
14940 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14941 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14942 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14943 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14944 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14945 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14946 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14947
14948 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14949 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14950
14951 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14952 .cindex "warning of delay"
14953 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14954 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14955 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14956 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14957 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14958 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14959 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14960 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14961 with
14962 .code
14963 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14964 .endd
14965 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14966 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14967 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14968 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14969 .code
14970 delay_warning = 6h
14971 .endd
14972 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14973 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14974 .code
14975 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14976 .endd
14977 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14978 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14979 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14980
14981 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14982 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14983 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14984 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14985 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14986 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14987 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14988 not sent. The default is:
14989 .code
14990 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14991 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14992 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14993 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14994 } {no}{yes}}
14995 .endd
14996 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14997 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14998 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14999 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15000
15001 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15002 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15003 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15004 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15005 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15006 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15007 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15008 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15009
15010 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15011 .cindex "load average"
15012 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15013 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15014 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15015 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15016 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15017
15018
15019 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15020 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15021 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15022 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15023 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15024 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15025 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15026 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15027
15028 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15029 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15030 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15031 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15032 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15033 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15034 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15035 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15036
15037 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15038 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15039 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15040 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15041
15042
15043 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15044 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15045 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15046 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15047 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15048 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15049 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15050
15051
15052 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15053 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15054 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15055 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15056 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15057 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15058
15059
15060 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15061 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15062 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15063 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15064 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15065 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15066 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15067 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15068 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15069 by a setting such as this:
15070 .code
15071 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15072 .endd
15073 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15074 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15075 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15076 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15077 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15078 options are applied after this global option.
15079
15080 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15081 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15082 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15083 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15084 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15085 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15086 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15087 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15088 value of this option. The default pattern is
15089 .code
15090 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15091 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15092 .endd
15093 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15094 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15095 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15096 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15097 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15098 empty string.
15099
15100 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15101 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15102 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15103
15104 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15105 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15106 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15107 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15108
15109 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15110 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15111 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15112 not do it internally.
15113 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15114 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15115
15116 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15117 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15118 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15119
15120
15121 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15122 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15123 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15124 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15125 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15126 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15127
15128 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15129
15130
15131 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15132 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15133 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15134 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15135 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15136 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15137 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15138 domain matches this list.
15139
15140 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15141 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15142 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15143
15144
15145 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15146 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15147 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15148 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15149 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15150 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15151 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15152 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15153 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15154 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15155 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15156 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15157 to set in them.
15158 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15159
15160
15161 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15162 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15163
15164
15165 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15166 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15167 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15168 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15169 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15170 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15171 match with this expanded domain list.
15172
15173 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15174 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15175 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15176 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15177 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15178 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15179
15180 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15181 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15182 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15183
15184 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15185 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15186 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15187 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15188 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15189
15190 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15191 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15192 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15193 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15194 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15195 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15196 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15197 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15198 on.
15199
15200 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15201
15202 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15203 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15204 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15205
15206
15207 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15208 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15209 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15210 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15211
15212 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15213 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15214 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15215 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15216 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15217 and accepted from, these hosts.
15218 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15219 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15220 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15221 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15222 are sent.
15223
15224 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15225 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15226 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15227 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15228 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15229 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15230 .code
15231 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15232 .endd
15233 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15234 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15235
15236 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15237 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15238 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15239 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15240 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15241 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15242 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15243 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15244 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15245
15246
15247 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15248 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15249 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15250 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15251 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15252 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15253 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15254 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15255 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15256
15257 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15258 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15259 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15260 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15261 are examined. For example:
15262 .code
15263 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15264 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15265 postmaster@mydomain.example
15266 .endd
15267 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15268 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15269 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15270 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15271 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15272 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15273 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15274
15275
15276 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15277 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15278 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15279 .display
15280 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15281 .endd
15282 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15283 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15284 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15285 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15286 overrides the default.
15287
15288 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15289 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15290 and warning messages. For example:
15291 .code
15292 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15293 .endd
15294 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15295 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15296 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15297 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15298 not used.
15299
15300
15301 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15302 .cindex events
15303 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15304 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15305
15306
15307 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15308 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15309 .cindex "Exim group"
15310 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15311 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15312 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15313 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15314 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15315 security issues.
15316
15317
15318 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15319 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15320 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15321 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15322 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15323 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15324 other place.
15325 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15326 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15327 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15328 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15329
15330
15331 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15332 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15333 .cindex "Exim user"
15334 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15335 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15336 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15337 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15338
15339 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15340 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15341 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15342 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15343
15344
15345 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15346 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15347 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15348 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15349
15350
15351 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15352 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15353
15354 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15355 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15356 .oindex "&%-t%&"
15357 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15358 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15359 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15360 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15361 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15362 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15363 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15364 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15365 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15366 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15367 addresses.
15368
15369
15370 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15371 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15372 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15373 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15374 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15375 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15376 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15377 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15378 retries.
15379
15380 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15381 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15382 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15383 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15384
15385
15386
15387 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15388 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15389 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15390 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15391 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15392 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15393 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15394 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15395 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15396 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15397 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15398 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15399 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15400 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15401 logging that you require.
15402
15403
15404 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15405 .cindex "HP-UX"
15406 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15407 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15408 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15409 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15410 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15411 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15412 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15413 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15414
15415 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15416 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15417 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15418 user's name.
15419
15420 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15421 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15422 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15423 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15424 .code
15425 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15426 gecos_name = $1
15427 .endd
15428
15429 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15430 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15431
15432
15433 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15434 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15435 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15436 implementations of TLS.
15437
15438
15439 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15440 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15441 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15442
15443 See
15444 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15445 for documentation.
15446
15447
15448
15449 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15450 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15451 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15452 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15453 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15454 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15455
15456
15457
15458 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15459 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15460 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15461 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15462 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15463 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15464 sections are rejected.
15465
15466
15467 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15468 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15469 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15470 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15471 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15472 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15473 zero means &"no limit"&.
15474
15475
15476
15477
15478 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15479 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15480 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15481 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15482 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15483 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15484 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15485 if you want to do semantic checking.
15486 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15487 set.
15488
15489
15490 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15491 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15492 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15493 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15494 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15495 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15496 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15497 .code
15498 helo_allow_chars = _
15499 .endd
15500 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15501
15502
15503 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15504 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15505 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15506 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15507 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15508 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15509 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15510 do.
15511
15512
15513 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15514 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15515 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15516 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15517 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15518 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15519 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15520 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15521 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15522 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15523 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15524 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15525
15526 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15527 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15528 EHLO command either:
15529
15530 .ilist
15531 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15532 .next
15533 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15534 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15535 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15536 calling host address, or
15537 .next
15538 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15539 .endlist
15540
15541 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15542 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15543 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15544
15545 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15546 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15547 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15548
15549 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15550 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15551 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15552 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15553 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15554 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15555 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15556 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15557 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15558 error.
15559
15560 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15561 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15562 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15563 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15564 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15565 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15566 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15567 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15568 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15569
15570 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15571 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15572 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15573 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15574 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15575
15576 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15577 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15578 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15579 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15580
15581
15582 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15583 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15584 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15585 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15586 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15587 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15588 default configuration file contains
15589 .code
15590 host_lookup = *
15591 .endd
15592 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15593 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15594
15595 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15596 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15597 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15598
15599 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15600 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15601 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15602 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15603 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15604 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15605
15606
15607 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15608 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15609 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15610 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15611 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15612 if you want.
15613
15614 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15615 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15616 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15617 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15618
15619
15620
15621 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15622 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15623 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15624 as soon as the connection is made.
15625 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15626 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15627 connections immediately.
15628
15629 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15630 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15631 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15632 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15633 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15634
15635
15636 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15637 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15638 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15639 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15640 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15641 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15642 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15643 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15644 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15645 .code
15646 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15647 .endd
15648 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15649
15650
15651
15652 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15653 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15654 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15655 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15656
15657
15658 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15659 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15660 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15661 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15662 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15663 records
15664 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15665 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15666
15667 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15668 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15669 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15670 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15671 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15672 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15673 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15674
15675
15676 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15677 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15678 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15679 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15680 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15681
15682
15683
15684 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15685 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15686 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15687 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15688 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15689 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15690
15691 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15692 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15693 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15694 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15695 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15696 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15697 for frozen messages. For example,
15698 .code
15699 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15700 .endd
15701 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15702 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15703 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15704 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15705 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15706 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15707
15708
15709 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15710 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15711 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15712 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15713 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15714 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15715 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15716 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15717 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15718 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15719
15720
15721 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15722 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15723
15724 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15725 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15726 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15727 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15728 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15729 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15730 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15731 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15732 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15733
15734 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15735 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15736
15737 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15738 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15739 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15740 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15741
15742 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15743 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15744 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15745 anymore.
15746
15747 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15748 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15749 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15750 details.
15751
15752
15753 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15754 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15755 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15756 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15757 logged.
15758
15759
15760 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15761 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15762 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15763 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15764 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15765 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15766 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15767 and constrained to be a directory.
15768
15769
15770 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15771 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15772 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15773 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15774 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15775 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15776 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15777 and constrained to be a file.
15778
15779
15780 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15781 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15782 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15783 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15784 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15785 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15786
15787
15788 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15789 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15790 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15791 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15792 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15793 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15794 identity to be proven.
15795
15796
15797 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15798 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15799 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15800 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15801 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15802
15803
15804 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15805 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15806 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15807 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15808 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15809 with LDAP support.
15810
15811
15812 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15813 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15814 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15815 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15816 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15817 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15818 to hard/demand.
15819
15820
15821 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15822 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15823 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15824 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15825 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15826 of SSL-on-connect.
15827 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15828 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15829 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15830
15831
15832 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15833 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15834 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15835 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15836 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15837 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15838 has been built with LDAP support.
15839
15840
15841
15842 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15843 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15844 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15845 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15846 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15847 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15848 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15849
15850 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15851 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15852 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15853
15854 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15855 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15856 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15857 and the default qualify domain.
15858
15859 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15860 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15861 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15862 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15863
15864 .cindex "envelope sender"
15865 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15866 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15867 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15868
15869 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15870 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15871 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15872
15873
15874
15875
15876 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15877 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15878 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15879 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15880 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15881 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15882 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15883 example, if
15884 .code
15885 local_from_prefix = *-
15886 .endd
15887 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15888 .code
15889 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15890 .endd
15891 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15892 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15893 qualify domain.
15894
15895
15896 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15897 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15898
15899
15900 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15901 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15902 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15903 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15904 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15905 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15906 &%local_interfaces%& is
15907 .code
15908 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15909 .endd
15910 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15911 .code
15912 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15913 .endd
15914
15915 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15916 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15917 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15918 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15919 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15920 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15921 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15922 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15923
15924
15925
15926 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15927 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15928 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15929 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15930 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15931 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15932 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15933 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15934
15935
15936
15937
15938 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15939 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15940 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15941 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15942 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15943 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15944 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15945 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15946 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15947 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15948 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15949 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15950 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15951 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15952 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15953
15954
15955
15956 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15957 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15958 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15959 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15960 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15961 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
15962 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15963 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15964 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15965 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15966 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15967 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15968 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15969 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15970 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15971
15972
15973 .option log_selector main string unset
15974 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15975 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15976 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15977 minus characters. For example:
15978 .code
15979 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15980 .endd
15981 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15982 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15983
15984
15985 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15986 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15987 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15988 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15989 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15990 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15991 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15992 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15993 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15994 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15995 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15996 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15997 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15998
15999
16000 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16001 .cindex "too many open files"
16002 .cindex "open files, too many"
16003 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16004 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16005 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16006 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16007 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16008 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16009 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16010 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16011 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16012 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16013 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16014 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16015
16016
16017 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16018 .cindex "length of login name"
16019 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16020 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16021 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16022 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16023 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16024 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16025
16026
16027 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16028 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16029 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16030 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16031 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16032 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16033 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16034 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16035
16036
16037 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16038 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16039 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16040 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16041 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16042 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16043 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16044
16045
16046 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16047 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16048 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16049 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16050 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16051 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16052 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16053 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16054 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16055 empty string, the option is ignored.
16056
16057
16058 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16059 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16060 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16061 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16062 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16063 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16064 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16065 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16066 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16067 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16068 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16069 colons will become hyphens.
16070
16071
16072 .option message_logs main boolean true
16073 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16074 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16075 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16076 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16077 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16078 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16079 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16080 which is not affected by this option.
16081
16082
16083 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16084 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16085 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16086 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16087 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16088 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16089 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16090 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16091 optionally followed by K or M.
16092
16093 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16094 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16095 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16096 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16097 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16098
16099 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16100 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16101 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16102 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16103 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16104 message that an individual transport can process.
16105
16106 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16107 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16108 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16109 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16110 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16111 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16112 some problems may result.
16113
16114 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16115 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16116 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16117
16118
16119 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16120 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16121 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16122 .code
16123 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16124 .endd
16125 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16126 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16127 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16128 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16129 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16130
16131
16132 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16133 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16134 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16135 contains a full description of this facility.
16136
16137
16138
16139 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16140 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16141 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16142 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16143 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16144
16145
16146 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16147 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16148 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16149 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16150 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16151 safety precaution.
16152
16153 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16154 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16155 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16156 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16157 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16158
16159 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16160 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16161 example is
16162 .code
16163 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16164 .endd
16165 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16166 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16167 transport driver.
16168
16169
16170 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
16171 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16172 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16173 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16174 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16175
16176 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16177 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16178 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16179 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16180 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16181 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16182 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16183
16184 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16185 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16186 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16187 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16188 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16189
16190 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16191
16192 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16193 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16194 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16195 some now infamous attacks.
16196
16197 Examples:
16198 .code
16199 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16200 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16201 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16202
16203 # Disable older protocol versions:
16204 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16205 .endd
16206
16207 Possible options may include:
16208 .ilist
16209 &`all`&
16210 .next
16211 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16212 .next
16213 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16214 .next
16215 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16216 .next
16217 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
16218 .next
16219 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16220 .next
16221 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16222 .next
16223 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16224 .next
16225 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16226 .next
16227 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16228 .next
16229 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16230 .next
16231 &`no_compression`&
16232 .next
16233 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16234 .next
16235 &`no_sslv2`&
16236 .next
16237 &`no_sslv3`&
16238 .next
16239 &`no_ticket`&
16240 .next
16241 &`no_tlsv1`&
16242 .next
16243 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
16244 .next
16245 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
16246 .next
16247 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16248 .next
16249 &`single_dh_use`&
16250 .next
16251 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16252 .next
16253 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16254 .next
16255 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16256 .next
16257 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16258 .next
16259 &`tls_d5_bug`&
16260 .next
16261 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16262 .endlist
16263
16264 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16265 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16266 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16267 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16268 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16269 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16270
16271
16272 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16273 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16274 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16275 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16276 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16277
16278
16279 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16280 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16281 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16282 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16283 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16284 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16285 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16286 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16287 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16288 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16289 an ACL.
16290
16291 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16292 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16293 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16294 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16295 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16296 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16297 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16298
16299
16300 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16301 .cindex "Perl"
16302 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16303 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16304
16305
16306 .option perl_startup main string unset
16307 .cindex "Perl"
16308 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16309 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16310
16311 .option perl_startup main boolean false
16312 .cindex "Perl"
16313 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16314
16315
16316 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16317 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16318 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16319 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16320 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16321 PostgreSQL support.
16322
16323
16324 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16325 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16326 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16327 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16328 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16329 to the host name:
16330 .code
16331 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16332 .endd
16333 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16334 spool directory.
16335 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16336 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16337 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16338
16339
16340 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16341 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16342 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16343 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16344 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16345 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16346 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16347 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16348 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16349
16350
16351 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16352 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16353 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16354 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16355 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16356 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16357 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16358 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16359
16360 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16361 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16362 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16363 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16364 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16365 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16366 volume of mail. Use with care!
16367
16368
16369 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16370 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16371 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16372 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16373 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16374 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16375 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16376 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16377 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16378 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16379
16380 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16381 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16382 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16383 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16384 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16385 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16386
16387
16388 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16389 .cindex "printing characters"
16390 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16391 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16392 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16393 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16394 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16395 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16396 characters.
16397
16398 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16399 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16400 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16401 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16402 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16403 standards.
16404
16405
16406 .option process_log_path main string unset
16407 .cindex "process log path"
16408 .cindex "log" "process log"
16409 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16410 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16411 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16412 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16413 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16414 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16415 different spool directories.
16416
16417
16418 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16419 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16420 .oindex "&%-M%&"
16421 .oindex "&%-R%&"
16422 .oindex "&%-q%&"
16423 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16424 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16425 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16426
16427
16428 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16429 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16430 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16431 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16432 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16433 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16434 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16435 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16436 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16437
16438 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16439 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16440 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16441 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16442 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16443 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16444 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16445
16446
16447 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16448 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16449 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16450
16451
16452
16453 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16454 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16455 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16456 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16457 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16458 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16459 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16460 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16461
16462
16463 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16464 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16465 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
16466 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16467 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16468 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16469 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16470
16471
16472 .option queue_only main boolean false
16473 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16474 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16475 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16476 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16477 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16478 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16479
16480 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16481 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16482 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16483 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16484
16485
16486 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16487 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16488 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16489 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16490 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16491 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16492 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16493 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16494 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16495 .code
16496 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16497 .endd
16498 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16499 &_/some/file_& exists.
16500
16501
16502 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16503 .cindex "load average"
16504 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16505 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16506 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16507 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16508 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16509 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16510 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16511 false.
16512
16513 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16514 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16515 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16516 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16517
16518
16519 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16520 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16521 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16522 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16523 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16524 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16525 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16526 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16527 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16528 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16529 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16530 re-evaluated for each message.
16531
16532
16533 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16534 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16535 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16536 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16537 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16538 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16539
16540
16541 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16542 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16543 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16544 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16545 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16546 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16547 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16548 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16549 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16550 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16551 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16552 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16553 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16554
16555
16556
16557 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16558 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16559 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16560 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16561 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16562 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16563 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16564 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16565 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16566
16567 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16568 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16569 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16570 the daemon's command line.
16571
16572 .cindex queues named
16573 .cindex "named queues"
16574 To set limits for different named queues use
16575 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16576
16577 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16578 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16579 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16580 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16581 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16582 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16583 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16584 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16585 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16586 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16587 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16588 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16589 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16590 &%queue_domains%&.
16591
16592
16593 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16594 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16595 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16596 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16597 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16598 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16599 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16600
16601 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16602 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16603 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16604 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16605 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16606 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16607 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16608 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16609 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16610 header lines.
16611 .new
16612 The default setting is:
16613
16614 .code
16615 received_header_text = Received: \
16616 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16617 {${if def:sender_ident \
16618 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16619 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16620 by $primary_hostname \
16621 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16622 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16623 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16624 ${if def:sender_address \
16625 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16626 id $message_exim_id\
16627 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16628 .endd
16629 .wen
16630
16631 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16632 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16633 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16634 header lines such as the following:
16635 .code
16636 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16637 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16638 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16639 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16640 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16641 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16642 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16643 .endd
16644 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16645 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16646 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16647 message was accepted.
16648
16649
16650 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16651 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16652 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16653 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16654 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16655 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16656 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16657 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16658
16659
16660 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16661 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16662 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16663 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16664 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16665 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16666 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16667 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16668 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16669 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16670 option was not set.
16671
16672
16673 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16674 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16675 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16676 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16677 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16678 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16679 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16680 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16681 done.
16682
16683 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16684 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16685 RCPT commands in a single message.
16686
16687
16688 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16689 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16690 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16691 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16692 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16693 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16694 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16695
16696
16697 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16698 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16699 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16700 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16701 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16702 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16703 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16704 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16705 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16706 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16707 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16708 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16709 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16710 tagged with its process id.
16711
16712 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16713 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16714 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16715 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16716 is received.
16717
16718 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16719 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16720 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16721 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16722 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16723 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16724 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16725 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16726 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16727 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16728 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16729
16730 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16731 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16732 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16733 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16734
16735
16736 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16737 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16738 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16739 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16740 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16741 .code
16742 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16743 .endd
16744 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16745 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16746
16747
16748 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16749 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16750 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16751 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16752 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16753 past failures.
16754
16755
16756 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16757 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16758 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16759 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16760 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16761 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16762 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16763 the default value.
16764
16765
16766 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16767 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16768 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16769 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16770 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16771 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16772 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16773 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16774 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16775 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16776
16777
16778 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16779 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16780
16781
16782 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16783 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16784 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16785 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16786 an item in the list.
16787 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16788 for the system.
16789
16790 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16791 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16792 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16793 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16794 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16795
16796
16797 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16798 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16799 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16800 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16801 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16802 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16803 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16804 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16805 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16806 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16807
16808 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16809 .cindex "environment"
16810 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16811 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16812 default list is empty,
16813
16814
16815 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16816 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16817 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16818 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16819 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16820 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16821 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16822
16823
16824
16825 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16826 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16827 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16828 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16829 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16830 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16831 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16832 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16833 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16834 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16835 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16836
16837
16838
16839 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16840 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16841 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16842 .cindex "inetd"
16843 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16844 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16845 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16846 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16847 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16848 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16849
16850 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16851 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16852 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16853 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16854
16855
16856 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16857 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16858 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16859 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16860 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16861 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16862 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16863 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16864
16865 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16866 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16867 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16868 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16869 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16870 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16871 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16872 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16873
16874
16875 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16876 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16877 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16878 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16879 live with.
16880
16881
16882 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16883 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16884 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16885 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16886 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16887 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16888 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16889 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16890 . the option name to split.
16891
16892 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16893 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16894 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16895 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16896 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16897 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16898 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16899 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16900 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16901 seen).
16902
16903
16904 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16905 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16906 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16907 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16908 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16909 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16910 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16911 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16912 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16913 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16914 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16915
16916 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16917 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16918 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16919 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16920 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16921 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16922
16923
16924
16925 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16926 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16927 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16928 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16929 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16930 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16931 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16932 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16933 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16934 to all messages received in the same connection.
16935
16936 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16937 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16938 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16939 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16940
16941
16942 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16943
16944 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16945 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16946 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16947 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16948 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16949 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16950 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16951 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16952 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
16953 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16954 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16955 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16956 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16957
16958
16959 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16960 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16961 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16962 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16963 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16964 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16965 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16966 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16967 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16968 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16969 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16970 individual host.
16971
16972 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16973 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16974 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16975 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16976
16977
16978 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16979 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16980 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16981 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16982 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16983 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16984 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16985 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16986 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16987
16988 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16989 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16990 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16991 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16992
16993 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16994 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16995 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16996 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16997 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16998 For example:
16999 .code
17000 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17001 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17002 .endd
17003
17004 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17005 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17006 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17007 &%helo_data%& value.
17008
17009 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17010 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17011 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17012 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17013 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17014 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17015 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17016 .code
17017 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17018 $version_number $tod_full
17019 .endd
17020 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17021 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17022 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17023 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17024 multiline response).
17025
17026
17027 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17028 .cindex "checking disk space"
17029 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17030 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17031 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17032 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17033 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17034 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17035 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17036
17037
17038 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17039 .cindex "connection backlog"
17040 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17041 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17042 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17043 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17044 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17045 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17046 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17047 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17048 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17049 attacks by SYN flooding.
17050
17051
17052 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17053 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17054 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17055 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17056 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17057 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17058 fewer, but they still exist.
17059
17060 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17061 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17062 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17063 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17064 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17065 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17066 does detect many instances.
17067
17068 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17069 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17070 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17071 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17072
17073
17074
17075 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17076 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17077 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17078 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17079 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17080 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17081 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17082 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17083 example:
17084 .code
17085 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17086 $sender_host_address
17087 .endd
17088 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17089 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17090 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17091 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17092 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17093 the command.
17094
17095
17096 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17097 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17098 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17099 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17100 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17101
17102
17103 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17104 .cindex "load average"
17105 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17106 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17107 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17108 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17109 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17110 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17111
17112
17113
17114 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17115 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17116 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17117 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17118 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17119 .code
17120 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17121 .endd
17122 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17123 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17124 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17125 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17126 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17127
17128 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17129 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17130 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17131 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17132 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17133 not count towards the limit.
17134
17135
17136
17137 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17138 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17139 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17140 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17141 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17142 that subvert web
17143 clients
17144 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17145 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17146
17147
17148
17149 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17150 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17151 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17152 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17153 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17154 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17155 recipients.
17156
17157 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17158 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17159 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17160 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17161
17162 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17163 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17164 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17165 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17166 values:
17167
17168 .ilist
17169 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17170 .next
17171 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17172 fractional parts are allowed here.
17173 .next
17174 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17175 .next
17176 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17177 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17178 .endlist
17179
17180 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17181 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17182 .code
17183 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17184 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17185 .endd
17186 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17187 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17188 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17189 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17190
17191
17192 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17193 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17194
17195
17196 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17197 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17198
17199
17200 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17201 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17202 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17203 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17204 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17205 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17206 the message is abandoned.
17207 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17208 .code
17209 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17210 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17211 .endd
17212 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17213 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17214
17215 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17216 expanded before use and may depend on
17217 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17218
17219
17220 .oindex "&%-os%&"
17221 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17222 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17223 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17224 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17225 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17226
17227
17228 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17229 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17230 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17231
17232
17233 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17234 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17235 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17236 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17237 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17238 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17239 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17240 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17241 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17242 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17243 .code
17244 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17245 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17246 .endd
17247
17248
17249 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17250 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17251 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17252 the availability thereof is advertised in
17253 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17254 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17255
17256
17257 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17258 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17259 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17260 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17261
17262
17263
17264 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17265 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17266 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17267
17268
17269
17270 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17271 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17272 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17273 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17274 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17275 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17276 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17277 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17278 arrival of the message.
17279
17280 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17281 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17282 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17283 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17284 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17285
17286 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17287 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17288 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17289 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17290 automatically deleted.
17291
17292 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17293 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17294 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17295 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17296 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17297 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17298 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17299 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17300 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17301
17302
17303 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17304 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17305 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17306 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17307 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17308 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17309 &$primary_hostname$&.
17310
17311 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17312 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17313 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17314 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17315 as failures in the configuration file.
17316
17317 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17318 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17319
17320 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17321 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17322 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17323 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17324 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17325 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17326 option.
17327
17328 The following variables will not have useful values:
17329 .code
17330 $max_received_linelength
17331 $body_linecount
17332 $body_zerocount
17333 .endd
17334
17335 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17336 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17337 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17338 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17339
17340 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17341 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17342 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17343
17344 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17345 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17346 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17347 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17348
17349 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17350 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17351 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17352 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17353 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17354 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17355
17356 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17357 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17358 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17359 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17360 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17361 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17362 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17363
17364
17365 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17366 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17367 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17368 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17369 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17370 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17371 domain causes a syntax error.
17372 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17373 syntax checking.
17374
17375
17376 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17377 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17378 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17379 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17380 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17381 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17382 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17383 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17384 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17385 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17386 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17387 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17388
17389
17390 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17391 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17392 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17393 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17394 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17395 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17396 details of Exim's logging.
17397
17398
17399 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17400 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17401 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17402 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17403 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17404 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17405 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17406
17407
17408
17409 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17410 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17411 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17412 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17413 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17414
17415
17416
17417 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17418 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17419 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17420 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17421 details of Exim's logging.
17422
17423
17424 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17425 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17426 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17427 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17428 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17429 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17430 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17431 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17432 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17433 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17434 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17435 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17436
17437
17438 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17439 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17440 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17441 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17442 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17443 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17444
17445
17446 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17447 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17448 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17449 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17450 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17451
17452 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17453 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17454 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17455 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17456 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17457
17458 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17459 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17460 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17461 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17462 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17463 contains the pipe command.
17464
17465
17466 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17467 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17468 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17469 is used in a system filter.
17470
17471
17472 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17473 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17474 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17475 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17476 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17477 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17478 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17479 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17480 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17481 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17482
17483 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17484 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17485 transport option overrides.
17486
17487
17488 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17489 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17490 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17491 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17492 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17493 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17494 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17495 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17496 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17497 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17498 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17499 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17500 TCP_NODELAY.
17501
17502
17503 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17504 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17505 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17506 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17507 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17508 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17509 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17510 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17511 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17512 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17513
17514 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17515 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17516 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17517
17518
17519 .option timezone main string unset
17520 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17521 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17522 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17523 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17524 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17525 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17526 .code
17527 timezone = UTC
17528 .endd
17529 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17530 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17531 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17532 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17533 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17534 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17535
17536
17537 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17538 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17539 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17540 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17541 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17542 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17543 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17544 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17545 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17546 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17547 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17548
17549
17550 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17551 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17552 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17553 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17554 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17555 needed.
17556 The server's private key is also
17557 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17558 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17559
17560 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17561 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17562 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17563 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17564
17565 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17566 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) >to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17567
17568 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17569 when a list of more than one
17570 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17571
17572 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17573 when a list of more than one file is used.
17574
17575 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17576 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17577 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17578 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17579
17580 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17581 generated for every connection.
17582
17583 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17584 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17585 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17586 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17587 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17588
17589 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17590
17591 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17592 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17593 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17594
17595 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17596
17597
17598 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17599 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17600 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17601 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17602 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17603 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17604
17605 The value must be at least 1024.
17606
17607 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17608 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17609 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17610
17611 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17612 number.
17613
17614 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17615 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17616 larger prime than requested.
17617
17618
17619 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17620 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17621 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17622 to be used by Exim.
17623
17624 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17625 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17626 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17627 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17628
17629 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17630 then it names a file from which DH
17631 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17632 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17633 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17634 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17635 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17636 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17637
17638 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17639 loaded by Exim.
17640
17641 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17642 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17643 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17644 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17645
17646 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17647 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17648
17649 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17650 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17651 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17652
17653 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17654 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17655 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17656 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17657 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17658
17659 The available standard primes are:
17660 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17661 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17662 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17663 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17664
17665 The available additional primes are:
17666 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17667
17668 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17669 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17670 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17671 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17672 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17673
17674 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17675 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17676 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17677
17678 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17679 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17680 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17681 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17682 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17683 userbase.
17684
17685 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17686 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17687 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17688 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17689 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17690 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17691 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17692
17693
17694 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17695 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17696 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17697 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17698
17699 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17700 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17701 for valid selections.
17702
17703 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17704 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17705 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17706
17707 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17708
17709
17710 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17711 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17712 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17713 This option
17714 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17715 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17716 Certificate Authority.
17717
17718 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17719
17720 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17721 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17722 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17723
17724
17725 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17726 .cindex SSMTP
17727 .cindex SMTPS
17728 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17729 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17730 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17731 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17732
17733
17734
17735 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17736 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17737 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17738 files which contains the server's private keys.
17739 If this option is unset, or if
17740 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17741 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17742 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17743
17744 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17745
17746
17747 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17748 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17749 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17750 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17751 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17752 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17753 TLS session.
17754
17755
17756 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17757 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17758 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17759 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17760 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17761 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17762 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17763 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17764 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17765 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17766 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17767
17768
17769 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17770 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17771 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17772 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17773
17774
17775 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17776 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17777 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17778 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17779 word "system"
17780 or the absolute path to
17781 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17782 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17783
17784 The "system" value for the option will use a
17785 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17786 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17787 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17788 must be specified.
17789
17790 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17791 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17792
17793 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17794 explicitly
17795 either by file or directory
17796 are added to those given by the system default location.
17797
17798 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17799 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17800 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17801 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17802 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17803 use the explicit directory version.
17804
17805 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17806
17807 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17808 being unset.
17809
17810
17811 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17812 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17813 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17814 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17815 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17816 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17817 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17818 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17819
17820 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17821 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17822 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17823 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17824 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17825 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17826 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17827
17828 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17829 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17830 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17831 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17832 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17833 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17834 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17835 certificate"&.
17836
17837 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17838 certificates.
17839
17840
17841 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17842 .cindex "trusted groups"
17843 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17844 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17845 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17846 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17847 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17848 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17849 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17850 are trusted.
17851
17852 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17853 .cindex "trusted users"
17854 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17855 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17856 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17857 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17858 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17859 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17860 Exim user are trusted.
17861
17862 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17863 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17864 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17865 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17866 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17867 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17868 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17869 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17870 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17871 &%-F%& option.
17872
17873 .option unknown_username main string unset
17874 See &%unknown_login%&.
17875
17876 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17877 .cindex "trusted users"
17878 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17879 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17880 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17881 .cindex "envelope sender"
17882 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17883 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17884 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17885 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17886 is used) is ignored.
17887
17888 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17889 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17890 .code
17891 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17892 .endd
17893 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17894 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17895 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17896 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17897 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17898 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17899 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17900 followed by a hyphen
17901 by a setting like this:
17902 .code
17903 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17904 .endd
17905 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17906 restriction, you can use
17907 .code
17908 untrusted_set_sender = *
17909 .endd
17910 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17911 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17912 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17913 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17914 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17915 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17916 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17917 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17918
17919 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17920 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17921 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17922 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17923 sender address.
17924
17925
17926 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17927 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17928 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17929 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17930 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17931 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17932 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17933 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17934 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17935 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17936 .code
17937 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17938 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17939 .endd
17940 The pattern can be seen by running
17941 .code
17942 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17943 .endd
17944 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17945 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17946 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17947 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17948 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17949 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17950
17951
17952 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17953 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17954
17955
17956 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17957 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17958 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17959 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17960 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17961 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17962 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17963 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17964
17965
17966 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17967 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17968 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17969 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17970 .ecindex IIDconfima
17971 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17972
17973
17974
17975
17976 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17977 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17978
17979 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17980 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17981 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17982 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17983 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17984
17985 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17986 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17987 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17988 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17989 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17990
17991
17992
17993 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17994 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17995 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17996 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17997 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17998 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17999 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18000
18001 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18002 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18003 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18004 routers, and the eventual transport.
18005
18006 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18007 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18008 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18009 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18010 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18011
18012 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18013 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18014 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18015 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18016 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18017
18018 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18019 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18020 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18021 .code
18022 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18023 .endd
18024 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18025 .code
18026 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18027 .endd
18028 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18029 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18030
18031 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18032 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18033 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18034 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18035 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18036 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18037 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18038
18039
18040
18041 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18042 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
18043 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18044 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18045 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18046 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18047 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18048 routing.
18049
18050
18051
18052 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18053 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18054 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18055 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18056 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18057 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18058 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18059 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18060 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18061 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18062 you could put:
18063 .code
18064 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18065 .endd
18066 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18067 and
18068 .code
18069 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18070 .endd
18071 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18072 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18073 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18074 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18075
18076
18077 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18078 .cindex "case of local parts"
18079 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18080 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18081 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18082 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18083 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18084 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18085 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18086 more details.
18087
18088 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18089 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18090 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18091 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18092 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18093 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18094 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18095 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18096 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18097
18098 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18099 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18100 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18101 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18102
18103
18104
18105 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18106 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18107 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18108 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18109 .vindex "&$home$&"
18110 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18111 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18112 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18113 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18114 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18115 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18116 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18117 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18118 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18119 the router is skipped.
18120
18121 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18122 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18123 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18124 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18125 setting to achieve this. For example:
18126 .code
18127 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18128 .endd
18129 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18130 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18131 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18132
18133
18134
18135 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18136 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18137 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18138 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18139 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18140 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18141 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18142 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18143
18144 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18145 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18146
18147 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18148 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18149
18150 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18151 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18152 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18153 .code
18154 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18155 .endd
18156 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18157 .code
18158 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18159 .endd
18160
18161 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18162 .code
18163 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18164 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18165 condition = foobar
18166 .endd
18167
18168 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18169 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18170 be specified using &%condition%&.
18171
18172 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18173 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18174 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18175 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18176 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18177 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18178 Router rules processing behavior.
18179
18180 This is best illustrated in an example:
18181 .code
18182 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18183 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18184
18185 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18186 true {yes} {no}}
18187
18188 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18189 {yes} {no}}
18190 .endd
18191 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18192 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18193 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18194 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18195 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18196 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18197 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18198 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18199
18200 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18201 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18202 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18203 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18204 string characters.
18205
18206 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18207 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18208 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18209 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18210 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18211
18212
18213 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18214 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18215 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18216 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18217 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18218 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18219 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18220 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18221 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18222 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18223 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18224 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18225 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18226 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18227
18228
18229
18230 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18231 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18232 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18233 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18234 transport option of the same name.
18235
18236 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18237 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18238 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18239 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18240 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18241 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18242 the dnssec request bit set.
18243 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18244
18245 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18246 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18247 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18248 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18249 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18250 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18251 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18252 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18253 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18254
18255
18256 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18257 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18258 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18259 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18260 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18261 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18262 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18263 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18264
18265
18266
18267 .option driver routers string unset
18268 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18269 to be used.
18270
18271
18272 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18273 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18274 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18275 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18276 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18277 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18278 Not effective on redirect routers.
18279
18280
18281
18282 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18283 .cindex "envelope sender"
18284 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18285 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18286 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18287 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18288 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18289 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18290 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18291
18292 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18293 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18294 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18295 setting.
18296
18297 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18298 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18299 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18300 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18301
18302 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18303 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18304 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18305 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18306 settings:
18307 .code
18308 errors_to =
18309 errors_to = ""
18310 .endd
18311 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18312 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18313 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18314 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18315 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18316
18317 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18318 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18319 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18320 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18321 setting &%return_path%&.
18322
18323 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18324 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18325 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18326
18327
18328
18329 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18330 .cindex "address" "testing"
18331 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18332 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18333 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18334 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18335 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18336 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18337 on for the system alias file.
18338 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18339 are evaluated.
18340
18341 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18342 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18343 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18344
18345
18346
18347 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18348 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18349 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18350 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18351
18352
18353
18354 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18355 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18356 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18357
18358
18359
18360 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18361 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18362 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18363
18364
18365
18366 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18367 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18368 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18369 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18370 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18371 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18372 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18373 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18374 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18375
18376 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18377 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18378 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18379 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18380 transport for further details.
18381
18382
18383 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18384 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18385 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18386 .cindex "transport" "local"
18387 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18388 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18389 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18390 process.
18391 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18392 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18393 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18394 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18395 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18396
18397
18398
18399 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18400 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18401 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18402 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18403 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18404 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18405 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18406 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18407 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18408 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18409 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18410 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18411 &"see"& the added header lines.
18412
18413 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18414 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18415 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18416 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18417
18418 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18419 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18420
18421 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18422 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18423
18424 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18425 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18426 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18427 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18428 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18429 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18430 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18431 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18432 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18433 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18434
18435
18436
18437 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18438 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18439 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18440 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18441 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18442 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18443 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18444 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18445 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18446 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18447 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18448 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18449 &"see"& the original header lines.
18450
18451 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18452 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18453 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18454 errors.
18455
18456 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18457 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18458
18459 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18460 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18461
18462 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18463 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18464 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18465 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18466
18467 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18468 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18469 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18470
18471
18472
18473 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18474 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18475 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18476 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18477 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18478 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18479 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18480 like
18481 .code
18482 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18483 .endd
18484 by setting
18485 .code
18486 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18487 .endd
18488 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18489 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18490 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18491 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18492 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18493 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18494
18495 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18496 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18497 .code
18498 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18499 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18500 .endd
18501 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18502 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18503
18504 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18505 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18506 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18507 domain that is being routed.
18508
18509 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18510 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18511 checked.
18512
18513 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18514 .cindex "additional groups"
18515 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18516 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18517 .cindex "transport" "local"
18518 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18519 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18520 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18521 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18522 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18523
18524
18525
18526 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18527 .cindex affix "router precondition"
18528 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18529 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18530 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18531 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18532 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18533 evaluated.
18534
18535 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18536 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18537 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18538 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18539 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18540 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18541 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18542 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18543 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18544
18545 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18546 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18547 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18548 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18549 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18550 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18551 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18552 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18553 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18554 the relevant transport.
18555
18556 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18557 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18558 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18559 callout.
18560
18561 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18562 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18563 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18564 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18565 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18566 .code
18567 real_localuser:
18568 driver = accept
18569 local_part_prefix = real-
18570 check_local_user
18571 transport = local_delivery
18572 .endd
18573 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18574 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18575 .code
18576 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18577 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18578 .endd
18579
18580 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18581 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18582 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18583 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18584
18585
18586 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18587 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18588
18589
18590
18591 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18592 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18593 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18594 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18595 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18596 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18597 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18598 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18599 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18600 &%username-foo%&.
18601
18602
18603 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18604 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18605
18606
18607
18608 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18609 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18610 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18611 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18612 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18613 are evaluated, and
18614 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18615 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18616 example:
18617 .code
18618 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18619 .endd
18620 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18621 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18622 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18623 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18624 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18625 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18626 each virtual domain:
18627 .code
18628 postmaster:
18629 driver = redirect
18630 local_parts = postmaster
18631 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18632 .endd
18633
18634
18635 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18636 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18637 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18638 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18639 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18640 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18641 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18642 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18643 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18644 redirect addresses.
18645
18646
18647
18648 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18649 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18650 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18651 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18652 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18653 delivery to be deferred.
18654
18655 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18656 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18657 .oindex "&%self%&"
18658 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18659 means of the setting
18660 .code
18661 self = pass
18662 .endd
18663 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18664 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18665 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18666
18667 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18668 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18669 controls what happens next.
18670
18671
18672 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18673 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18674 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18675 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18676 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18677 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18678 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18679 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18680
18681 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18682 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18683 applies to all of them.
18684
18685
18686
18687 .option pass_router routers string unset
18688 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18689 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18690 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18691 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18692 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18693 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18694 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18695 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18696 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18697 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18698
18699
18700
18701 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18702 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18703 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18704 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18705 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18706 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18707
18708 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18709 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18710 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18711 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18712
18713
18714
18715 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18716 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18717 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18718 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18719 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18720 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18721 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18722
18723 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18724 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18725 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18726 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18727 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18728
18729 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18730 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18731 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18732 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18733 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18734
18735 .cindex "NFS"
18736 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18737 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18738 unavailable.
18739
18740 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18741 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18742 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18743 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18744 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18745 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18746 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18747 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18748
18749 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18750 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18751 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18752 operates as follows:
18753
18754 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18755 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18756 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18757 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18758 used. For example:
18759 .code
18760 require_files = mail:/some/file
18761 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18762 .endd
18763 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18764 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18765
18766 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18767 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18768 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18769 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18770
18771 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18772 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18773 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18774 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18775 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18776
18777 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18778 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18779 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18780 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18781 check again in that process.
18782
18783 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18784 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18785 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18786 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18787 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18788 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18789 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18790 .code
18791 require_files = +/some/file
18792 .endd
18793 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18794 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18795 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18796
18797
18798
18799 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18800 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18801 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18802 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18803 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18804 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18805 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18806 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18807 latter kind.
18808
18809 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18810 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18811 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18812 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18813 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18814 same name.
18815
18816 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18817 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18818 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18819
18820
18821
18822 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18823 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18824 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18825 .vindex "&$home$&"
18826 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18827 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18828 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18829 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18830 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18831 cause the router to defer.
18832
18833 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18834 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18835 place.
18836 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18837 are evaluated.)
18838 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18839 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18840
18841 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18842 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18843 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18844 of these values that is set:
18845
18846 .ilist
18847 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18848 .next
18849 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18850 .next
18851 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18852 .next
18853 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18854 .endlist
18855
18856 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18857 router, but not for the transport.
18858
18859
18860
18861 .option self routers string freeze
18862 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18863 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18864 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18865 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18866 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18867 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18868 of remote hosts.
18869 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18870 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18871 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18872 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18873 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18874
18875 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18876 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18877 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18878 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18879 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18880 cases:
18881
18882 .vlist
18883 .vitem &%defer%&
18884 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18885
18886 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18887 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18888 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18889 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18890
18891 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18892 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18893 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18894 rewritten.
18895
18896 .vitem &%pass%&
18897 .oindex "&%more%&"
18898 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18899 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18900 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18901 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18902 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18903 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18904 combination
18905 .code
18906 self = pass
18907 no_more
18908 .endd
18909 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18910 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18911 be passed to the next router.
18912
18913 .vitem &%fail%&
18914 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18915
18916 .vitem &%send%&
18917 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18918 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18919 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18920 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18921 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18922 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18923 .endlist
18924
18925
18926
18927 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18928 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18929 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18930 address matches something on the list.
18931 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18932 are evaluated.
18933
18934 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18935 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18936 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18937 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18938 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18939 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18940 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18941 matters.
18942
18943
18944 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18945 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18946 .cindex "packet radio"
18947 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18948 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18949 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18950 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18951 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18952 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18953 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18954 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18955
18956 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18957 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18958 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18959 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18960 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18961 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18962 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18963 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18964 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18965 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18966 .code
18967 translate_ip_address = \
18968 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18969 {$value}fail}}
18970 .endd
18971 The file would contain lines like
18972 .code
18973 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18974 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18975 .endd
18976 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18977 are doing.
18978
18979
18980
18981 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18982 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18983 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18984 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18985 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18986 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18987 delivery is deferred.
18988
18989 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18990 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18991 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18992
18993
18994
18995 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18996 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18997 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18998 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18999 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19000 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19001 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19002 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19003 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19004 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19005 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19006 environment.
19007
19008
19009
19010
19011 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19012 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19013 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19014 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19015 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19016 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19017 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19018 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19019 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19020 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19021
19022 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19023 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19024 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19025 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19026 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19027
19028 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19029 environment.
19030
19031
19032
19033
19034 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19035 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19036 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19037 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19038 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19039 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19040 delivery to be deferred.
19041
19042 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19043 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19044 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19045 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19046 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19047 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19048
19049 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19050 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19051 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19052 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19053 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19054 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19055 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19056 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19057
19058 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19059 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19060 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19061 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19062 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19063 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19064 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19065 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19066 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19067 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19068
19069 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19070 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19071 subsequent routers.
19072
19073
19074 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19075 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19076 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19077 .cindex "transport" "local"
19078 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19079 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19080 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19081 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19082 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19083 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19084 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19085 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19086 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19087 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19088 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19089 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19090
19091
19092
19093 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19094 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19095 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19096
19097
19098 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19099 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19100 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
19101 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19102 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19103 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19104 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19105 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19106 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19107 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19108
19109 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19110 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19111 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19112 user or group.
19113
19114
19115 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19116 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19117 addresses,
19118 delivering in cutthrough mode
19119 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19120 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19121 are evaluated.
19122 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19123
19124
19125 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19126 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19127 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19128 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19129 are evaluated.
19130 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19131 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19132 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19133
19134
19135
19136
19137
19138
19139 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19140 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19141
19142 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19143 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19144 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19145 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19146 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19147 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19148 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19149 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19150 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19151 .code
19152 localusers:
19153 driver = accept
19154 domains = mydomain.example
19155 check_local_user
19156 transport = local_delivery
19157 .endd
19158 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19159 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19160 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19161 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19162
19163
19164
19165
19166
19167
19168 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19170
19171 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19172 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19173 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19174 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19175 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19176 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19177
19178 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19179 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19180 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19181 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19182 records.
19183
19184 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19185 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19186 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19187 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19188 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19189 generic option, the router declines.
19190
19191 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19192 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19193 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19194
19195 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19196 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19197 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19198 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19199 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19200 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19201
19202
19203 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19204 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19205 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19206 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19207 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19208 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19209
19210 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19211 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19212 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19213 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19214 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19215 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19216 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19217 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19218 case routing fails.
19219
19220
19221 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19222 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19223 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19224 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19225 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19226
19227 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19228 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19229
19230 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19231 .ilist
19232 The domain does not exist in DNS
19233 .next
19234 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19235 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19236 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19237 .next
19238 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19239 .next
19240 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19241 .next
19242 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19243 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19244 .next
19245 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19246 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19247 .next
19248 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19249 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19250 .next
19251 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19252 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19253 .endlist
19254
19255
19256
19257
19258 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19259 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19260 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19261
19262 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19263 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19264 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19265 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19266 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19267 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19268 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19269
19270
19271 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19272 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19273 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19274 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19275 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19276 required. For example,
19277 .code
19278 check_srv = smtp
19279 .endd
19280 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19281 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19282 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19283 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19284 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19285 normal way.
19286
19287 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19288 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19289 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19290 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19291 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19292 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19293
19294 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19295 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19296 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19297 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19298 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19299 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19300 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19301 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19302
19303 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19304 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19305
19306
19307
19308
19309 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19310 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19311 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19312 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19313 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19314 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19315 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19316 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19317 also being queued.
19318
19319
19320 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19321 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19322 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19323 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19324 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19325 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19326 only A records are used.
19327
19328 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19329 .cindex IPv4 preference
19330 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19331 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19332 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19333 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19334 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19335
19336 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19337 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19338 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19339 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19340 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19341 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19342 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19343 setting:
19344 .code
19345 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19346 .endd
19347 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19348 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19349 the address record.
19350
19351
19352 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19353 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19354 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19355 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19356
19357
19358
19359
19360 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19361 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19362 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19363 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19364 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19365 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19366 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19367 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19368 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19369 &'resolv.conf'&.
19370
19371
19372
19373 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19374 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19375 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19376 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19377 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19378 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19379 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19380 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19381 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19382 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19383 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19384
19385 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19386 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19387 sense.
19388
19389 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19390 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19391 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19392 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19393 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19394 header rewriting.
19395
19396
19397 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19398 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19399 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19400 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19401 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19402 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19403 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19404 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19405
19406 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19407 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19408 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19409 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19410 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19411 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19412 without processing them independently,
19413 provided the following conditions are met:
19414
19415 .ilist
19416 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19417 &%headers_remove%&.
19418 .next
19419 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19420 the domain.
19421 .endlist
19422
19423
19424
19425
19426 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19427 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19428 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19429 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19430 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19431 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19432 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19433 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19434 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19435 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19436
19437 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19438 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19439 local wildcard.
19440
19441
19442
19443 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19444 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19445 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19446 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19447
19448
19449
19450
19451 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19452 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19453 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19454 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19455 if
19456 .code
19457 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19458 .endd
19459 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19460 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19461 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19462 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19463 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19464 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19465
19466
19467 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19468 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19469 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19470 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19471 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19472
19473 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19474 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19475 such as that implied by
19476 .code
19477 domains = @mx_any
19478 .endd
19479 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19480 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19481 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19482 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19483
19484
19485
19486
19487
19488
19489
19490
19491
19492 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19493 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19494
19495 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19496 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19497 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19498 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19499 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19500 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19501 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19502 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19503 router handles the address
19504 .code
19505 root@[192.168.1.1]
19506 .endd
19507 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19508 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19509 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19510 .code
19511 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19512 .endd
19513 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19514 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19515
19516 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19517 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19518 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19519 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19520
19521 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19522 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19523 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19524 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19525
19526
19527
19528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19529 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19530
19531 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19532 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19533 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19534 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19535 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19536 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19537 must set
19538 .code
19539 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19540 .endd
19541 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19542
19543 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19544 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19545 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19546 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19547 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19548 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19549 must not be specified for it.
19550
19551 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19552 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19553 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19554 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19555 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19556 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19557 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19558
19559
19560 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19561 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19562 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19563 delivery to the address is deferred.
19564
19565
19566 .option port iplookup integer 0
19567 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19568 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19569 call.
19570
19571
19572 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19573 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19574 protocols is to be used.
19575
19576
19577 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19578 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19579 default value is:
19580 .code
19581 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19582 .endd
19583 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19584 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19585
19586
19587 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19588 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19589 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19590 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19591 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19592 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19593 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19594 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19595
19596
19597 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19598 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19599 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19600 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19601 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19602 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19603 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19604 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19605 following could be used:
19606 .code
19607 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19608 reroute = $local_part@$1
19609 .endd
19610
19611 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19612 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19613 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19614 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19615
19616
19617
19618
19619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19620 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19621
19622 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19623 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19624 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19625 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19626 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19627 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19628 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19629 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19630 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19631 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19632
19633 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19634 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19635 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19636 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19637 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19638 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19639 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19640
19641 .vindex "&$host$&"
19642 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19643 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19644 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19645 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19646 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19647 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19648 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19649 text string.
19650
19651 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19652 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19653 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19654 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19655 below, following the list of private options.
19656
19657
19658 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19659
19660 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19661 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19662
19663 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19664 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19665
19666 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19667 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19668 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19669 of the following values:
19670 .code
19671 decline
19672 defer
19673 fail
19674 freeze
19675 ignore
19676 pass
19677 .endd
19678 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19679 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19680 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19681 &%pass_router%&),
19682 .oindex "&%more%&"
19683 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19684 router only if &%more%& is true.
19685
19686 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19687 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19688 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19689 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19690
19691 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19692 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19693 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19694
19695
19696 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19697 .cindex "randomized host list"
19698 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19699 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19700 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19701 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19702 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19703 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19704 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19705 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19706
19707 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19708 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19709 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19710 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19711 .code
19712 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19713 .endd
19714 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19715 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19716 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19717 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19718 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19719
19720
19721 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19722 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19723 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19724 example:
19725 .code
19726 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19727 .endd
19728 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19729 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19730 deferred.
19731
19732
19733 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19734 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19735 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19736 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19737
19738
19739 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19740 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19741 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19742 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19743 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19744 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19745 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19746 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19747
19748 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19749 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19750 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19751 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19752 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19753 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19754 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19755 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19756
19757
19758
19759
19760 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19761 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19762 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19763 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19764 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19765 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19766 .display
19767 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19768 .endd
19769 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19770 no options:
19771 .code
19772 route_list = \
19773 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19774 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19775 .endd
19776 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19777 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19778 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19779 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19780 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19781 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19782 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19783 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19784 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19785 in a &%route_list%&).
19786
19787 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19788 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19789 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19790 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19791
19792
19793
19794 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19795 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19796 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19797 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19798 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19799 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19800 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19801 like this:
19802 .code
19803 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19804 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19805 .endd
19806 This data can be accessed by setting
19807 .code
19808 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19809 .endd
19810 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19811 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19812 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19813 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19814 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19815
19816
19817
19818
19819 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19820 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19821 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19822 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19823 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
19824 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
19825 The format of each item
19826 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19827 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
19828
19829 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19830 variables are set during its expansion:
19831
19832 .ilist
19833 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19834 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19835 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19836 .code
19837 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19838 .endd
19839 .next
19840 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19841 .next
19842 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19843
19844 .next
19845 .vindex "&$value$&"
19846 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19847 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19848 .code
19849 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19850 .endd
19851 .endlist
19852
19853 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19854 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19855
19856
19857
19858 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19859 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19860 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19861 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19862 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19863 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19864
19865 .ilist
19866 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19867 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19868 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19869 .code
19870 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19871 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19872 .endd
19873 .next
19874 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19875 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19876 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19877 number follows. For example:
19878 .code
19879 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19880 .endd
19881 .endlist
19882
19883 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19884 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19885 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19886 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19887 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19888 transport.
19889
19890 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19891 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19892 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19893 records in the DNS. For example:
19894 .code
19895 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19896 .endd
19897 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19898 example:
19899 .code
19900 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19901 .endd
19902 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19903 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19904 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19905 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19906 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19907 happens is controlled by the
19908 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19909 &%self%& option of the router.
19910
19911 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19912 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19913 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19914 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19915 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19916 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19917 defined by MX preferences.
19918
19919 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19920 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19921 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19922
19923 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19924 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19925 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19926 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19927
19928 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19929 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19930 router.
19931
19932 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19933 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19934 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19935
19936 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19937 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19938
19939
19940
19941 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19942 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19943 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19944 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19945 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19946 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19947 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19948
19949 .ilist
19950 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19951 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19952 .next
19953 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19954 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19955 .next
19956 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19957 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19958 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19959 .next
19960 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19961 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19962 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19963 .next
19964 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19965 .next
19966 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19967 .endlist
19968
19969 For example:
19970 .code
19971 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19972 domain2 host4:host5
19973 .endd
19974 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19975 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19976 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19977 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19978 call.
19979
19980 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19981 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19982 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19983 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19984 function called.
19985
19986 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19987 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19988 option specified.
19989
19990
19991
19992 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19993 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19994
19995 .vindex "&$host$&"
19996 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19997 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19998
19999
20000
20001 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20002 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20003 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20004
20005 .ilist
20006 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20007 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20008 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20009 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20010 .code
20011 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20012 .endd
20013 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20014 your first router something like this:
20015 .code
20016 smart_route:
20017 driver = manualroute
20018 domains = !+local_domains
20019 transport = remote_smtp
20020 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20021 .endd
20022 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20023 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20024 they are tried in order
20025 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20026 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20027 .code
20028 smart_route:
20029 driver = manualroute
20030 transport = remote_smtp
20031 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20032 .endd
20033 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20034 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20035 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20036 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20037 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20038 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20039 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20040 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20041
20042 .next
20043 .cindex "mail hub example"
20044 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20045 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20046 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20047 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20048 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20049 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20050 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20051 lookup is easier to manage.
20052
20053 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20054 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20055 example:
20056 .code
20057 hub_route:
20058 driver = manualroute
20059 transport = remote_smtp
20060 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20061 .endd
20062 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20063 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20064 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20065 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20066 domain can be used to find the host:
20067 .code
20068 through_firewall:
20069 driver = manualroute
20070 transport = remote_smtp
20071 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20072 .endd
20073 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20074 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20075 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20076 next router.
20077
20078 .next
20079 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20080 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20081 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20082 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20083 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20084 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20085 .code
20086 save_in_file:
20087 driver = manualroute
20088 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20089 route_list = saved.domain.example
20090 .endd
20091 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20092 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20093 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20094 .code
20095 save_in_file:
20096 driver = manualroute
20097 route_list = \
20098 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20099 *.saved.domain2.example \
20100 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20101 batch_pipe
20102 .endd
20103 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20104 .vindex "&$host$&"
20105 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20106 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20107 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20108 the address if the lookup fails.
20109
20110 .next
20111 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20112 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20113 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20114 one way it can be done:
20115 .code
20116 # Transport
20117 uucp:
20118 driver = pipe
20119 user = nobody
20120 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20121 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20122 return_fail_output = true
20123
20124 # Router
20125 uucphost:
20126 transport = uucp
20127 driver = manualroute
20128 route_data = \
20129 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20130 .endd
20131 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20132 .code
20133 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20134 .endd
20135 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20136 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20137 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20138 .endlist
20139 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20140 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20141
20142
20143
20144
20145
20146
20147
20148
20149 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20150 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20151
20152 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20153 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20154 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20155 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20156 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20157 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20158 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20159 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20160 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20161 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20162 options:
20163 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20164
20165 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20166 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20167 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20168 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20169 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20170
20171
20172 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
20173 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20174 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20175 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20176 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20177 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20178
20179
20180 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
20181 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20182 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20183 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20184 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20185 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20186 not set, a value for the gid also.
20187
20188 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20189 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20190 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20191 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20192 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20193 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20194 gid.
20195
20196
20197 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
20198 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20199 before running the command.
20200
20201
20202 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20203 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20204 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20205 timeout.
20206
20207
20208 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20209 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20210 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20211 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20212 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20213
20214 .ilist
20215 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20216 below).
20217 .next
20218 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20219 &%no_more%& is set.
20220 .next
20221 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20222 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20223 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20224 included in the SMTP response.
20225 .next
20226 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20227 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20228 included in any SMTP response.
20229 .next
20230 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20231 .next
20232 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20233 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20234 .next
20235 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20236 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20237 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20238 .endlist
20239
20240 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20241 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20242 the page):
20243 .code
20244 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20245 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20246 .endd
20247 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20248 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20249 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20250 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20251
20252 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20253 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20254 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20255 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20256 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20257
20258 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20259 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20260 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20261 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20262 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20263
20264 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20265 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20266 variable. For example, this return line
20267 .code
20268 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20269 .endd
20270 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20271 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20272 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20273 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20274
20275
20276
20277
20278 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20279 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20280
20281 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20282 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20283 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20284 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20285 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20286 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20287 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20288 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20289 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20290 redirected in several different ways:
20291
20292 .ilist
20293 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20294 independently.
20295 .next
20296 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20297 .next
20298 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20299 .next
20300 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20301 .next
20302 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20303 .next
20304 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20305 .next
20306 It can be discarded.
20307 .endlist
20308
20309 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20310 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20311 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20312 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20313
20314 If success DSNs have been requested
20315 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20316 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20317 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20318
20319
20320
20321 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20322 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20323 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20324 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20325 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20326 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20327 .code
20328 system_aliases:
20329 driver = redirect
20330 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20331 .endd
20332 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20333 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20334 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20335 cause delivery to be deferred.
20336
20337 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20338 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20339 .code
20340 userforward:
20341 driver = redirect
20342 check_local_user
20343 file = $home/.forward
20344 no_verify
20345 .endd
20346 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20347 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20348 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20349 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20350 comments.
20351
20352
20353
20354 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20355 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20356 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20357 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20358
20359 .ilist
20360 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20361 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20362 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20363 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20364 .next
20365 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20366 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20367 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20368 saves some resources.
20369 .endlist
20370
20371
20372
20373
20374
20375
20376 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20377 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20378 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20379 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20380 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20381
20382 .ilist
20383 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20384 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20385 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20386 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20387 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20388 document is intended for use by end users.
20389 .next
20390 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20391 described in the next section.
20392 .endlist
20393
20394 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20395 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20396 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20397 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20398 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20399
20400
20401
20402 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20403 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20404 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20405 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20406 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20407 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20408 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20409 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20410 commas or newlines.
20411 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20412 quotes.
20413
20414 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20415 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20416 next newline character is ignored.
20417
20418 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20419 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20420 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20421 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20422 removed.
20423
20424 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20425 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20426 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20427 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20428 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20429 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20430 setting:
20431 .code
20432 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20433 .endd
20434
20435
20436 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20437 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20438 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20439 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20440 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20441 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20442 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20443 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20444 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20445 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20446 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20447
20448 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20449 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20450 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20451 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20452 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20453 .code
20454 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20455 .endd
20456 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20457 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20458 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20459 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20460 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20461 synonymously.
20462
20463 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20464 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20465 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20466 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20467 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20468
20469 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20470 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20471 contains:
20472 .code
20473 Sam.Reman: spqr
20474 .endd
20475 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20476 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20477 this forward file:
20478 .code
20479 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20480 .endd
20481 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20482 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20483 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20484 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20485 should really contain
20486 .code
20487 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20488 .endd
20489 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20490 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20491 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20492
20493
20494
20495 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20496 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20497 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20498
20499 .ilist
20500 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20501 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20502 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20503 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20504 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20505 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20506 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20507
20508 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20509 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20510 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20511 in double quotes, for example:
20512 .code
20513 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20514 .endd
20515 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20516 quote just the command. An item such as
20517 .code
20518 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20519 .endd
20520 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20521
20522 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20523 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20524 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20525 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20526 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20527 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20528 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20529 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20530 an &%accept%& router.
20531
20532 .next
20533 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20534 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20535 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20536 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20537 .code
20538 /home/world/minbari
20539 .endd
20540 is treated as a filename, but
20541 .code
20542 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20543 .endd
20544 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20545 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20546 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20547 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20548
20549 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20550 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20551
20552 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20553 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20554 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20555 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20556
20557 .next
20558 .cindex "included address list"
20559 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20560 If an item is of the form
20561 .code
20562 :include:<path name>
20563 .endd
20564 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20565 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20566 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20567 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20568 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20569 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20570 .code
20571 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20572 .endd
20573 It must be given as
20574 .code
20575 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20576 .endd
20577 .next
20578 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20579 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20580 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20581 .cindex "black hole"
20582 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20583 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20584 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20585 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20586 .code
20587 :blackhole:
20588 .endd
20589 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20590 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20591 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20592
20593 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20594 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20595 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20596 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20597 &_/dev/null_&.
20598
20599 .next
20600 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20601 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20602 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20603 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20604 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20605 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20606 redirection items of the form
20607 .code
20608 :defer:
20609 :fail:
20610 .endd
20611 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20612 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20613 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20614 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20615 .code
20616 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20617 .endd
20618 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20619 of a
20620 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20621 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20622 default.
20623 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20624 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20625 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20626
20627 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20628 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20629 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20630 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20631 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20632 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20633 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20634 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20635 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20636 ignored.
20637
20638 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20639 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20640 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20641 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20642
20643 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20644 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20645 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20646 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20647 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20648
20649 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20650 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20651 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20652 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20653 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20654 rules still apply.
20655
20656 .next
20657 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20658 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20659 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20660 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20661 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20662 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20663 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20664 .endlist
20665
20666
20667 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20668 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20669 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20670 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20671 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20672 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20673 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20674 aliasing scheme of the type
20675 .code
20676 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20677 localpart1: pipe
20678 localpart2: pipe
20679 .endd
20680 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20681 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20682 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20683 such as
20684 .code
20685 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20686 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20687 .endd
20688 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20689 the pipes are distinct.
20690
20691
20692
20693 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20694 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20695 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20696 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20697 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20698 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20699 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20700 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20701 can be used to avoid this.
20702
20703
20704 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20705 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20706 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20707 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20708 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20709 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20710 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20711
20712
20713
20714 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20715
20716 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20717 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20718
20719
20720 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20721 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20722 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20723
20724
20725 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20726 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20727 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20728 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20729
20730
20731 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20732 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20733 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20734 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20735 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20736 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20737 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20738
20739 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20740 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20741
20742
20743 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20744 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20745 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20746 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20747 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20748
20749
20750
20751 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20752 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20753 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20754 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20755 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20756 let ordinary users do.
20757
20758
20759
20760 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20761 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20762 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20763 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20764 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20765 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20766
20767 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20768 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20769 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20770 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20771 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20772 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20773 .code
20774 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20775 .endd
20776 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20777 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20778 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20779 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20780 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20781 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20782 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20783 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20784
20785
20786 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20787 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20788 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20789 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20790 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20791 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20792 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20793 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20794
20795
20796
20797 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20798 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20799 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20800 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20801 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20802 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20803
20804
20805 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20806 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20807 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20808 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20809 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20810 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20811
20812 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20813 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20814 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20815 .code
20816 data = #Exim filter\n\
20817 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20818 .endd
20819 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20820 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20821 choice into a newline.
20822
20823
20824 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20825 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20826 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20827 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20828 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20829
20830
20831 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20832 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20833 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20834 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20835 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20836 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20837 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20838 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20839
20840 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20841 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20842 runs a check on the containing directory,
20843 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20844 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20845 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20846 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20847 not, the router declines.
20848
20849
20850 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20851 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20852 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20853 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20854 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20855 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20856 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
20857
20858
20859 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20860 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20861 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20862 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20863 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20864
20865
20866 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20867 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20868 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20869 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20870 redirection list.
20871
20872
20873 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20874 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20875 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20876 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20877 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20878
20879
20880
20881
20882 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20883 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20884 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20885 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20886 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20887 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20888 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20889 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20890 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20891 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20892 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20893
20894
20895 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20896 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20897 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20898 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20899 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20900 functions.
20901
20902 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20903 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20904 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20905 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20906 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20907 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20908
20909 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20910 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20911 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20912 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20913 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20914 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20915 &_.forward_& files).
20916
20917
20918 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20919 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20920 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20921 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20922 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20923
20924
20925 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20926 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20927 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20928 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20929 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20930 of the embedded Perl support.
20931
20932
20933 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20934 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20935 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20936 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20937 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20938
20939
20940 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20941 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20942 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20943 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20944 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20945
20946
20947 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20948 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20949 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20950 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20951 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20952 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20953 &%one_time%& is set.
20954
20955
20956 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20957 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20958 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20959 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20960 to make use of &%run%& items.
20961
20962
20963 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20964 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20965 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20966 If this option is true, items of the form
20967 .code
20968 :include:<path name>
20969 .endd
20970 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20971
20972
20973 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20974 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20975 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20976 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20977 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20978 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20979 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20980
20981
20982 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20983 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20984 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20985 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20986 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20987
20988
20989 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20990 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20991 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20992 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20993 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20994
20995
20996
20997
20998 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20999 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21000 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21001 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21002 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21003 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21004 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21005
21006
21007 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21008 .cindex "EACCES"
21009 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21010 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21011 file did not exist.
21012
21013
21014 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21015 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
21016 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21017 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21018 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21019
21020 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21021 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21022 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21023 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21024 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21025 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21026 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21027 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21028
21029
21030
21031 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21032 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21033 redirection list must start with this directory.
21034
21035
21036 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21037 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21038 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21039
21040
21041 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21042 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21043 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21044 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21045 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21046 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21047 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21048 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21049 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21050 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21051 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21052 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21053 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21054 before they subscribed.
21055
21056 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21057 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21058 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21059 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21060 attempt.
21061
21062 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21063 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21064 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21065 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21066
21067 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21068 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21069 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21070
21071 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21072 &%one_time%&.
21073
21074 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21075 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21076 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21077 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21078 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21079 expansion.
21080
21081
21082 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21083 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21084 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21085 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21086 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21087 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21088 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21089 See &%check_owner%& above.
21090
21091
21092 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21093 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21094 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21095 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21096
21097
21098 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21099 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21100 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21101 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21102 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21103 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21104 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21105
21106
21107 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21108 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21109 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21110 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21111 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21112 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21113 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21114 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21115
21116 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21117 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21118 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21119 addresses.
21120
21121 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21122 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21123 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21124 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21125 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21126 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21127 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21128 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21129 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21130 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21131
21132
21133 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21134 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21135 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21136 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21137 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21138 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21139
21140
21141 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21142 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21143 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21144 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21145 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21146 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21147
21148
21149 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21150 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21151 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21152 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21153 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21154
21155
21156 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21157 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21158 :subaddress part of an address.
21159
21160 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21161 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21162 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21163 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21164
21165
21166 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21167 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21168 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21169 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21170 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21171 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21172 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21173
21174
21175
21176 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21177 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
21178 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21179 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
21180 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21181 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21182 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21183 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21184 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21185 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21186 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21187 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21188 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21189 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21190 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21191 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21192
21193 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21194 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21195 the following routers.
21196
21197 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21198 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21199 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21200 so it is passed to the following routers.
21201
21202 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21203 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21204 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21205 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21206
21207 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21208 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21209 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21210 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21211 .code
21212 userforward:
21213 driver = redirect
21214 allow_filter
21215 check_local_user
21216 file = $home/.forward
21217 file_transport = address_file
21218 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21219 reply_transport = address_reply
21220 no_verify
21221 skip_syntax_errors
21222 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21223 syntax_errors_text = \
21224 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21225 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21226 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21227 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21228 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21229 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21230 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21231 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21232 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21233 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21234 .endd
21235 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21236 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21237 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21238 .code
21239 real_localuser:
21240 driver = accept
21241 check_local_user
21242 local_part_prefix = real-
21243 transport = local_delivery
21244 .endd
21245 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21246 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21247 .code
21248 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21249 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21250 .endd
21251
21252
21253 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21254 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21255
21256
21257 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21258 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21259 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21260 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21261
21262
21263
21264
21265
21266
21267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21268 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21269
21270 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21271 "Environment for local transports"
21272 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21273 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21274 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21275 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21276 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21277 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21278 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21279
21280 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21281 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21282 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21283 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21284
21285 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21286 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21287 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21288 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21289 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21290
21291
21292
21293 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21294 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21295 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21296 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21297 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21298 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21299 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21300 time.
21301
21302 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21303 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21304 .code
21305 my_transport:
21306 driver = pipe
21307 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21308 .endd
21309 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21310 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21311 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21312 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21313
21314
21315
21316
21317 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21318 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21319 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21320 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21321 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21322 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21323 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21324 group (set by the transport). For example:
21325 .code
21326 # Routers ...
21327 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21328 local_users:
21329 driver = accept
21330 check_local_user
21331 transport = group_delivery
21332
21333 # Transports ...
21334 # This transport overrides the group
21335 group_delivery:
21336 driver = appendfile
21337 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21338 group = mail
21339 .endd
21340 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21341 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21342 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21343 set.
21344
21345 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21346 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21347 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21348 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21349 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21350 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21351
21352 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21353 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21354 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21355 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21356 original gid is also used.
21357
21358 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21359 following that is set is used:
21360
21361 .ilist
21362 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21363 .next
21364 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21365 .next
21366 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21367 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21368 .next
21369 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21370 .next
21371 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21372 the uid is the creator's uid;
21373 .next
21374 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21375 .endlist
21376
21377 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21378 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21379 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21380 The first of the following that is set is used:
21381
21382 .ilist
21383 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21384 .next
21385 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21386 .next
21387 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21388 .next
21389 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21390 .next
21391 The Exim uid.
21392 .endlist
21393
21394 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21395 &%never_users%& list.
21396
21397
21398
21399
21400
21401 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21402 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21403 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21404 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21405 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21406 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21407 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21408 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21409 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21410 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21411
21412 .ilist
21413 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21414 .next
21415 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21416 .next
21417 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21418 .next
21419 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21420 .endlist
21421
21422 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21423
21424 .ilist
21425 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21426 .next
21427 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21428 .endlist
21429
21430
21431 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21432 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21433 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21434
21435
21436
21437 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21438 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21439 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21440 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21441 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21442 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21443 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21444 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21445 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21446 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21447 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21448 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21449 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21450 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21451
21452
21453
21454
21455
21456
21457
21458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21459 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21460
21461 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21462 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21463 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21464 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21465 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21466
21467
21468 .option body_only transports boolean false
21469 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21470 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21471 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21472 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21473 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21474 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21475 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21476 automatically suppress them.
21477
21478
21479 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21480 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21481 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21482 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21483 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21484 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21485
21486
21487 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21488 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21489 deliveries by the transport or for any
21490 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21491 what you are doing.
21492
21493
21494 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21495 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21496 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21497 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21498 transport is run.
21499 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21500 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21501 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21502 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21503 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21504 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21505 one.
21506 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21507 transport and the router that called it.
21508
21509 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21510 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21511 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21512 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21513 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21514 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21515 safely be resent to other recipients.
21516
21517
21518 .option driver transports string unset
21519 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21520 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21521
21522
21523 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21524 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21525 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21526 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21527 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21528 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21529 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21530 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21531 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21532 resent to other recipients.
21533
21534
21535 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21536 .cindex events
21537 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21538 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21539
21540
21541 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21542 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21543 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21544 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21545 &%user%& (see below).
21546
21547
21548 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21549 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21550 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21551 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21552 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21553 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21554 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21555 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21556 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21557 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21558 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21559
21560 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21561 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21562
21563
21564 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21565 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21566 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21567 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21568 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21569 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21570 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21571 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21572
21573
21574 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21575 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21576 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21577 This option specifies a list of header names,
21578 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21579 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21580 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21581 routers.
21582 Each list item is separately expanded.
21583 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21584 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21585 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21586
21587 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21588 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21589
21590 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21591 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21592 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21593
21594
21595
21596 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21597 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21598 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21599 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21600 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21601 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21602 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21603 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21604 example,
21605 .code
21606 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21607 x@y w@z
21608 .endd
21609 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21610 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21611 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21612 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21613 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21614 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21615 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21616 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21617 change envelope recipients at this time.
21618
21619
21620 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21621 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21622 .vindex "&$home$&"
21623 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21624 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21625 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21626 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21627 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21628 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21629 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21630 deferred.
21631
21632
21633 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21634 .cindex "additional groups"
21635 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21636 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21637 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21638 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21639 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21640
21641
21642 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21643 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21644 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21645 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21646 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21647 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21648 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21649 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21650
21651 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21652 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21653 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21654 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21655 Obviously there is scope for
21656 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21657 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21658
21659 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21660 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21661 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21662 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21663 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21664
21665
21666 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21667 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21668 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21669 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21670 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21671 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21672 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21673 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21674 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21675 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21676 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21677 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21678 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21679 delivered.
21680
21681
21682
21683 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21684 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21685 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21686 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21687 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21688 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21689 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21690 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21691 that contains
21692 .code
21693 local_part_prefix = *-
21694 .endd
21695 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21696 is delivered with
21697 .code
21698 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21699 .endd
21700 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21701 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21702 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21703 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21704 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21705
21706
21707 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21708 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21709 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21710 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21711 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21712 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21713 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21714 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21715 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21716
21717 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21718 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21719 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21720 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21721
21722 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21723 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21724 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21725
21726
21727 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21728 .cindex "envelope sender"
21729 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21730 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21731 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21732 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21733 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21734 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21735 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21736 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21737 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21738
21739 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21740 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21741
21742 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21743 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21744 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21745 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21746 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21747 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21748 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21749
21750 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21751 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21752 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21753 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21754 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21755
21756
21757
21758 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21759 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21760 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21761 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21762 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21763 have easy access to it.
21764
21765 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21766 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21767 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21768 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21769 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21770 recipients.
21771
21772
21773 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21774 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21775
21776
21777 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21778 .cindex "shadow transport"
21779 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21780 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21781 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21782
21783 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21784 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21785 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21786 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21787 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21788 cause a log line to be written.
21789
21790 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21791 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21792 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21793 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21794 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21795 of the form
21796 .code
21797 ST=<shadow transport name>
21798 .endd
21799 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21800 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21801 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21802 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21803 headers that some sites insist on.
21804
21805
21806 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21807 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21808 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21809 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21810 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21811 individual users or via a system filter.
21812 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21813
21814 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21815 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21816 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21817 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21818 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21819
21820 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21821 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21822 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21823 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21824 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21825 &(pipe)& transports.
21826
21827 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21828 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21829 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21830 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21831 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21832
21833 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21834 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21835 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21836 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21837
21838 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21839 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21840 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21841 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21842 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21843 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21844
21845 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21846 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21847 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21848 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21849 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21850 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21851 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21852 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21853
21854 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21855 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21856 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21857 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21858 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21859 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21860 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21861 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21862 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21863 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21864
21865 .vindex "&$host$&"
21866 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21867 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21868 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21869 which the message is being sent. For example:
21870 .code
21871 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21872 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21873 .endd
21874
21875 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21876 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21877 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21878 .ilist
21879 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21880 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21881 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21882 example:
21883 .code
21884 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21885 .endd
21886 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21887 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21888 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21889 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21890 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21891 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21892 .next
21893 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21894 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21895 arguments. Consider this example:
21896 .code
21897 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21898 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21899 .endd
21900 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21901 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21902 .code
21903 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21904 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21905 .endd
21906 .endlist
21907
21908 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21909 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21910 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21911 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21912 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21913 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21914 bounced from a transport filter.
21915
21916 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21917 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21918 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21919
21920
21921 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21922 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21923 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21924 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21925 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21926 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21927 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21928 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21929 becomes a temporary error.
21930
21931
21932 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21933 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21934 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21935 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21936 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21937 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21938 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21939 option is not set.
21940
21941 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21942 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21943 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21944
21945 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21946 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21947 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21948 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21949 retry data.
21950 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21951 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21952 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21953
21954
21955
21956
21957
21958
21959 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21960 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21961
21962 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21963 "Address batching"
21964 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21965 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21966 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21967 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21968 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21969 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21970 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21971
21972 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21973 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21974 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21975 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21976 local transport, for example:
21977
21978 .ilist
21979 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21980 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21981 recipients saves space.
21982 .next
21983 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21984 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21985 .next
21986 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21987 to a scanner program or
21988 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21989 acceptable.
21990 .endlist
21991
21992 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21993 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21994 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21995
21996 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21997 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21998 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21999 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22000 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22001 to certain conditions:
22002
22003 .ilist
22004 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22005 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22006 batching is possible.
22007 .next
22008 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22009 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22010 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22011 .next
22012 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22013 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22014 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22015 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22016 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22017 from taking place.
22018 .next
22019 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22020 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22021 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22022 be the same.
22023 .endlist
22024
22025 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22026 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22027 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22028 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22029 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22030 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22031 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22032 .code
22033 check_string = "."
22034 escape_string = ".."
22035 .endd
22036 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22037 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22038 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22039
22040 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22041 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22042 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22043 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22044 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22045 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22046
22047 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22048 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22049 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22050 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22051 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22052 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22053 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22054 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22055 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22056
22057
22058
22059
22060 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22061 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22062
22063 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22064 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22065 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22066 .cindex "directory creation"
22067 .cindex "creating directories"
22068 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22069 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22070 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22071 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22072 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22073 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22074 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22075 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22076 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22077 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22078
22079 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22080 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22081 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22082 included.
22083
22084 .cindex "quota" "system"
22085 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22086 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22087 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22088
22089 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22090 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22091 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22092 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22093
22094 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22095 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22096 private options.
22097
22098 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22099 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22100 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22101 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22102 option).
22103
22104
22105
22106 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22107 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22108 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22109 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22110 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22111
22112 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22113 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22114 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22115 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22116 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22117 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22118 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22119 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22120 operation. There are two cases:
22121
22122 .ilist
22123 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22124 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22125 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22126 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22127 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22128 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22129 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22130 .next
22131 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22132 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22133 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22134 .endlist
22135
22136
22137 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22138 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22139 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22140 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22141 form:
22142 .code
22143 save folder23
22144 .endd
22145 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22146 .code
22147 require "fileinto";
22148 fileinto "folder23";
22149 .endd
22150 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22151 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22152 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22153 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22154 way of handling this requirement:
22155 .code
22156 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22157 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22158 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22159 {$address_file} \
22160 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22161 }} \
22162 }
22163 .endd
22164 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22165 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22166 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22167
22168 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22169 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22170 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22171 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22172 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22173 path to the transport.
22174
22175 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22176 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22177
22178
22179
22180
22181 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22182 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22183
22184
22185
22186 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22187 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22188 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22189 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22190 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22191 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22192 delivery is deferred.
22193
22194
22195 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22196 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22197 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22198 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22199 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22200 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22201 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22202 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22203
22204
22205 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22206 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22207 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22208 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22209 file.
22210
22211
22212 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22213 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22214
22215
22216 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22217 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22218 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22219 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22220 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22221
22222
22223 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22224 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22225 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22226 process is running.
22227
22228
22229 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22230 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22231 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22232 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22233 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22234 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22235 contains is significant.
22236
22237 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22238 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22239 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22240 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22241 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22242
22243 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22244 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22245 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22246 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22247 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22248 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22249 .code
22250 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22251 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22252 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22253 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22254 .endd
22255 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22256 .cindex "directory creation"
22257 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22258 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22259 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22260
22261 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22262 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22263 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22264 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22265 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22266
22267
22268
22269 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22270 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22271 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22272 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22273 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22274 beneath.
22275
22276 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22277 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22278 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22279 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22280 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22281 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22282 &%file_must_exist%&.
22283
22284
22285 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22286 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22287 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22288 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22289
22290 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22291 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22292 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22293 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22294 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22295
22296
22297 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22298 .cindex "base62"
22299 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22300 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22301 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22302 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22303 .code
22304 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22305 .endd
22306 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22307 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22308 option.
22309
22310
22311 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22312 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22313 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22314
22315
22316 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22317 See &%check_string%& above.
22318
22319
22320 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
22321 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22322 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22323 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22324 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22325 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22326 &%file%&.
22327
22328 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22329 .cindex "locking files"
22330 .cindex "lock files"
22331 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22332 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22333
22334 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22335 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22336 examples:
22337 .code
22338 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22339 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22340 file = $home/inbox
22341 .endd
22342 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22343 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22344 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22345 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22346 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22347 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22348
22349
22350
22351 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22352 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22353 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22354 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22355 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22356 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22357 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22358 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22359 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22360 this added to it:
22361 .code
22362 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22363 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22364 .endd
22365 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22366 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22367 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22368 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22369 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22370 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22371 delivery is deferred.
22372
22373
22374 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22375 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22376 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22377 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22378
22379
22380 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22381 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22382 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22383 .cindex "locking files"
22384 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22385 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22386 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22387 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22388 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22389 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22390 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22391 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22392
22393 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22394 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22395 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22396 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22397
22398 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22399 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22400 retries is
22401 .code
22402 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22403 .endd
22404 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22405 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22406 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22407
22408 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22409 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22410 .code
22411 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22412 .endd
22413
22414 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22415 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22416 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22417 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22418
22419
22420 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22421 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22422 for details of locking.
22423
22424
22425 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22426 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22427 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22428
22429
22430 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22431 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22432 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22433
22434
22435 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22436 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22437 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22438 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22439 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22440
22441
22442 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22443 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22444 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22445 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22446 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22447 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22448 external source that maintains the data.
22449
22450
22451 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22452 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22453 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22454 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22455 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22456 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22457 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22458 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22459
22460
22461
22462 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22463 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22464 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22465 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22466 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22467 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22468 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22469 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22470 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22471 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22472
22473
22474 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22475 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22476 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22477 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22478 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22479 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22480 calculation. The default value is:
22481 .code
22482 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22483 .endd
22484 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22485 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22486 &_Trash_&
22487 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22488 .code
22489 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22490 .endd
22491 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22492 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22493 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22494 directly into that directory.
22495
22496
22497 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22498 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22499 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22500
22501
22502 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22503 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22504 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22505
22506
22507 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22508 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22509 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22510 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22511 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22512 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22513 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22514 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22515
22516 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22517 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22518 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22519 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22520 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22521 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22522 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22523 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22524 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22525 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22526
22527
22528 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22529 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22530 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22531 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22532 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22533 below for further details.
22534
22535
22536 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22537 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22538 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22539
22540
22541 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22542 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22543 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22544
22545
22546 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22547 .cindex "locking files"
22548 .cindex "file" "locking"
22549 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22550 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22551 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22552 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22553 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22554 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22555 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22556
22557 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22558 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22559 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22560 combination:
22561 .code
22562 mbx_format = true
22563 message_prefix =
22564 message_suffix =
22565 .endd
22566 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22567 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22568 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22569 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22570 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22571 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22572 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22573 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22574
22575 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22576 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22577 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22578 append messages to it.
22579
22580
22581 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22582 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22583 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22584 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22585 in which case it is:
22586 .code
22587 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22588 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22589 .endd
22590 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22591 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22592
22593 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22594 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22595 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22596 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22597 setting
22598 .code
22599 message_suffix =
22600 .endd
22601 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22602 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22603
22604 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22605 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22606 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22607 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22608 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22609 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22610 value, and this option is ignored.
22611
22612
22613 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22614 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22615 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22616 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22617 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22618
22619
22620 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22621 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22622 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22623 on users about incoming mail.
22624
22625
22626 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22627 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22628 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22629 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22630 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22631 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22632 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22633 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22634 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22635
22636 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22637 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22638 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22639
22640 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22641 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22642 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22643 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22644 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22645 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22646
22647 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22648 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22649 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22650 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22651 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22652 be handled.
22653
22654 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22655 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22656
22657 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22658
22659 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22660 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22661 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22662 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22663 system quota failures.
22664
22665 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22666 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22667 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22668 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22669 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22670 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22671 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22672 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22673 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22674 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22675
22676
22677 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22678 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22679 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22680 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22681 delivery directory.
22682
22683
22684 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22685 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22686 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22687 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22688 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22689 &"no quota"&.
22690
22691 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22692 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22693
22694 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22695 See &%quota%& above.
22696
22697
22698 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22699 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22700 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22701 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22702 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22703 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22704 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22705
22706 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22707 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22708 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22709 the file length to the filename. For example:
22710 .code
22711 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22712 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22713 .endd
22714 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22715 number of lines in the message.
22716
22717 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22718 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22719 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22720
22721 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22722
22723
22724 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22725 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22726 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22727 .code
22728 quota_warn_message = "\
22729 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22730 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22731 This message is automatically created \
22732 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22733 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22734 a warning threshold that is\n\
22735 set by the system administrator.\n"
22736 .endd
22737
22738
22739 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22740 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22741 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22742 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22743 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22744 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22745 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22746 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22747 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22748 sign. For example:
22749 .code
22750 quota = 10M
22751 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22752 .endd
22753 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22754 percent sign is ignored.
22755
22756 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22757 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22758 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22759 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22760 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22761 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22762 .code
22763 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22764 .endd
22765 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22766 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22767 option.
22768
22769 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22770 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22771 percentage.
22772
22773
22774 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22775 .cindex "envelope sender"
22776 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22777 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22778 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22779 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22780 for details of batch SMTP.
22781
22782
22783 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22784 .cindex "carriage return"
22785 .cindex "linefeed"
22786 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22787 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22788 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22789 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22790
22791 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22792 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22793 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22794 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22795 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22796 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22797
22798
22799 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22800 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22801 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22802 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22803 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22804 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22805
22806
22807 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22808 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22809 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22810 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22811 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22812
22813 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22814 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22815 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22816 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22817
22818 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22819 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22820 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22821 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22822 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22823 error.
22824
22825 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22826 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22827
22828
22829 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22830 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22831 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22832 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22833 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22834 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22835 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22836
22837 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22838 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22839 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22840 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22841 file corruption.
22842
22843 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22844 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22845 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22846
22847
22848 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22849 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22850 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22851 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22852 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22853 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22854 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22855 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22856 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22857
22858 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22859 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22860 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22861 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22862
22863
22864
22865
22866 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22867 .cindex "appending to a file"
22868 .cindex "file" "appending"
22869 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22870
22871 .ilist
22872 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22873 return is given.
22874
22875 .next
22876 .cindex "directory creation"
22877 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22878 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22879 &%directory_mode%& option.
22880
22881 .next
22882 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22883 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22884 transport.
22885
22886 .next
22887 .cindex "file" "locking"
22888 .cindex "locking files"
22889 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22890 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22891 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22892
22893 .olist
22894 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22895 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22896 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22897 .next
22898 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
22899 .next
22900 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22901 Unlink the hitching post name.
22902 .next
22903 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22904 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22905 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22906 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22907 .next
22908 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22909 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22910 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22911 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22912 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22913 it before trying again.
22914 .endlist olist
22915
22916 .next
22917 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22918 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22919 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22920
22921 .next
22922 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22923 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22924 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22925 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22926 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22927 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22928 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22929 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22930 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22931 checked.
22932
22933 .next
22934 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22935 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22936 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22937 delivery is deferred.
22938
22939 .next
22940 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22941 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22942 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22943 permissions.
22944
22945 .next
22946 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22947 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22948 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22949
22950 .next
22951 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22952 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22953 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22954
22955 .next
22956 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22957 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22958 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22959 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22960 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22961 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22962 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22963 that prevents link following.
22964
22965 .next
22966 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22967 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22968 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22969 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22970 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22971
22972 .next
22973 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22974
22975 .next
22976 .cindex "file" "locking"
22977 .cindex "locking files"
22978 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22979 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22980 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22981 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22982 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22983 .code
22984 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22985 .endd
22986 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22987 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22988 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22989
22990 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22991 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22992 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22993
22994 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22995 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22996 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22997 delivery is deferred.
22998
22999 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23000 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23001 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23002 immediately. It retries up to
23003 .code
23004 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23005 .endd
23006 times (rounded up).
23007 .endlist
23008
23009 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23010 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23011
23012
23013 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23014 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23015 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23016 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23017 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23018 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23019 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23020 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23021 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23022 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23023
23024 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23025 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23026 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23027 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23028 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23029 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23030 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23031
23032 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23033 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23034 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23035 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23036
23037
23038 .cindex "maildir format"
23039 .cindex "mailstore format"
23040 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23041 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23042 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23043 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23044 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23045
23046 .cindex "directory creation"
23047 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23048 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23049 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23050 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23051 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23052 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23053 deferred.
23054
23055
23056
23057 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23058 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23059 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23060 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23061 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23062 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23063 &_new_& subdirectory.
23064
23065 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23066 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23067 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23068 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23069 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23070 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23071 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23072
23073 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23074 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23075 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23076 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23077 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23078 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23079 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23080 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23081
23082 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23083 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23084 folders. Consider this example:
23085 .code
23086 maildir_format = true
23087 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23088 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23089 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23090 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23091 .endd
23092 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23093 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23094 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23095 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23096 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23097 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23098
23099 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23100 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23101 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23102 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23103 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23104
23105 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23106 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23107 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23108
23109 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23110 .cindex "maildir++"
23111 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23112 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23113 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23114 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23115 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23116 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23117 amount of space used.
23118
23119 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23120 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23121 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23122 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23123 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23124 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23125
23126
23127
23128
23129 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23130 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23131 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23132 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23133 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23134 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23135
23136
23137 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
23138 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23139 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23140 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23141 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23142 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23143 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23144 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23145 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23146 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23147 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23148 backwards compatibility).
23149
23150 For one common implementation, you might set:
23151 .code
23152 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23153 .endd
23154 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23155
23156 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23157 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23158 &[stat()]& each message file.
23159
23160
23161 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23162 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23163 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23164 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23165 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23166 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23167 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23168 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23169 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23170
23171 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23172 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23173 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23174 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23175 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23176 need to know the quota.
23177
23178 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23179 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23180
23181 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23182 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23183 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23184 details.
23185
23186
23187 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23188 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23189 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23190 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23191 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23192 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23193 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23194 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23195
23196 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23197 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23198 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23199 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23200 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23201 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23202
23203 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23204 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23205 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23206 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23207 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23208 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23209
23210 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23211 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23212 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23213 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23214
23215
23216 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23217 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23218 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23219 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23220 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23221 .code
23222 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23223 .endd
23224 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23225 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23226 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23227 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23228 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23229
23230
23231
23232
23233
23234
23235 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23236 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23237
23238 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23239 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23240 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23241 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23242 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23243 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23244 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23245 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23246
23247 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23248 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23249 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23250 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23251 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23252
23253
23254 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23255 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23256 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23257 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23258 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23259
23260 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23261 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23262 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23263 transport is run as a consequence of a
23264 &%mail%&
23265 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23266 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23267 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23268 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23269 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23270 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23271
23272 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23273 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23274 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23275 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23276
23277 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23278 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23279 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23280 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23281 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23282 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23283 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23284
23285 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23286 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23287 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23288 the transport defers.
23289 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23290 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23291
23292 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23293 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23294 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23295 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23296
23297 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23298 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23299 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23300 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23301 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23302 problems. They are just discarded.
23303
23304
23305
23306 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23307 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23308
23309 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23310 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23311 message when the message is specified by the transport.
23312
23313
23314 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23315 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23316 when the message is specified by the transport.
23317
23318
23319 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
23320 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23321 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23322 string comes first.
23323
23324
23325 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23326 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23327 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23328
23329
23330 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23331 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23332 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23333
23334
23335 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23336 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23337 specified by the transport.
23338
23339
23340 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23341 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23342 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23343 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23344
23345
23346 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23347 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23348 the message is specified by the transport.
23349
23350
23351 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23352 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23353 used.
23354
23355
23356 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23357 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23358 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23359 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23360 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23361
23362
23363
23364 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23365 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23366 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23367 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23368
23369 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23370 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23371 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23372 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23373 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23374 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23375 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23376 infinity.
23377
23378 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23379 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23380 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23381 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23382 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23383
23384 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23385 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23386 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23387 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23388 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23389 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23390
23391
23392 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23393 See &%once%& above.
23394
23395
23396 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23397 See &%once%& above.
23398 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23399
23400
23401 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23402 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23403 specified by the transport.
23404
23405
23406 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23407 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23408 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23409 configuration option.
23410
23411
23412 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23413 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23414 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23415 automatic responses. For example:
23416 .code
23417 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23418 .endd
23419 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23420 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23421 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23422 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23423 small.
23424
23425
23426
23427 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23428 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23429 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23430 the text comes first.
23431
23432
23433 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23434 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23435 when the message is specified by the transport.
23436 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23437 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23438
23439
23440
23441
23442 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23443 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23444
23445 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23446 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23447 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23448 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23449 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23450 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23451 specified command
23452 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23453 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23454 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23455 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23456 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23457 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23458 .code
23459 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23460 .endd
23461 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23462 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23463 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23464 as follows:
23465
23466 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23467 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23468
23469
23470 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23471 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23472 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23473 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23474 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23475
23476
23477 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23478 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23479 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23480 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23481 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23482 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23483 LMTP protocol.
23484
23485 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23486 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23487 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23488 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23489 in its response to the LHLO command.
23490
23491 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23492 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23493 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23494 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23495
23496
23497 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23498 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23499 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23500 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23501 LMTP transport:
23502 .code
23503 lmtp:
23504 driver = lmtp
23505 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23506 batch_max = 20
23507 user = exim
23508 .endd
23509 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23510 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23511
23512
23513
23514 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23516
23517 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23518 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23519 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23520 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23521 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23522 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23523 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23524 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23525 following ways:
23526
23527 .ilist
23528 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23529 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23530 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23531 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23532 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23533 .next
23534 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23535 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23536 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23537 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23538 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23539 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23540 that are routed to the transport.
23541 .next
23542 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23543 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23544 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23545 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23546 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23547 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23548 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23549 .endlist
23550
23551
23552 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23553 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23554 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23555
23556 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23557 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23558 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23559 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23560 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23561 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23562 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23563
23564
23565 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23566 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23567 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23568 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23569 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23570 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23571 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23572
23573
23574
23575
23576 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23577 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23578 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23579 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23580 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23581 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23582 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23583 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23584 &"local delivery failed"&.
23585
23586 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23587 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23588 will be sent as normal.
23589
23590 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23591 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23592 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23593 apply in this case.
23594
23595 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23596 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23597 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23598 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23599
23600 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23601 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23602 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23603 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23604 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23605 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23606 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23607 &%temp_errors%&.
23608
23609
23610
23611 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23612 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23613 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23614 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23615 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23616 run.
23617
23618 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23619 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23620 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23621 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23622
23623 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23624 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23625 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23626 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23627 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23628 .code
23629 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23630 .endd
23631 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23632 arguments. You have to write
23633 .code
23634 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23635 .endd
23636 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23637 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23638 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23639 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23640 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23641 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23642 example:
23643 .code
23644 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23645 .endd
23646
23647 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23648 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23649 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23650 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23651 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23652 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23653 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23654 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23655 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23656 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23657 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23658
23659 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23660 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23661 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23662 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23663 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23664 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23665 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23666 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23667
23668 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23669 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23670 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23671 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23672 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23673 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23674 control what is done with it.
23675
23676 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23677 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23678 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23679 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23680 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23681 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23682 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23683 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23684 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23685 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23686 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23687
23688
23689
23690 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23691 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23692 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23693 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23694 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23695 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23696 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23697 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23698 .display
23699 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23700 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23701 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23702 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23703 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23704 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23705 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23706 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23707 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23708 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23709 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23710 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23711 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23712 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23713 &`USER `& see below
23714 .endd
23715 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23716 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23717 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23718 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23719 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23720 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23721 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23722
23723 .cindex "HOST"
23724 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23725 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23726 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23727 the router.
23728
23729 .cindex "HOME"
23730 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23731 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23732 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23733 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23734
23735
23736 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23737 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23738
23739
23740
23741 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23742 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23743 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23744 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23745 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23746 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23747 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23748 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23749 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23750 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23751 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23752 example, if
23753 .code
23754 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23755 .endd
23756 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23757 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23758 &%use_shell%& is set.
23759
23760
23761 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23762 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23763
23764
23765 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23766 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23767 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23768
23769
23770 .option check_string pipe string unset
23771 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23772 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23773 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23774 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23775 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23776 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23777 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23778 ignored.
23779
23780
23781 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23782 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23783 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23784 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23785 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23786 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23787 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23788
23789
23790 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23791 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23792 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23793 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23794 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23795 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23796 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23797
23798
23799 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23800 See &%check_string%& above.
23801
23802
23803 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23804 .cindex "exec failure"
23805 .cindex "failure of exec"
23806 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23807 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23808 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23809 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23810 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23811
23812
23813 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23814 .cindex "signal exit"
23815 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23816 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23817 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23818 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23819
23820
23821 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23822 .cindex "force command"
23823 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23824 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23825 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23826 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23827 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23828 command. For example:
23829 .code
23830 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23831 force_command
23832 .endd
23833
23834 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23835 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23836 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23837
23838
23839 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23840 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23841 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23842 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23843 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23844 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23845
23846 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23847 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23848
23849
23850 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23851 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23852 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23853 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23854 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23855 written to the main log.
23856
23857
23858 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23859 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23860 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23861 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23862 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23863 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23864 be set.
23865
23866
23867 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23868 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23869 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23870 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23871 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23872
23873
23874 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23875 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23876 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23877 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23878 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23879 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23880 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23881 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23882
23883
23884 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23885 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23886 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23887 .code
23888 message_prefix = \
23889 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23890 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23891 .endd
23892 .cindex "Cyrus"
23893 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23894 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23895 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23896 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23897 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23898 setting
23899 .code
23900 message_prefix =
23901 .endd
23902 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23903 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23904
23905
23906 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23907 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23908 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23909 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23910 .code
23911 message_suffix =
23912 .endd
23913 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23914 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23915
23916
23917 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23918 This option is expanded and
23919 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23920 variable of the subprocess.
23921 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23922 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23923 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23924
23925
23926 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23927 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23928 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23929 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23930 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23931 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23932 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23933 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23934 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23935
23936
23937 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23938 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23939 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23940 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23941 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23942 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23943 accept the message is used.
23944
23945
23946 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23947 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23948 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23949 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23950 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23951 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23952
23953
23954 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23955 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23956 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23957 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23958 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23959 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23960 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23961
23962
23963
23964 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23965 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23966 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23967 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23968 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23969 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23970 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23971 of them may be set.
23972
23973
23974
23975 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23976 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23977 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23978 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23979 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23980 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23981 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23982 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23983 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23984 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23985 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23986 and 73, respectively.
23987
23988
23989 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23990 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23991 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23992 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23993 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23994 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23995 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23996
23997 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23998 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23999 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24000 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24001 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24002 delivery to be deferred.
24003
24004 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24005 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24006
24007
24008 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24009 .cindex "envelope sender"
24010 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24011 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24012 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24013 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24014 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24015
24016 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24017 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24018 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24019 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24020 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24021 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24022 class database.
24023
24024
24025 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24026 .cindex "carriage return"
24027 .cindex "linefeed"
24028 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24029 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24030 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24031 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24032
24033 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24034 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24035 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24036 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24037 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24038
24039
24040 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24041 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24042 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24043 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24044 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24045 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24046 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24047 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24048 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24049 its &%-c%& option.
24050
24051
24052
24053 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24054 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24055 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24056 .cindex "external local delivery"
24057 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24058 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24059 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24060 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24061 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24062 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24063 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24064 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24065 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24066 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24067 .code
24068 # transport
24069 procmail_pipe:
24070 driver = pipe
24071 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24072 return_path_add
24073 delivery_date_add
24074 envelope_to_add
24075 check_string = "From "
24076 escape_string = ">From "
24077 umask = 077
24078 user = $local_part
24079 group = mail
24080
24081 # router
24082 procmail:
24083 driver = accept
24084 check_local_user
24085 transport = procmail_pipe
24086 .endd
24087 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24088 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24089 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24090 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24091 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24092 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24093
24094 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24095 .code
24096 IFS=" "
24097 .endd
24098 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24099 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24100
24101 .cindex "Cyrus"
24102 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24103 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24104 .code
24105 # transport
24106 local_delivery_cyrus:
24107 driver = pipe
24108 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24109 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24110 user = cyrus
24111 group = mail
24112 return_output
24113 log_output
24114 message_prefix =
24115 message_suffix =
24116
24117 # router
24118 local_user_cyrus:
24119 driver = accept
24120 check_local_user
24121 local_part_suffix = .*
24122 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24123 .endd
24124 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24125 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24126 sender.
24127 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24128 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
24129
24130
24131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24132 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24133
24134 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24135 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24136 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24137 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24138 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24139 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24140 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24141 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24142
24143
24144 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24145 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24146 two ways:
24147
24148 .ilist
24149 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24150 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24151 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24152 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24153 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24154 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24155 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24156 .next
24157 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24158 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24159 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24160 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24161 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24162 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24163 process.
24164 .endlist
24165
24166
24167 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24168 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24169 no further messages are sent over that connection.
24170
24171
24172
24173 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24174 .vindex "&$host$&"
24175 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24176 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24177 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24178 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24179 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24180 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24181 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24182 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24183
24184
24185 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24186 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
24187 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24188 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24189 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
24190 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24191 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24192 are the values that were set when the message was received.
24193 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24194 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24195 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24196 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24197 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24198 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24199
24200 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24201 and will be removed in a future release.
24202
24203
24204 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24205 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24206 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24207
24208
24209 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24210 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24211 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24212 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24213 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24214 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24215 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24216 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24217
24218 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24219 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24220 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24221 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24222 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24223 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24224 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24225 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24226 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24227
24228
24229 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24230 .cindex "Cyrus"
24231 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24232 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24233 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24234 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24235 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24236 ignored.
24237
24238 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24239 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24240 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24241 particular connection.
24242
24243 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24244 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24245 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24246 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24247
24248 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24249 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24250 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24251 .code
24252 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24253 .endd
24254 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24255 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24256
24257 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24258 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24259 value.
24260
24261
24262 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24263 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24264 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24265 authenticated as a client.
24266
24267
24268 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24269 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24270 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24271 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24272
24273
24274 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24275 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24276 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24277 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24278 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24279 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24280 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24281
24282
24283 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24284 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24285 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24286 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24287 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24288 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24289 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24290 option.
24291
24292
24293 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24294 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24295 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24296 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24297 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24298 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24299 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24300 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24301 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24302 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24303 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24304 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24305 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24306 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24307
24308
24309 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24310 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24311 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24312 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24313
24314
24315 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24316 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24317 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24318 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24319 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24320 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24321 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24322 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24323 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24324 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24325
24326
24327 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24328 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24329 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
24330 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24331 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24332 cutoff times.
24333
24334 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24335 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24336 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24337 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24338 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24339 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24340
24341 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24342 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24343 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24344 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24345 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24346 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24347 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24348 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24349 to them.
24350
24351
24352 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24353 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24354 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24355 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24356 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24357
24358
24359 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24360 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24361 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24362 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24363 details.
24364
24365
24366 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24367 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24368 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24369 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24370 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24371 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24372 the dnssec request bit set.
24373 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24374
24375
24376
24377 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24378 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24379 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24380 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24381 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24382 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24383 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24384 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24385 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24386
24387
24388
24389 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24390 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24391 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24392 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24393 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24394 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24395 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24396
24397 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24398 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24399 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24400 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24401 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24402
24403
24404 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24405 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24406 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24407 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24408 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24409 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24410 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24411 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24412
24413 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24414 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24415 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24416 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24417 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24418 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24419
24420 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24421 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24422 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24423 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24424 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24425
24426 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24427 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24428 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24429 copy of the message is sent.
24430
24431 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24432 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24433 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24434 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24435 fails"& facility.
24436
24437
24438 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24439 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24440 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24441 zero.
24442
24443 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24444 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24445 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24446 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24447 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24448 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24449
24450 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24451 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24452 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24453 implementations of TLS.
24454
24455 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24456 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24457 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24458 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24459 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24460 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24461 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24462 option is:
24463 .code
24464 $primary_hostname
24465 .endd
24466 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24467 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24468 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24469 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24470 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24471 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24472 interface address, you could use this:
24473 .code
24474 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24475 {$primary_hostname}}
24476 .endd
24477 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24478 callouts.
24479
24480 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24481 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24482 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24483 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24484 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24485 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24486
24487 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24488 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24489 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24490 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24491
24492 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24493 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24494 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24495 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24496 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24497 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24498 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24499
24500 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24501 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24502 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24503 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24504 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24505 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24506 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24507 address are used.
24508
24509 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24510 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24511
24512
24513 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24514 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24515 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24516 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24517 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24518 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24519 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24520 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24521 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24522 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24523
24524
24525 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24526 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24527 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24528 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24529
24530
24531 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24532 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24533 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24534 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24535
24536 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24537 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24538 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24539 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24540 to any host that matches this list.
24541
24542
24543 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24544 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24545 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24546 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24547 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24548 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24549 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24550 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24551
24552
24553 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24554 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24555 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24556 why it exists.
24557
24558
24559
24560 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24561 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24562 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24563 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24564 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24565 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24566 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24567 explanation of when this might be needed.
24568
24569 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24570 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24571 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24572 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24573 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24574 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24575 message on the same session.
24576
24577 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24578 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24579 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24580 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24581 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24582 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24583 logging.
24584
24585
24586
24587 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24588 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24589 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24590 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24591 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24592
24593
24594 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24595 .cindex "randomized host list"
24596 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24597 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24598 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24599 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24600 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24601 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24602 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24603 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24604
24605 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24606 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24607 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24608 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24609 .code
24610 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24611 .endd
24612 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24613 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24614 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24615
24616 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24617 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24618 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24619 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24620 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24621 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24622 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24623 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24624 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24625
24626
24627 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24628 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24629 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24630 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24631 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24632
24633 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24634 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24635 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24636 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24637 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24638 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24639 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24640 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24641
24642 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24643 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24644 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24645 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24646 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24647
24648 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24649 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24650 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24651 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24652 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24653 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24654
24655 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24656 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24657 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24658 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24659 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24660 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24661 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24662
24663 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24664 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24665 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24666 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24667 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24668 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24669 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24670
24671 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24672 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24673 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24674 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24675 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24676 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24677 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24678 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24679 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24680
24681 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24682 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24683 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24684 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24685 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24686 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24687 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24688 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24689 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24690 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24691
24692 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24693 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24694
24695 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24696 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24697 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24698 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24699 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24700
24701 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24702 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24703 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24704 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24705 for multi-recipient messages.
24706 The option can usually be left as default.
24707
24708 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24709 .cindex "bind IP address"
24710 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24711 .vindex "&$host$&"
24712 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24713 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24714 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24715 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24716 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24717 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24718 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24719 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24720 unknown.
24721
24722 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24723 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24724 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24725 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24726 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24727 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24728 For example:
24729 .code
24730 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24731 .endd
24732 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24733 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24734 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24735 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24736
24737
24738 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24739 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24740 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24741 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24742 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24743 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24744 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24745 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24746 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24747 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24748 unreachable hosts.
24749
24750
24751 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24752 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24753 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24754 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24755 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24756
24757 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24758 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24759 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24760 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24761 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24762 permits this.
24763
24764
24765 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24766 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24767 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24768 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24769 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24770 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24771 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24772 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24773
24774 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24775 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24776 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24777
24778 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24779 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24780 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24781 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24782 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24783 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24784 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24785 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24786
24787 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24788 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24789 normally &"smtp"&,
24790 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
24791 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
24792 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24793 is deferred.
24794
24795 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
24796 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
24797
24798
24799
24800 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24801 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24802 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24803 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24804 .vindex "&$port$&"
24805 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24806 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24807 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24808 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24809 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24810
24811 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24812 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24813 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24814 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
24815 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
24816 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
24817
24818
24819 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24820 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24821 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24822 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24823 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24824 addresses is not affected.
24825
24826 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24827 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24828 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24829 Exim to use only the host name.
24830 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24831
24832
24833 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24834 .cindex "serializing connections"
24835 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24836 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24837 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24838 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24839 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24840 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24841 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24842
24843 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24844 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24845 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24846 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24847 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24848 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24849
24850 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24851 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24852 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24853 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24854 are used for ETRN serialization.
24855
24856 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24857
24858
24859 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24860 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24861 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24862 .cindex "size" "of message"
24863 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24864 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24865 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24866 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24867 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24868 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24869 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24870 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24871
24872 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24873 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24874
24875
24876 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24877 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24878 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24879 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24880
24881
24882 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24883 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24884 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24885 .vindex "&$host$&"
24886 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24887 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24888 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24889 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24890 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24891 details of TLS.
24892
24893 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24894 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24895 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24896 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24897 client.
24898
24899
24900 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24901 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24902 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24903 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24904 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24905
24906
24907 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24908 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24909 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24910 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24911 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24912 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24913 will fail.
24914
24915 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24916
24917
24918 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24919 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24920 .vindex "&$host$&"
24921 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24922 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24923 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24924 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24925 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24926 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24927 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24928 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24929
24930
24931 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24932 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24933 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24934 .vindex "&$host$&"
24935 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24936 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24937 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24938 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24939 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24940 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24941 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24942 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24943 ciphers is a preference order.
24944
24945
24946
24947 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24948 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24949 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24950 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24951 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24952 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24953 certificate and private key for the session.
24954
24955 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24956
24957 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24958 TLS extensions.
24959
24960
24961
24962
24963 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24964 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24965 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24966 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24967 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24968 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24969 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24970 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24971 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24972 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24973 in clear.
24974
24975
24976 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24977 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24978 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24979 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24980 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24981 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24982 Note that unless the host is in this list
24983 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24984 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24985 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24986 certificate verification succeeds.
24987
24988
24989 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24990 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24991 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24992 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24993 while verifying the server certificate,
24994 checks will be included on the host name
24995 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24996 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24997 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24998
24999 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25000
25001
25002 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25003 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25004 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25005 .vindex "&$host$&"
25006 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25007 The value of this option must be either the
25008 word "system"
25009 or the absolute path to
25010 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25011 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25012
25013 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25014 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25015 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25016 must be specified.
25017
25018 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25019 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25020
25021 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25022 explicitly
25023 either by file or directory
25024 are added to those given by the system default location.
25025
25026 The values of &$host$& and
25027 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25028 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25029
25030 For back-compatibility,
25031 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25032 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25033 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25034
25035
25036 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25037 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25038 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25039 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25040 certificate verification must succeed.
25041 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25042 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25043 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25044
25045 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25046 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25047 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25048 If built with internationalization support,
25049 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25050 to a-label form.
25051 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25052
25053
25054
25055
25056 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25057 "SECTvalhosmax"
25058 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25059 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25060 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25061 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25062 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25063
25064
25065 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25066 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25067 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25068 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25069 retrying.
25070
25071 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25072 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25073 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25074
25075 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25076 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25077 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25078 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25079 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25080
25081 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25082 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25083 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25084 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25085 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25086 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25087 see below for an exception).
25088
25089 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25090 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25091 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25092 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25093 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25094
25095 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25096 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25097 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25098 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25099 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25100 reached their retry times.
25101
25102 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25103 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25104 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25105 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25106 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25107 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25108 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25109 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25110 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25111 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25112 reached.
25113
25114 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25115 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25116 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25117 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25118 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25119 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25120
25121 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25122 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25123 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25124 possible IP addresses have been tried.
25125 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
25126 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
25127
25128
25129
25130
25131
25132 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25133 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25134
25135 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25136 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25137 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25138 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25139 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25140 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25141
25142 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25143 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25144 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25145 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25146 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25147 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25148 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25149
25150 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25151 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25152 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25153 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25154
25155
25156 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25157 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25158 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25159 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25160
25161 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25162 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25163 facility; you do not have to use it.
25164
25165 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25166 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25167 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25168 address to which it applies.
25169
25170 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25171 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25172 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25173 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25174 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25175 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25176 rules.
25177
25178 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25179 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25180 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25181 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25182
25183
25184 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25185 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25186 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25187 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25188 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25189 discouraged.
25190
25191 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25192 illustrated by these examples:
25193
25194 .ilist
25195 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25196 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25197 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25198 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25199 .next
25200 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25201 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25202 .endlist
25203
25204
25205
25206 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25207 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25208 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25209 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25210 message's processing.
25211
25212 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25213 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25214 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25215 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25216 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25217 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25218 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25219 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25220 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25221
25222 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25223 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25224 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25225 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25226 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25227 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25228 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25229 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25230 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25231 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25232
25233 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25234 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25235 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25236 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25237 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25238 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25239
25240 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25241 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25242 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25243
25244 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25245 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25246 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25247 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25248 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25249 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25250 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25251 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25252 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25253
25254 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25255 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25256 transport time.
25257
25258
25259
25260
25261 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25262 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25263 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25264 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25265 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25266 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
25267 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25268 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25269 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25270 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25271 .code
25272 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25273 .endd
25274 might produce the output
25275 .code
25276 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25277 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25278 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25279 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25280 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25281 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25282 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25283 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25284 .endd
25285 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25286 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25287 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25288 set for a particular transport.
25289
25290
25291 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25292 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25293 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25294 rules in the form
25295 .display
25296 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25297 .endd
25298 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25299 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25300 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25301 any colons must be doubled, of course).
25302
25303 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25304 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25305 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25306 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25307 ignored.
25308
25309 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25310 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25311 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25312
25313 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25314 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25315 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25316 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25317 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25318 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25319 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25320
25321 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25322 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25323 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25324 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25325 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25326 .code
25327 *@* ${lookup ...
25328 .endd
25329 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25330 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25331
25332
25333 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25334 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25335 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25336 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25337 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25338 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25339 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25340 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25341 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25342
25343 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25344 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25345 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25346
25347 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25348 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25349 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25350 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25351 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25352 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25353 of pattern they are set as follows:
25354
25355 .ilist
25356 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25357 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25358 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25359 pattern
25360 .code
25361 *queen@*.fict.example
25362 .endd
25363 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25364 .code
25365 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25366 $1 = hearts-
25367 $2 = wonderland
25368 .endd
25369 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25370 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25371
25372 .next
25373 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25374 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25375 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25376 rewriting rule of the form
25377 .display
25378 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25379 .endd
25380 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25381 .code
25382 $1 = foo
25383 $2 = bar
25384 $3 = baz.example
25385 .endd
25386 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25387 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25388 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25389 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25390 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25391 .endlist
25392
25393
25394 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25395 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25396 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25397 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25398 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25399 .code
25400 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25401 .endd
25402 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25403 &'From:'& headers.
25404
25405 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25406 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25407 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25408 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25409 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25410 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25411 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25412 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25413 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25414 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25415 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25416 entry written to the panic log.
25417
25418
25419
25420 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25421 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25422
25423 .ilist
25424 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25425 c, f, h, r, s, t.
25426 .next
25427 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25428 .next
25429 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25430 .endlist
25431
25432 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25433 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25434
25435
25436
25437 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25438 "SECID154"
25439 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25440 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25441 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25442 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25443 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25444 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25445 .display
25446 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25447 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25448 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25449 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25450 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25451 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25452 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25453 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25454 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25455 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25456 .endd
25457 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25458 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25459 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25460
25461 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25462 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25463
25464
25465 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25466 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25467 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25468 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25469 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25470 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25471 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25472 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25473 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25474
25475 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25476 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25477 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25478 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25479 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25480 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25481 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25482 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25483
25484
25485 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25486 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25487 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25488 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25489
25490 .ilist
25491 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25492 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25493 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25494 .next
25495 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25496 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25497 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25498 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25499 .next
25500 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25501 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25502 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25503 .next
25504 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25505 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25506 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25507 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25508 .code
25509 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25510 .endd
25511 into
25512 .code
25513 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25514 .endd
25515 .cindex "RFC 2047"
25516 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25517 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25518 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25519 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25520 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25521 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25522 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25523 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25524
25525 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25526 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25527 .endlist
25528
25529
25530 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25531 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25532 .code
25533 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25534 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25535 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25536 .endd
25537 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25538 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25539 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25540 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25541 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25542 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25543 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25544 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25545
25546 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25547 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25548 .code
25549 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25550 .endd
25551 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25552 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25553
25554 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25555 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25556 messages that originate outside the local host:
25557 .code
25558 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25559 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25560 .endd
25561 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25562 space.
25563
25564 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25565 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25566 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25567 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25568 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25569 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25570 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25571 components. For example, the rule
25572 .code
25573 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25574 .endd
25575 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25576 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25577 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25578 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25579 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25580 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25581 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25582 .ecindex IIDaddrew
25583
25584
25585
25586
25587
25588 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25589 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25590
25591 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25592 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25593 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25594 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25595 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25596 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25597 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25598 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25599 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25600 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25601 address, domain and error.
25602
25603 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25604 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25605 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25606 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25607 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25608 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25609 log selector is set, the message
25610 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25611 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25612 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25613 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25614
25615 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25616 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25617 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25618 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25619 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25620 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25621 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25622 domain are maintained independently.
25623
25624 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25625 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25626 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25627 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25628 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25629 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25630 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25631 the local address is reached.
25632
25633 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25634 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25635 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25636 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25637 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25638
25639 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25640 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25641 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25642 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25643 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25644 messages that it should now be retaining.
25645
25646
25647
25648 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25649 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25650 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25651 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25652 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25653 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25654 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25655 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25656 message's sender, respectively.
25657
25658
25659 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25660 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25661 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25662 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25663 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25664 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25665 example,
25666 .code
25667 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25668 .endd
25669 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25670 whereas
25671 .code
25672 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25673 .endd
25674 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25675 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25676 part.
25677
25678 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25679 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25680 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25681 expressions work in address lists.
25682 .display
25683 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25684 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25685 .endd
25686
25687
25688 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25689 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25690 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25691 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25692 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25693 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25694 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25695 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25696 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25697
25698 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25699 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25700 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25701 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25702 local transports).
25703
25704 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25705 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25706 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25707 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25708 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25709 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25710 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25711 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25712 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25713 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25714 commands.
25715
25716
25717
25718 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25719 "SECID160"
25720 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25721 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25722 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25723 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25724 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25725 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25726 .code
25727 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25728 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25729 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25730 .endd
25731 and the retry rules are
25732 .code
25733 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25734 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25735 .endd
25736 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25737 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25738 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25739 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25740 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25741 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25742
25743 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25744 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25745 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25746 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25747
25748 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25749 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25750 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25751 .code
25752 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25753 .endd
25754 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25755 textual form of the IP address.
25756
25757 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25758 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25759 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25760 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25761
25762 .vlist
25763 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25764 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25765 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25766
25767 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25768 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25769 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25770
25771 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25772 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25773
25774 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25775 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25776 .endlist
25777
25778 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25779 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25780 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25781 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25782 retry rule of this form:
25783 .code
25784 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25785 .endd
25786 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25787 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25788
25789 .vlist
25790 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25791 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25792 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25793 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25794
25795 .vitem &%lookup%&
25796 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25797 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25798 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25799 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25800 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25801
25802 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25803 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25804
25805 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25806 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25807
25808 .vitem &%refused%&
25809 A connection was refused.
25810
25811 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25812 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25813
25814 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25815 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25816
25817 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25818 A connection attempt timed out.
25819
25820 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25821 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25822 obtained from an MX record.
25823
25824 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25825 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25826 obtained from an MX record.
25827
25828 .vitem &%timeout%&
25829 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25830
25831 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25832 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25833 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25834 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25835
25836 .vitem &%quota%&
25837 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25838 transport.
25839
25840 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25841 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25842 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25843 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25844 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25845 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25846 for four days.
25847 .endlist
25848
25849 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25850 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25851 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25852 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25853 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25854 heuristic rules:
25855
25856 .ilist
25857 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25858 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25859 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25860 .next
25861 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25862 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25863 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25864 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25865 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25866 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25867 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25868 .next
25869 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25870 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25871 .endlist
25872
25873 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25874 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25875 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25876 error).
25877
25878
25879
25880 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25881 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25882 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25883 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25884 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25885 form:
25886 .display
25887 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25888 .endd
25889 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25890 .code
25891 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25892 .endd
25893 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25894 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25895 For example:
25896 .code
25897 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25898 .endd
25899 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25900 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25901 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25902 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25903 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25904
25905 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25906 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25907 .code
25908 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25909 .endd
25910 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25911 list is never matched.
25912
25913
25914
25915
25916
25917 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25918 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25919 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25920 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25921 .display
25922 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25923 .endd
25924 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25925 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25926 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25927 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25928 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25929
25930 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25931 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25932 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25933 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25934 The available algorithms are:
25935
25936 .ilist
25937 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25938 the interval.
25939 .next
25940 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25941 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25942 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25943 .next
25944 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25945 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25946 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25947 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25948 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25949 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25950 queue processing times.
25951 .endlist
25952
25953 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25954 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25955 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25956 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25957 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25958 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25959 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25960 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25961 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25962 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25963 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25964 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25965
25966 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25967 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25968 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25969 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25970 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25971 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25972 time.
25973
25974 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25975 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25976 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25977 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25978 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25979 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25980 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25981 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25982 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25983 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25984 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25985 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25986
25987 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25988 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25989 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25990 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25991 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25992 deliveries that have been deferred.
25993
25994
25995 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25996 Here are some example retry rules:
25997 .code
25998 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25999 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26000 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26001 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26002 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26003 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26004 .endd
26005 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26006 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26007 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26008 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26009 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26010 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26011 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26012 days.
26013
26014 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26015 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26016 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26017 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26018 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26019
26020 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26021 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26022 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26023 were not obtained from an MX record.
26024
26025 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26026 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26027 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26028 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26029 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26030
26031
26032
26033 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26034 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26035 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26036 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26037 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26038 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26039 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26040 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26041 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26042 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26043 failing for the first time.
26044
26045 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26046 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26047 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26048 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26049
26050 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26051 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26052 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26053
26054
26055
26056
26057 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26058 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26059 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26060 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26061 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26062 default retry rule:
26063 .code
26064 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26065 .endd
26066 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26067 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26068 failure for the recipient address that counts.
26069
26070 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26071 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26072 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26073 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26074 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26075
26076 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26077 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26078 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26079
26080 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26081 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
26082 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26083 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26084 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26085 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26086 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26087 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26088 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26089 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26090 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26091
26092 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26093 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26094 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26095 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26096 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26097 notice.
26098
26099 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26100 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26101 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26102 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26103 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26104 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26105 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26106 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26107 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26108 true.
26109
26110 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26111 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26112 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26113 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26114 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26115 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26116 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26117 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26118 reached.
26119
26120 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26121 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26122 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26123 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26124 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26125 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26126 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26127 time out the address.
26128
26129 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26130 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26131 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26132 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26133 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26134 considered immediately.
26135 .ecindex IIDretconf1
26136 .ecindex IIDregconf2
26137
26138
26139
26140
26141
26142
26143 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26144 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26145
26146 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26147 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26148 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26149 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26150 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26151 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26152 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26153 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26154 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26155 other.
26156
26157 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26158 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26159
26160 .ilist
26161 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26162 the client's EHLO command.
26163 .next
26164 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26165 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26166 .next
26167 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26168 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26169 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26170 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26171 with the AUTH command.
26172 .next
26173 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26174 .next
26175 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26176 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26177 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26178 connection.
26179 .next
26180 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26181 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26182 unauthenticated connection.
26183 .endlist
26184
26185 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26186 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26187 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26188 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26189 .display
26190 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26191 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26192 &`Connected to server.example.`&
26193 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26194 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26195 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26196 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26197 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26198 &`250-PIPELINING`&
26199 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26200 &`250 HELP`&
26201 .endd
26202 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26203 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26204 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26205 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26206 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26207 included by setting
26208 .code
26209 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26210 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26211 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26212 AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26213 AUTH_GSASL=yes
26214 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26215 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26216 AUTH_SPA=yes
26217 AUTH_TLS=yes
26218 .endd
26219 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26220 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26221 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26222 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26223 work via a socket interface.
26224 .new
26225 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26226 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26227 .wen
26228 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26229 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26230 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26231 supporting setting a server keytab.
26232 The seventh can be configured to support
26233 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26234 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26235 The eighth authenticator
26236 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26237 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26238 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26239
26240 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26241 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26242 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26243 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26244 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26245 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26246 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26247
26248 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26249 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26250 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26251 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26252 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26253 both sets of options, is required. For example:
26254 .code
26255 cram:
26256 driver = cram_md5
26257 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26258 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26259 client_name = ph10
26260 client_secret = secret2
26261 .endd
26262 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26263 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26264
26265 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26266 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26267 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26268 in Exim.
26269
26270 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26271 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26272 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26273 authenticating data.
26274
26275 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26276 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26277 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26278 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26279 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26280 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26281 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26282 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26283 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26284 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26285 choose to honour.
26286
26287 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26288 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26289 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26290 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26291
26292
26293
26294 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26295 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26296 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26297
26298 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26299 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26300 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26301 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26302 encrypted by a setting such as:
26303 .code
26304 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26305 .endd
26306
26307
26308 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26309 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26310 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26311 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26312
26313
26314 .option driver authenticators string unset
26315 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26316 authenticators is to be used.
26317
26318
26319 .option public_name authenticators string unset
26320 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26321 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26322 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26323 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26324 defaults to the driver's instance name.
26325
26326
26327 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26328 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26329 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26330 mechanism is not advertised.
26331 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26332 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26333 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26334
26335
26336 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26337 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26338 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26339 for details.
26340
26341 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26342 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26343
26344 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26345 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26346 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26347 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26348 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26349 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26350 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26351 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26352 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26353 the error text.
26354
26355
26356 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26357 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26358 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26359 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26360 out the values of variables.
26361 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26362 output, and Exim carries on processing.
26363
26364
26365 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26366 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26367 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26368 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26369 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26370 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26371 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26372 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26373 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26374 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26375 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26376 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26377
26378
26379 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26380 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26381 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26382 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26383 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26384 remembered for later use.
26385 How it is used is described in the following section.
26386
26387
26388
26389
26390
26391 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26392 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26393 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26394 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26395 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26396 message:
26397
26398 .ilist
26399 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26400 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26401 .next
26402 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26403 .next
26404 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26405 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26406 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26407 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26408 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26409 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26410 given for the MAIL command.
26411 .next
26412 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26413 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26414 authenticated.
26415 .next
26416 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26417 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26418 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26419 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26420 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26421 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26422 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26423 message.
26424 .endlist
26425
26426
26427 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26428 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26429 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26430 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26431
26432 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26433 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26434 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26435 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26436 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26437 ACL is run.
26438
26439
26440
26441 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26442 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26443 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26444 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26445 conditions:
26446
26447 .ilist
26448 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26449 .next
26450 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26451 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26452 .endlist
26453
26454 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26455 the mechanisms are advertised.
26456
26457 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26458 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26459 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26460 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26461 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26462 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26463 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26464 .code
26465 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26466 .endd
26467 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26468
26469 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26470 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26471 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26472 such as:
26473 .code
26474 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26475 .endd
26476 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26477 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26478 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26479
26480 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26481 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26482 command. This is the case if
26483
26484 .ilist
26485 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26486 .next
26487 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26488 .next
26489 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26490 server authenticators.
26491 .endlist
26492
26493
26494 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26495 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26496 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26497
26498 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26499 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26500 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26501 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26502 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26503 rejected with a 504 error.
26504
26505 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26506 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26507 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26508 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26509 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26510 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26511 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26512 no successful authentication.
26513
26514 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26515 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26516 &$authresults$& expansion item.
26517
26518
26519
26520
26521 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26522 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26523 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26524 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26525 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26526 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26527 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26528 script:
26529 .code
26530 use MIME::Base64;
26531 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26532 .endd
26533 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26534 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26535 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26536 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26537 command line to run this script on such data might be
26538 .code
26539 encode '\0user\0password'
26540 .endd
26541 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26542 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26543 whose code value is zero.
26544
26545 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26546 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26547 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26548 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26549
26550 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26551 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26552 example, a command such as
26553 .code
26554 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26555 .endd
26556 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26557
26558 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26559 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26560 .code
26561 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26562 .endd
26563 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26564 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26565 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26566 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26567
26568
26569
26570 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26571 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26572 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26573 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26574 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26575 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26576
26577 .ilist
26578 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26579 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26580 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26581 of the authenticator.
26582 .next
26583 .vindex "&$host$&"
26584 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26585 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26586 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26587 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26588 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26589 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26590 delivery to be deferred.
26591 .next
26592 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26593 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26594 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26595 usual way.
26596 .next
26597 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26598 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26599 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26600 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26601 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26602 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26603 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26604 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26605 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26606 .endlist
26607
26608 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26609 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26610 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26611 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26612 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26613 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26614 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26615 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26616
26617 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26618
26619 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26620 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26621 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26622 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26623 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26624 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26625 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26626 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26627 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26628 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26629 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26630 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26631 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26632
26633
26634
26635
26636
26637
26638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26640
26641 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26642 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26643 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26644 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26645 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26646 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26647 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26648 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26649 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26650 connections as you do for login accounts.
26651
26652 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26653 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26654 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26655
26656 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26657 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26658 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26659
26660 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26661 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26662 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26663 given.
26664
26665 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26666 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26667 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26668 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26669 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26670 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26671 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26672
26673 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26674 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26675 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26676 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26677 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26678 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26679 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26680
26681 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26682 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26683 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26684 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26685
26686 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26687 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26688 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26689
26690 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26691 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26692 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26693 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26694 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26695 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26696 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26697 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26698 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26699 string as the error text.
26700
26701 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26702 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26703 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26704
26705
26706
26707 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26708 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26709 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26710 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26711 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26712 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26713 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26714 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26715
26716 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26717 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26718 configured as follows:
26719 .code
26720 fixed_plain:
26721 driver = plaintext
26722 public_name = PLAIN
26723 server_prompts = :
26724 server_condition = \
26725 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26726 server_set_id = $auth2
26727 .endd
26728 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26729 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26730 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26731 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26732
26733 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26734 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26735 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26736 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26737 .code
26738 250-AUTH PLAIN
26739 .endd
26740 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26741 .code
26742 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26743 .endd
26744 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26745 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26746 .code
26747 AUTH PLAIN
26748 .endd
26749 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26750 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26751
26752 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26753 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26754 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26755 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26756 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26757
26758 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26759 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26760 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26761
26762 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26763 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26764 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26765 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26766 This is an incorrect example:
26767 .code
26768 server_condition = \
26769 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26770 .endd
26771 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26772 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26773 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26774 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26775 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26776 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26777 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26778 .code
26779 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26780 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26781 .endd
26782 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26783 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26784 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26785 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26786 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26787
26788
26789 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26790 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26791 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26792 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26793 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26794 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26795 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26796 .code
26797 fixed_login:
26798 driver = plaintext
26799 public_name = LOGIN
26800 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26801 server_condition = \
26802 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26803 server_set_id = $auth1
26804 .endd
26805 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26806 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26807 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26808 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26809
26810 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26811 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26812 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26813 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26814 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26815 .code
26816 login:
26817 driver = plaintext
26818 public_name = LOGIN
26819 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26820 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26821 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
26822 ldapauth{\
26823 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26824 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26825 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26826 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26827 .endd
26828 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26829 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26830 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26831 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26832 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26833 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26834 uninterpreted string.
26835
26836
26837 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26838 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26839 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26840 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26841 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26842 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
26843
26844
26845
26846
26847 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26848 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26849 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26850
26851 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26852 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26853 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26854 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26855 usual.
26856
26857 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26858 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26859 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26860 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26861 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26862 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26863 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26864 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26865 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26866 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26867 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26868 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26869
26870 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26871 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26872
26873 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26874 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26875 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26876 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26877 the string.
26878
26879 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26880 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26881 .code
26882 fixed_plain:
26883 driver = plaintext
26884 public_name = PLAIN
26885 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26886 .endd
26887 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26888 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26889 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26890 .code
26891 fixed_login:
26892 driver = plaintext
26893 public_name = LOGIN
26894 client_send = : username : mysecret
26895 .endd
26896 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26897 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26898 prompts.
26899 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26900 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26901
26902
26903
26904
26905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26906 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26907
26908 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26909 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26910 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26911 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26912 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26913 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26914 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26915 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26916 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26917 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26918 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26919 available in plain text at either end.
26920
26921
26922 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26923 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26924 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26925 authenticator as a server:
26926
26927 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26928 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26929 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26930 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26931 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26932 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26933 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26934 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26935 returned to the client.
26936
26937 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26938 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26939 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26940 numeric variables for other things.
26941
26942 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26943 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26944 user name, authentication fails.
26945 .code
26946 fixed_cram:
26947 driver = cram_md5
26948 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26949 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26950 server_set_id = $auth1
26951 .endd
26952 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26953 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26954 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26955 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26956 .code
26957 lookup_cram:
26958 driver = cram_md5
26959 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26960 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26961 {$value}fail}
26962 server_set_id = $auth1
26963 .endd
26964 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26965 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26966
26967 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26968 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26969 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26970 realm, with:
26971 .code
26972 cyrusless_crammd5:
26973 driver = cram_md5
26974 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26975 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26976 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26977 server_set_id = $auth1
26978 .endd
26979
26980 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26981 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26982 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26983
26984
26985
26986 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26987 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26988 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26989
26990
26991 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26992 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26993 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26994
26995
26996 .vindex "&$host$&"
26997 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26998 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26999 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27000 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27001 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27002 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27003 send the message to the current server.
27004
27005 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27006 strings, is:
27007 .code
27008 fixed_cram:
27009 driver = cram_md5
27010 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27011 client_name = ph10
27012 client_secret = secret
27013 .endd
27014 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27015 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27016
27017
27018
27019 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27020 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27021
27022 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27023 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27024 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27025 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27026 .cindex "Kerberos"
27027 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27028 at A L Digital Ltd.
27029
27030 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27031 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27032 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27033 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27034 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27035
27036 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27037 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27038 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27039 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27040
27041 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27042 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27043 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27044 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27045 depending on the driver you are using.
27046
27047 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27048 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27049 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27050 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27051 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27052 implementation.
27053
27054 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27055 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27056 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27057 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27058 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27059 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27060 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27061 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27062
27063
27064 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27065 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27066 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27067 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27068 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27069 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27070 things.
27071
27072
27073 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27074 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27075 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27076 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27077
27078
27079 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27080 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27081 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27082 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27083 example:
27084 .code
27085 sasl:
27086 driver = cyrus_sasl
27087 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27088 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27089 server_set_id = $auth1
27090 .endd
27091
27092 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27093 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27094
27095
27096 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27097 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27098
27099
27100 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27101 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27102 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27103 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27104 .code
27105 sasl_cram_md5:
27106 driver = cyrus_sasl
27107 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27108 server_set_id = $auth1
27109
27110 sasl_plain:
27111 driver = cyrus_sasl
27112 public_name = PLAIN
27113 server_set_id = $auth2
27114 .endd
27115 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27116 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27117 but it is present in many binary distributions.
27118 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27119 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27120
27121
27122
27123
27124 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27125 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27126 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27127 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27128 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27129 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27130 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27131 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27132 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27133 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27134 authenticator only. There is only one option:
27135
27136 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
27137
27138 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27139 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27140 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27141 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27142 .code
27143 dovecot_plain:
27144 driver = dovecot
27145 public_name = PLAIN
27146 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27147 server_set_id = $auth1
27148
27149 dovecot_ntlm:
27150 driver = dovecot
27151 public_name = NTLM
27152 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27153 server_set_id = $auth1
27154 .endd
27155 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27156 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27157 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27158 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27159 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27160 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27161 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27162 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27163
27164
27165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27167 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27168 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27169 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27170 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27171 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27172 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27173 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27174 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27175 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27176 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27177 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27178 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27179 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
27180 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27181 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27182 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27183 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27184 without code changes in Exim.
27185
27186 Exim's &(gsasl)& authenticator does not have client-side support at this
27187 time; only the server-side support is implemented. Patches welcome.
27188
27189
27190 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27191 Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27192
27193 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27194 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27195 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27196 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27197 context.
27198
27199 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27200 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27201 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27202
27203 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
27204 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27205 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27206
27207 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27208 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27209 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27210
27211 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
27212 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27213 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27214
27215
27216 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27217 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27218 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27219 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27220
27221
27222 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27223 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27224 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27225 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27226 example:
27227 .code
27228 sasl:
27229 driver = gsasl
27230 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27231 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27232 server_set_id = $auth1
27233 .endd
27234
27235
27236 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27237 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27238 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27239 the password itself.
27240
27241 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27242 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27243 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27244 if available, else the empty string.
27245 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27246 else the empty string.
27247
27248 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27249
27250 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27251 option to be simply "true".
27252
27253
27254 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27255 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27256 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27257
27258
27259 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
27260 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27261 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27262 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27263
27264
27265 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27266 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27267 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27268 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27269
27270
27271 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27272 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27273 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27274
27275
27276 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27277 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27278 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27279 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27280
27281 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27282 meanings for these variables:
27283
27284 .ilist
27285 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27286 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27287 .next
27288 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27289 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27290 .next
27291 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
27292 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27293 .endlist
27294
27295 On a per-mechanism basis:
27296
27297 .ilist
27298 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27299 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27300 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27301 .next
27302 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27303 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27304 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27305 .next
27306 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27307 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27308 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27309 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27310 .endlist
27311
27312 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27313 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27314 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27315
27316
27317 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27318 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27319 .code
27320 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27321 driver = gsasl
27322 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27323 server_realm = imap.example.org
27324 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27325 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27326 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27327 server_condition = yes
27328 .endd
27329
27330
27331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27332 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27333
27334 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27335 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27336 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27337 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27338 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27339 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27340 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27341 reliably.
27342
27343 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27344 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27345 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27346 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27347
27348 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27349 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27350 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27351 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27352
27353 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27354 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27355 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27356 from the keytab.
27357
27358
27359 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27360 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27361 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27362 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27363
27364 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27365 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27366 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27367 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27368
27369 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27370 .ilist
27371 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27372 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27373 .next
27374 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27375 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27376 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27377 GSS Display Name.
27378 .endlist
27379
27380
27381 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27382 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27383
27384 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27385 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27386 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27387 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27388 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27389 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27390 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27391 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27392 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27393 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27394 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27395 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27396 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27397 follows:
27398
27399 .ilist
27400 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27401 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27402 .next
27403 The server sends back a challenge.
27404 .next
27405 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27406 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27407 .endlist
27408
27409 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27410
27411
27412
27413 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27414 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27415 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27416
27417 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27418 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27419 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27420 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27421 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27422 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27423 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27424 for other things. For example:
27425 .code
27426 spa:
27427 driver = spa
27428 public_name = NTLM
27429 server_password = \
27430 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27431 .endd
27432 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27433 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27434
27435
27436
27437
27438
27439 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27440 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27441 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27442
27443
27444
27445 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27446 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27447
27448
27449 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27450 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27451
27452
27453 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27454 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27455 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27456 &'msn.com'&:
27457 .code
27458 msn:
27459 driver = spa
27460 public_name = MSN
27461 client_username = msn/msn_username
27462 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27463 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27464 .endd
27465 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27466 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27467
27468
27469
27470
27471
27472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27473 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27474
27475 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27476 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27477 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27478 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27479 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27480 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27481 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27482 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27483 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27484 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27485 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27486 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27487 by the server configuration.
27488
27489 The client presents an identity in-clear.
27490 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27491 and for clients to only attempt,
27492 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27493
27494 One possible use, compatible with the
27495 K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27496 is for using X509 client certificates.
27497
27498 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27499 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27500 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27501 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27502 client certificates only.
27503
27504 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27505 client-certificate authentication is being done.
27506
27507 The client must present a certificate,
27508 for which it must have been requested via the
27509 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27510 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27511 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27512 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27513
27514 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27515 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27516 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27517
27518 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27519 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27520 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27521 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27522 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27523 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27524 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27525
27526 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27527
27528 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27529 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27530 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27531 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27532 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27533 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27534
27535 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27536 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27537 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27538 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27539 an identity for authentication and
27540 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27541
27542 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27543 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27544 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27545 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27546
27547 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27548 Once an identity has been received,
27549 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27550 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27551 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27552 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27553 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27554 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27555 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27556 string as the error text.
27557
27558 Example:
27559 .code
27560 ext_ccert_san_mail:
27561 driver = external
27562 public_name = EXTERNAL
27563
27564 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27565 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27566 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27567 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27568 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27569 server_set_id = $auth1
27570 .endd
27571 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27572 of your configured trust-anchors
27573 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27574 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27575
27576 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27577 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27578 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27579 in this way.
27580 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27581
27582
27583 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27584 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27585 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27586
27587 .option client_send external string&!! unset
27588 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27589 identity being asserted.
27590
27591 Example:
27592 .code
27593 ext_ccert:
27594 driver = external
27595 public_name = EXTERNAL
27596
27597 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27598 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27599 .endd
27600
27601
27602 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
27603 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
27604
27605
27606
27607
27608
27609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27610 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27611
27612 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27613 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27614 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27615 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27616 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27617 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27618 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27619 authentication based on client certificates.
27620
27621 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27622 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27623 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27624 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27625 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27626 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27627
27628 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27629 for which it must have been requested via the
27630 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27631 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27632
27633 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27634 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27635 and can authenticate the connection.
27636 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27637
27638 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27639
27640
27641 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27642 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27643
27644 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27645 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27646 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27647 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27648 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27649 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27650
27651 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27652 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27653 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27654
27655 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27656
27657
27658 Example:
27659 .code
27660 tls:
27661 driver = tls
27662 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27663 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27664 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27665 {forany {$auth1} \
27666 {!= {0} \
27667 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27668 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27669 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27670 } } } }}}
27671 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27672 .endd
27673 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27674 of your configured trust-anchors
27675 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27676 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27677
27678 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27679 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27680 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27681 in this way.
27682 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27683
27684 . An alternative might use
27685 . .code
27686 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27687 . .endd
27688 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27689 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27690 . This would help for per-device use.
27691 .
27692 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27693 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27694
27695 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27696 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27697
27698
27699 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27700 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27701 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27702
27703
27704
27705 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27706 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27707
27708 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27709 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27710 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27711 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27712 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27713 .cindex "OpenSSL"
27714 .cindex "GnuTLS"
27715 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27716 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27717 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27718 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27719 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27720 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27721 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27722 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27723 certificates are used.
27724
27725 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27726 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27727 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27728 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27729 between them is encrypted.
27730
27731 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27732 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27733 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27734 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27735 encryption state.
27736
27737 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27738 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27739 in order to get TLS to work.
27740
27741
27742
27743 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27744 "SECID284"
27745 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27746 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27747 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27748 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27749 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27750 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27751 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27752 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27753 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27754 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27755 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27756
27757 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27758 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27759 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27760
27761 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27762 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27763 reassigned for other use.
27764 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27765 this port.
27766 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27767 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27768 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27769
27770 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27771 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27772 the most common use is expected to be:
27773 .code
27774 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27775 .endd
27776 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27777 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27778 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27779 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27780 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27781 defined elsewhere.
27782
27783 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27784 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27785
27786
27787
27788
27789
27790
27791 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27792 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27793 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27794 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27795 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27796 .code
27797 USE_GNUTLS=yes
27798 .endd
27799 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27800 .code
27801 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
27802 .endd
27803 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27804 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27805
27806 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27807
27808 .ilist
27809 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27810 cannot be the path of a directory
27811 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27812 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27813 .next
27814 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27815 .next
27816 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27817 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27818 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27819 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27820 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27821 .next
27822 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27823 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27824 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27825 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27826 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27827 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27828 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27829 option).
27830 .next
27831 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27832 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27833 .next
27834 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27835 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27836 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27837 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27838 .next
27839 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27840 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27841 .next
27842 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27843 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27844 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27845 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27846 .endlist
27847
27848
27849 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27850 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27851 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27852 but not the chosen filename.
27853 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27854 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27855
27856 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27857 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27858 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27859 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27860 of bits requested.
27861 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27862 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27863 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27864 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27865 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27866 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27867 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27868
27869 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27870 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27871 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27872 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27873 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27874
27875 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27876 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27877 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27878 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27879 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27880 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27881
27882 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27883 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27884 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27885
27886 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27887 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27888 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27889 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27890 .code
27891 # ls
27892 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27893 # rm -f new-params
27894 # touch new-params
27895 # chown exim:exim new-params
27896 # chmod 0600 new-params
27897 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27898 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27899 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27900 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27901 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27902 # chmod 0400 new-params
27903 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27904 .endd
27905 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27906 stalling is removed.
27907
27908 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27909 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27910 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27911 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27912 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27913 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27914 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27915 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27916 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27917 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27918 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27919
27920 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27921 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27922 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27923 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27924
27925 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27926 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27927 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27928 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27929 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27930
27931
27932 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27933 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27934 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27935 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27936 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27937 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
27938 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27939 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27940 directly to this function call.
27941 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27942 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27943 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27944 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27945
27946 .ilist
27947 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27948 .next
27949 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27950 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27951 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27952 SSL v3 algorithms.
27953 .next
27954 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27955 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27956 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27957 algorithms.
27958 .endlist
27959
27960 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27961 &`-`& or &`+`&.
27962 .ilist
27963 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27964 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27965 stated.
27966 .next
27967 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27968 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27969 .next
27970 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27971 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27972 .endlist
27973
27974 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27975 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27976 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27977 not be moved to the end of the list.
27978 .endlist
27979
27980 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27981 string:
27982 .code
27983 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27984 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27985 .endd
27986
27987 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27988 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27989 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27990 choice of clients used:
27991 .code
27992 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27993 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27994 {DEFAULT}\
27995 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
27996 .endd
27997
27998 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27999 .code
28000 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28001 .endd
28002
28003 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28004 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28005 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28006 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28007
28008 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28009 .code
28010 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28011 .endd
28012
28013
28014 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28015 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28016 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28017 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28018 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28019 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28020 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28021 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28022 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28023 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28024 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28025 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28026
28027 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28028 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28029
28030 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28031 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28032 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28033 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28034 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28035 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28036
28037 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28038 "Priority strings". This is online as
28039 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28040 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28041 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28042 then the example code
28043 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28044 on that site can be used to test a given string.
28045
28046 For example:
28047 .code
28048 # Disable older versions of protocols
28049 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28050 .endd
28051
28052 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28053 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28054 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28055
28056 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28057 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28058 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28059 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28060 used:
28061 .code
28062 # GnuTLS variant
28063 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28064 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28065 {SECURE128}}
28066 .endd
28067
28068
28069 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28070 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28071 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28072 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28073 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28074 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28075 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28076
28077 If STARTTLS is to be used you
28078 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28079
28080 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28081 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28082 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28083 with the error
28084 .code
28085 554 Security failure
28086 .endd
28087 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28088 rejected with a 554 error code.
28089
28090 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28091 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28092
28093 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28094 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28095 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28096 from someone able to intercept the communication.
28097
28098 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28099
28100 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28101 .code
28102 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28103 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28104 .endd
28105 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28106 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28107 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28108 that goes with it. These files need to be
28109 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28110 always be given as full path names.
28111 The key must not be password-protected.
28112 They can be the same file if both the
28113 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28114 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28115 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28116 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28117 the server's certificate.
28118
28119 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28120 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28121 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28122 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28123 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28124 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28125
28126 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28127 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28128 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28129
28130 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28131 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28132 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28133 transport.
28134
28135 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28136 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28137 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28138 .code
28139 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28140 .endd
28141 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28142 with the parameters contained in the file.
28143 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28144 available:
28145 .code
28146 tls_dhparam = none
28147 .endd
28148 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28149 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28150 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28151 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28152
28153 See the command
28154 .code
28155 openssl dhparam
28156 .endd
28157 for a way of generating file data.
28158
28159 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28160 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28161 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28162 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28163 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28164
28165 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28166 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28167 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28168 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28169 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28170 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28171 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28172 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28173 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28174
28175 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28176 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28177 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28178 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28179 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28180 documentation for more details.
28181
28182 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28183 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28184
28185
28186 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28187 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28188 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28189 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28190 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28191 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28192 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28193 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28194 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28195 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28196 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28197 an explicit file or,
28198 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28199 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28200
28201 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28202 directory is used
28203 (OpenSSL only),
28204 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28205 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28206 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28207 .code
28208 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28209 .endd
28210 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28211
28212 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28213 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28214
28215 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28216 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28217 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28218 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28219 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28220 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28221 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28222 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28223 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28224 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28225
28226 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28227 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28228 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28229 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28230
28231 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28232 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28233 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28234 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28235 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28236 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28237
28238
28239 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28240 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28241 .cindex "revocation list"
28242 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28243 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28244 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28245 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28246 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28247 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28248 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28249 CRL in PEM format.
28250 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28251 file from every certificate authority they know of.
28252
28253 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28254 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28255 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28256 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28257 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28258 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28259
28260 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28261 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28262 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28263 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28264
28265 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28266 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28267 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28268 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28269 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28270 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28271 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28272 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28273
28274 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28275 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28276 support for OCSP stapling is included.
28277
28278 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28279 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28280 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28281 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28282 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28283
28284 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28285 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28286 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28287 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28288 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28289 next connection.
28290
28291 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28292 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28293 ignored.
28294
28295 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28296 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28297 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28298 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28299 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28300 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28301
28302 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28303 not any of the chain from CA to it.
28304
28305 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28306
28307 .code
28308 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28309 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28310 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28311
28312 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28313 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28314 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28315 .endd
28316
28317
28318
28319
28320 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
28321 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28322 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28323 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28324 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28325 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28326 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28327 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28328 within the &(smtp)& transport.
28329
28330 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28331 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28332 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28333 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28334 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28335
28336 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28337 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28338 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28339 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28340 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28341 usual way.
28342
28343 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28344 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28345 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28346 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28347 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28348 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28349 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28350 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28351 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28352 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28353 unencrypted.
28354
28355 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28356 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28357 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28358 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28359
28360 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28361 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28362 These may be
28363 the system default set (depending on library version),
28364 a file,
28365 or (depending on library version) a directory.
28366 The client verifies the server's certificate
28367 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28368 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28369 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28370 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28371
28372 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28373 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28374 or need not succeed respectively.
28375
28376 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28377 checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28378 is valid for the certificate.
28379 The option defaults to always checking.
28380
28381 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28382 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28383 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28384 value is empty.
28385 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28386 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28387 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28388 otherwise.
28389
28390 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28391 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28392 for OCSP to be relevant.
28393
28394 If
28395 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28396 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28397 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28398 alternative hosts, if any.
28399
28400 &*Note*&:
28401 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28402 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28403 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28404 client.
28405
28406 .vindex "&$host$&"
28407 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28408 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28409 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28410 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28411 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28412
28413 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28414 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28415 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28416 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28417 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28418 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28419 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28420 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28421 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28422 outgoing connection.
28423
28424
28425
28426 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28427 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28428 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28429 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28430 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28431 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28432 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28433 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28434 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28435 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28436 for this session.
28437
28438 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28439 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28440 address.
28441
28442 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28443 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28444 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28445 be of limited use in that environment.
28446
28447 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28448 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28449 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28450 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28451 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28452
28453 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28454 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28455 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28456 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28457 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28458
28459 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28460 received from a client.
28461 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28462
28463 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28464 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28465 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28466
28467 .ilist
28468 &%tls_certificate%&
28469 .next
28470 &%tls_crl%&
28471 .next
28472 &%tls_privatekey%&
28473 .next
28474 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
28475 .next
28476 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
28477 .endlist
28478
28479 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28480 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28481 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28482 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28483 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
28484 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28485 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28486
28487 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28488 are re-expanded.
28489
28490 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28491 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28492 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28493 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28494
28495 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
28496 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28497 built, then you have SNI support).
28498
28499
28500
28501 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28502 "SECTmulmessam"
28503 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28504 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28505 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28506 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28507 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28508 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28509 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28510 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28511 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28512 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28513
28514 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28515 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28516 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28517 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28518 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28519 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28520 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28521
28522 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28523 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28524 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28525 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28526 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28527 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28528 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28529 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28530 and delay other deliveries to that host.
28531
28532 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28533 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28534 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28535 information is recorded.
28536
28537 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28538 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28539 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28540
28541
28542
28543
28544 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28545 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28546 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28547 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28548 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28549 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28550
28551 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28552 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28553 document is currently at
28554 .display
28555 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28556 .endd
28557 and their FAQ is at
28558 .display
28559 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28560 .endd
28561
28562 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28563 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28564 descriptions.
28565 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28566 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28567 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28568 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28569
28570
28571 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28572 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28573 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28574 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28575 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28576 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28577 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28578 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28579 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28580 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28581 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28582 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28583 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28584
28585 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28586 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28587 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28588 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28589
28590
28591
28592 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28593 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28594 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28595 with OpenSSL, like this:
28596 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28597 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28598 .code
28599 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28600 -days 9999 -nodes
28601 .endd
28602 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28603 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28604 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28605 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28606 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28607 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28608 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28609
28610 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28611 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28612 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28613 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28614 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28615 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28616 . ==== -pdp, 2012
28617 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28618 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28619 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28620 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28621 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28622 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28623 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28624 be a sensible resolution).
28625
28626 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28627 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28628 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28629
28630 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28631 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28632 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28633 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28634 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28635 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28636
28637 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28638 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28639 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28640 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28641 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28642 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28643
28644
28645
28646 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28647 .cindex DANE
28648 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28649 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28650 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28651 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28652 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28653 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28654
28655 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28656 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28657 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28658
28659 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28660 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28661
28662 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28663 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28664 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28665
28666 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28667 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28668 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28669 DNSSEC.
28670 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28671 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28672
28673 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28674 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28675 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28676 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28677
28678 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28679 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28680 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28681 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28682 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28683 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28684 well-known one.
28685 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28686 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
28687 does require careful arrangement.
28688 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28689 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28690 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28691 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28692 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28693
28694 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28695 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28696 your certificate.
28697 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28698 "MTA-STS", described below.
28699
28700 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28701 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28702 connections to you.
28703 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28704 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28705 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28706 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28707 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28708 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28709
28710 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28711 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
28712 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
28713 random serial numbers.
28714 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
28715 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
28716 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
28717 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
28718
28719 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28720
28721 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28722 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28723
28724 .code
28725 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28726 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28727 | openssl sha512 \
28728 | awk '{print $2}'
28729 .endd
28730
28731 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28732
28733 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28734
28735 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
28736 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
28737 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
28738 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
28739 libraries.
28740 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
28741 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
28742
28743 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28744 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28745 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28746
28747 .code
28748 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28749 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28750 {*}{}}
28751 .endd
28752
28753 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28754 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28755 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28756 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28757 control the OCSP request.
28758
28759 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28760 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28761
28762
28763 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28764 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28765 The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28766
28767 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28768
28769 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28770 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28771 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28772 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28773
28774 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28775 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28776 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28777 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28778 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28779 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28780 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28781
28782 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28783 .code
28784 hosts_require_tls
28785 tls_verify_hosts
28786 tls_try_verify_hosts
28787 tls_verify_certificates
28788 tls_crl
28789 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28790 .endd
28791
28792 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28793 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28794
28795 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28796
28797 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28798
28799 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28800 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28801 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28802 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28803
28804 .cindex DANE reporting
28805 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28806 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28807 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28808 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28809 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28810 Section 4.3 of that document.
28811
28812 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28813
28814 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
28815 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
28816 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
28817 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
28818 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
28819 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
28820 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
28821 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
28822 information.
28823
28824 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
28825 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
28826 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
28827
28828 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
28829 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
28830 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
28831 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
28832 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
28833 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
28834 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
28835
28836
28837
28838 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28839 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28840
28841 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28842 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28843 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28844 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28845 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28846 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
28847 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28848 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28849 one very small ACL:
28850 .code
28851 begin acl
28852 small_acl:
28853 accept hosts = one.host.only
28854 .endd
28855 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28856 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28857
28858 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28859 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28860 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28861 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28862 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28863 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28864 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28865 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28866
28867
28868 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28869 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28870 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28871
28872
28873 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28874 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28875 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28876 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28877 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28878 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28879 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28880 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28881 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28882 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28883 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28884 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28885 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28886 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28887 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28888 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28889 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28890 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28891 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28892 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28893
28894 .table2 140pt
28895 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28896 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28897 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28898 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28899 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28900 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28901 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28902 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28903 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28904 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28905 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28906 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28907 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28908 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28909 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28910 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28911 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28912 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28913 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28914 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28915 .endtable
28916
28917 For example, if you set
28918 .code
28919 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28920 .endd
28921 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28922 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28923 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28924 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28925 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28926 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28927 testing as possible at RCPT time.
28928
28929
28930 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28931 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28932 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28933 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28934 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28935 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28936 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28937 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28938 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28939 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28940 in any of these ACLs.
28941
28942 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28943 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28944 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28945 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28946 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28947 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28948 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28949 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28950 .code
28951 control = suppress_local_fixups
28952 .endd
28953 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28954 run, it is too late.
28955
28956 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28957 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28958
28959 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28960 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28961 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28962
28963
28964 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28965 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28966 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28967 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28968 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28969 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28970 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28971 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28972 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28973
28974
28975 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28976 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28977 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28978 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28979 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28980 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28981 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28982 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28983 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28984
28985 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28986 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28987 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28988
28989 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28990 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28991 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28992 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28993 an EHLO response.
28994
28995
28996 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28997 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28998 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28999 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29000 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29001 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29002 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29003 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29004 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29005 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29006
29007 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29008 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29009 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29010 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29011 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29012 associated with the DATA command.
29013
29014 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29015 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29016 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29017 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29018 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29019 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29020 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29021 the data specified is received.
29022
29023 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29024 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29025 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29026 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29027 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29028 your resources.
29029
29030 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29031 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29032 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29033 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29034
29035 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29036 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29037 enabled (which is the default).
29038
29039 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29040 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29041 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29042
29043 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29044
29045 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29046
29047
29048 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29049 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29050 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29051
29052 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29053
29054
29055 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29056 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29057 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29058 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29059 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29060 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29061 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29062 has been accepted.
29063
29064 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29065 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29066 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29067 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29068 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29069 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29070 for some or all recipients.
29071
29072 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29073 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29074 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29075 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29076 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29077 is &"yes"&.
29078 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29079 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29080 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29081
29082 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29083 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29084
29085 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29086 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29087 the feature was not requested by the client.
29088
29089 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29090 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29091 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29092 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29093 does not in fact control any access.
29094 For this reason, it may only accept
29095 or warn as its final result.
29096
29097 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29098 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29099 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29100 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29101
29102 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29103 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29104
29105 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29106 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29107 response to QUIT.
29108
29109 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29110 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29111 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29112 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29113 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29114
29115
29116 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29117 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29118 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29119 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29120 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29121 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29122 situation even worse.
29123
29124 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29125 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29126 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29127 and &%warn%&.
29128
29129 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29130 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29131 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29132 connection. The possible values are:
29133 .table2
29134 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29135 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29136 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29137 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29138 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29139 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29140 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29141 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29142 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29143 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29144 .endtable
29145 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29146 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29147 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29148 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29149 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29150 used.
29151
29152
29153 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29154 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29155 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29156 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29157 .code
29158 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29159 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29160 .endd
29161 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29162 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29163 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29164 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29165 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29166
29167 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29168 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29169 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29170
29171 .ilist
29172 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29173 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29174 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29175 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29176 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29177 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29178 .code
29179 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29180 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29181 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29182 .endd
29183 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29184 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29185 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29186 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29187 .next
29188 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29189 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29190 matches the string.
29191 .next
29192 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29193 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29194 want to have something like
29195 .code
29196 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29197 .endd
29198 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29199 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29200 .endlist
29201
29202
29203
29204
29205 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29206 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29207 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29208 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29209 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29210 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29211 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29212 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29213 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29214
29215 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29216 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29217 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29218
29219
29220 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29221 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29222 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29223 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29224
29225 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29226 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29227 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29228 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29229 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29230 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29231 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29232
29233 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29234 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29235
29236
29237 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29238 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29239 recipients; it may create new recipients.
29240
29241
29242
29243 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29244 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29245 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29246 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29247 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29248 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29249
29250 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29251 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29252 used to accept or reject anything.
29253
29254 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29255 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29256 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29257 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29258
29259 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29260 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29261 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29262 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29263 configuration file.
29264
29265
29266
29267
29268 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29269 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29270 .vindex &$domain$&
29271 .vindex &$local_part$&
29272 .vindex &$sender_address$&
29273 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29274 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29275 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29276 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29277 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29278 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29279 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29280 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29281
29282 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29283 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29284 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29285 how it is used.
29286
29287 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
29288 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29289 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29290 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29291 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29292 received).
29293
29294 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29295 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29296 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29297 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29298 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29299 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29300 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29301 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29302
29303
29304
29305
29306
29307 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29308 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29309 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29310 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29311 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29312 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29313 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29314 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29315 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29316 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29317 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29318 unencrypted connections.
29319 .code
29320 acl_check_auth:
29321 accept encrypted = *
29322 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29323 {CRAM-MD5}}
29324 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29325 .endd
29326 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29327 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29328 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29329 option to do this.)
29330
29331
29332
29333 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29334 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29335 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29336 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29337 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29338 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29339 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29340
29341 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29342 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29343 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29344 example:
29345 .code
29346 deny dnslists = list1.example
29347 dnslists = list2.example
29348 .endd
29349 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29350 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29351 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29352 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29353 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29354
29355
29356 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29357 The ACL verbs are as follows:
29358
29359 .ilist
29360 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29361 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29362 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29363 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29364 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29365 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29366 check a RCPT command:
29367 .code
29368 accept domains = +local_domains
29369 endpass
29370 verify = recipient
29371 .endd
29372 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29373 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29374 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29375 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29376 &%endpass%&.
29377
29378 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29379 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29380 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29381 configuration.
29382
29383 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29384 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29385 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29386 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29387 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29388 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29389 .display
29390 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29391 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29392 .endd
29393 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29394 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29395 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29396
29397 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29398 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29399 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29400 of &%endpass%&.
29401
29402
29403 .next
29404 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29405 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29406 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29407 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29408 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29409 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29410 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29411
29412
29413 .next
29414 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29415 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29416 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29417 example,
29418 .code
29419 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29420 .endd
29421 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29422
29423
29424 .next
29425 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29426 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29427 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29428 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29429 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29430 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29431 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29432 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29433 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29434
29435 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29436 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29437 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29438
29439
29440 .next
29441 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29442 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29443 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29444 .code
29445 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29446 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29447 .endd
29448 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29449 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29450
29451 .next
29452 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29453 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29454 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29455 example, when checking a RCPT command,
29456 .code
29457 require message = Sender did not verify
29458 verify = sender
29459 .endd
29460 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29461 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29462 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29463 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29464
29465 .next
29466 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29467 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29468 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29469 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29470 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29471 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29472 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29473
29474 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29475 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29476 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29477 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29478 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29479
29480 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29481 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29482 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29483 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29484 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29485 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29486 onwards.
29487
29488
29489 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29490 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29491 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29492 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29493 .code
29494 warn !verify = sender
29495 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29496 .endd
29497 .endlist
29498
29499 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29500
29501 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29502 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29503 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29504 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29505 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29506
29507
29508
29509 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29510 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29511 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29512 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29513 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29514 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29515 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29516 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29517 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29518 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29519 .ilist
29520 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29521 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29522 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29523 on the same SMTP connection.
29524 .next
29525 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29526 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29527 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29528 .endlist
29529
29530 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29531 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29532 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29533 .code
29534 accept hosts = whatever
29535 set acl_m4 = some value
29536 accept authenticated = *
29537 set acl_c_auth = yes
29538 .endd
29539 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29540 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29541 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29542
29543 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29544 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29545 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29546 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29547 error is generated.
29548
29549 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29550 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29551
29552
29553 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29554 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29555 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29556 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29557 .code
29558 deny domains = *.dom.example
29559 !verify = recipient
29560 .endd
29561 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29562 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29563 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29564 two statements are equivalent:
29565 .code
29566 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29567 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29568 .endd
29569 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29570 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29571
29572 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29573 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29574 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29575 .code
29576 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29577 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29578 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29579 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29580 .endd
29581 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29582 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29583 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29584 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29585 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29586 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29587 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29588
29589 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29590 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29591 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29592 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29593 message is handled.
29594
29595 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29596 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29597 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29598 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29599 .code
29600 require message = Can't verify sender
29601 verify = sender
29602 message = Can't verify recipient
29603 verify = recipient
29604 message = This message cannot be used
29605 .endd
29606 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29607 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29608 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29609 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29610 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29611 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29612
29613 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29614 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29615 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29616 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29617 .code
29618 deny hosts = ...
29619 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29620 message = Invalid sender from client host
29621 .endd
29622 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29623 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29624
29625
29626
29627 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29628 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29629 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29630
29631 .vlist
29632 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29633 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29634 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29635 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29636
29637 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29638 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29639 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29640 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29641 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29642 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29643 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29644 write rather ugly lines like this:
29645 .display
29646 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29647 .endd
29648 Instead, all you need is
29649 .display
29650 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29651 .endd
29652
29653 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29654 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29655 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29656 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29657 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29658 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29659 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29660 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29661
29662 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29663 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29664 in several different ways. For example:
29665
29666 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29667 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29668 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29669 . ==== way.
29670
29671 .ilist
29672 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29673 .code
29674 accept ...some conditions
29675 control = queue_only
29676 .endd
29677 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29678 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29679
29680 .next
29681 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29682 .code
29683 accept ...some conditions...
29684 control = queue_only
29685 ...some more conditions...
29686 .endd
29687 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29688 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29689 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29690 to be relevant.
29691
29692 .next
29693 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29694 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29695 example:
29696 .code
29697 warn ...some conditions...
29698 control = freeze
29699 accept ...
29700 .endd
29701 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29702 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29703 log entry.
29704
29705 .next
29706 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29707 &%require%& verb. For example:
29708 .code
29709 require control = no_multiline_responses
29710 .endd
29711 .endlist
29712
29713 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29714 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29715 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
29716 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29717 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29718 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29719 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29720 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29721 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29722
29723 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29724 example:
29725 .code
29726 deny ...some conditions...
29727 delay = 30s
29728 .endd
29729 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29730 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29731 .code
29732 deny delay = 30s
29733 ...some conditions...
29734 .endd
29735 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29736 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29737 .code
29738 warn ...some conditions...
29739 delay = 2m
29740 control = freeze
29741 accept ...
29742 .endd
29743
29744 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29745 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29746 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29747 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29748 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29749 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29750 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29751
29752
29753 .vitem &*endpass*&
29754 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29755 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29756 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29757 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29758 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29759 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29760 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29761
29762
29763 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29764 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29765 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29766 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29767 .code
29768 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29769 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29770 .endd
29771 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29772 example:
29773 .display
29774 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29775 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29776 .endd
29777 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29778 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29779 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29780 message.
29781
29782 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29783 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29784 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29785 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29786 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29787 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29788 ignored.
29789
29790 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29791 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29792 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29793 error message.
29794
29795 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29796 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29797 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29798 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29799 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29800 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29801
29802 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29803 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29804 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29805 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29806 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29807 logging rejections.
29808
29809
29810 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29811 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29812 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29813 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29814 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29815 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29816 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29817 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29818 .display
29819 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29820 &` log_reject_target =`&
29821 .endd
29822 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29823 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29824 current ACL.
29825
29826
29827 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29828 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29829 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29830 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29831 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29832 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29833 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29834 ACLs. For example:
29835 .display
29836 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29837 &` control = freeze`&
29838 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29839 .endd
29840 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29841 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29842 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29843 example:
29844 .code
29845 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29846 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29847 .endd
29848
29849
29850 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29851 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29852 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29853 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29854 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29855 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29856 &%accept%& for details.)
29857
29858 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29859 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29860 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29861 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29862 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29863 .code
29864 require message = Host not recognized
29865 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
29866 .endd
29867 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29868 processed.)
29869
29870 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29871 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29872 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29873 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29874 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29875 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29876 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29877 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29878 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29879 EHLO options.
29880
29881 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29882 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29883 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29884 .code
29885 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29886 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29887 .endd
29888 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29889 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29890 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
29891 2&'xx'&.
29892
29893 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29894 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29895
29896 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29897 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29898 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29899 response.
29900
29901 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29902 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29903 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29904
29905 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29906 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29907 However, the original message is available in the variable
29908 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29909 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29910 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29911 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29912
29913 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29914 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29915 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29916 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29917 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29918 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29919 effect.
29920
29921
29922 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29923 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29924 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29925 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29926 for the message.
29927 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29928 the DATA ACL).
29929 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29930 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29931 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29932 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29933
29934
29935 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29936 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29937 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29938 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29939
29940
29941 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29942 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29943 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29944 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29945
29946
29947 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29948 .cindex "UDP communications"
29949 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29950 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29951 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29952 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29953 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29954 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29955 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29956 when:
29957 .code
29958 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29959 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29960 .endd
29961 .endlist
29962
29963
29964
29965
29966 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29967 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29968 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29969
29970 .vlist
29971 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29972 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29973 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29974 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29975 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29976 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29977 not work without it. For example:
29978 .code
29979 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29980 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29981 .endd
29982 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29983 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29984 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29985 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29986 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29987
29988
29989 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29990 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29991 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29992 .cindex "case of local parts"
29993 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29994 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29995 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29996 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29997 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29998 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29999 is encountered.
30000
30001 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30002 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30003 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30004 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30005 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30006
30007 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30008 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30009 spam score:
30010 .code
30011 warn control = caseful_local_part
30012 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30013 $acl_m4 + \
30014 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30015 }
30016 control = caselower_local_part
30017 .endd
30018 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30019 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30020
30021
30022 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30023 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30024 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30025 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30026
30027 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30028 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30029 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30030 is used for all recipients of the message,
30031 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30032 and data is copied from one to the other.
30033
30034 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30035 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30036 If a recipient-verify callout
30037 (with use_sender)
30038 connection is subsequently
30039 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30040 any subsequent recipients and the data,
30041 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30042
30043 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30044 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30045 Note also that headers cannot be
30046 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30047 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30048 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30049 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30050 this will affect the timestamp.
30051
30052 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30053 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30054 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30055 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30056 message body.
30057
30058 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30059 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30060 before the entire message has been received from the source.
30061 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30062 or CHUNKING
30063 options in use.
30064
30065 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30066 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30067 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30068 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30069 before the acceptance "<=" line.
30070
30071 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30072 usual fashion.
30073 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30074 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30075 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30076 and does not queue the message.
30077 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30078
30079 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30080 (possibly faked)
30081 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30082
30083
30084 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30085 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30086 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30087 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30088 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30089 by default called &'debuglog'&.
30090 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30091 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30092 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30093 option.
30094 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30095 with the &'kill'& option.
30096 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30097 contexts):
30098 .code
30099 control = debug
30100 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30101 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30102 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30103 control = debug/kill
30104 .endd
30105
30106
30107 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30108 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30109 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30110 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30111 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30112
30113
30114 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30115 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30116 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30117 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30118 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30119 strings or to numeric value.
30120 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30121 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30122 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30123
30124 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30125 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30126 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30127 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30128 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30129
30130
30131 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30132 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30133 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30134 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30135 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30136 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30137 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30138 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30139
30140 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30141 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30142 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30143 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30144 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30145 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30146 work with.
30147
30148
30149 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30150 .cindex "fake defer"
30151 .cindex "defer, fake"
30152 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30153 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30154 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30155 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30156 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30157
30158 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30159 .cindex "fake rejection"
30160 .cindex "rejection, fake"
30161 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30162 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30163 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30164 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30165 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30166 the same SMTP connection.
30167
30168 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30169 message is supplied, the following is used:
30170 .code
30171 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30172 550-kept for evaluation.
30173 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30174 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30175 .endd
30176 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30177
30178 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30179 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30180 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30181 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30182 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30183 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30184 SMTP connection.
30185
30186 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30187 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30188 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30189 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30190
30191 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30192 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30193 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30194 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30195 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30196 disables such output flushing.
30197
30198 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30199 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30200 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30201 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30202 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30203 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30204
30205 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30206 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30207 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30208 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30209 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30210 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30211 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30212 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30213 to be useful in production.
30214
30215 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30216 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30217 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30218 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30219 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30220
30221 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30222 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30223 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30224 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30225 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30226 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30227
30228 .ilist
30229 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30230 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30231 verification failed"&) is sent.
30232 .next
30233 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30234 line is output.
30235 .endlist
30236
30237 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30238 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30239
30240 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30241 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30242 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30243 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30244 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30245 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30246 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30247
30248 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30249 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30250 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30251 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30252 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30253 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30254 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30255 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30256 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30257 same SMTP connection.
30258
30259 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30260 .cindex "message" "submission"
30261 .cindex "submission mode"
30262 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30263 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30264 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30265 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30266 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30267 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30268 late (the message has already been created).
30269
30270 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30271 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30272 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30273 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30274 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30275
30276 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30277 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30278 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30279 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30280 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30281
30282 .ilist
30283 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30284 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30285 .next
30286 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30287 .next
30288 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30289 .endlist ilist
30290
30291 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30292 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30293 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30294 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30295 data is read.
30296
30297 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30298 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30299
30300 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30301 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30302 to a-label form.
30303 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30304 .endlist vlist
30305
30306
30307 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30308 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30309
30310 .ilist
30311 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30312 .next
30313 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30314 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30315 .next
30316 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30317 .next
30318 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30319 .endlist
30320
30321
30322
30323 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30324 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30325 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30326 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30327 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30328 to an incoming message, as in this example:
30329 .code
30330 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30331 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30332 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30333 .endd
30334 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30335 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30336 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30337 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30338 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30339 RCPT ACL).
30340
30341 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30342 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30343
30344 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30345 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30346 contains one or more newlines that
30347 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30348 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30349 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30350
30351 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30352 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30353 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30354 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30355 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30356 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30357 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30358 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30359 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30360 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30361 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30362
30363 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30364 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30365 of message headers
30366 until they are added to the
30367 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30368 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30369 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30370 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30371 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30372 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30373 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30374
30375 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30376
30377 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30378 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30379 .display
30380 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30381 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30382
30383 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30384 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30385 .endd
30386 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30387 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30388 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30389 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30390 honoured.
30391
30392 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30393 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30394 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30395 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30396 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30397 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30398 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30399 specifications.
30400
30401 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30402 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30403 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30404 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30405 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30406
30407 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30408 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30409 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30410 to be a header name first.) For example:
30411 .code
30412 warn add_header = \
30413 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30414 .endd
30415 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30416 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30417 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30418 up in reverse order.
30419
30420 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30421 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30422 system filter or in a router or transport.
30423
30424
30425
30426 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30427 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30428 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30429 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30430 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30431 from an incoming message, as in this example:
30432 .code
30433 warn message = Remove internal headers
30434 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30435 .endd
30436 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30437 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30438 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30439 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30440 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30441 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30442
30443 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30444 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30445
30446 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30447 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30448 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30449 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30450 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30451 .code
30452 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30453 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30454 warn message = Remove internal headers
30455 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30456 .endd
30457 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30458 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30459 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30460 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30461 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30462 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30463 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30464 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30465 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30466 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30467 would have been removed.
30468
30469 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30470 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30471 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30472 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30473 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30474 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30475 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30476 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30477 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30478
30479 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30480 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30481 .display
30482 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30483 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30484
30485 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30486 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30487 .endd
30488 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30489 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30490 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30491 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30492 are honoured.
30493
30494 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30495 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30496 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30497
30498
30499
30500
30501 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30502 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30503 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30504 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30505 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30506 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30507
30508 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30509 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30510 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30511 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30512 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30513 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30514 The conditions are as follows:
30515
30516
30517 .vlist
30518 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30519 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30520 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30521 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30522 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30523 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30524 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30525 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30526 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30527 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30528 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30529 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30530
30531 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30532 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30533 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30534 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30535 The name and values are expanded separately.
30536 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30537 will act as argument separators.
30538
30539 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30540 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30541 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30542 conditions are tested.
30543
30544 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30545 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30546 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30547 for different local users or different local domains.
30548
30549 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30550 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30551 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30552 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30553 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30554 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30555 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30556 .code
30557 authenticated = *
30558 .endd
30559
30560 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30561 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30562 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30563 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30564 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30565 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30566 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30567 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30568 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30569 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30570 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30571 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30572 negative.
30573
30574 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30575 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30576 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30577 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30578 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30579 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30580 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30581 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30582
30583 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30584 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30585 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30586 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30587 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30588 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30589 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30590 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30591 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30592 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30593
30594 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30595 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30596 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30597 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30598 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30599 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30600 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30601 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30602 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30603 &%domains%& test.
30604
30605 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30606 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30607
30608
30609 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30610 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30611 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30612 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30613 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30614 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30615 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30616 .code
30617 encrypted = *
30618 .endd
30619
30620
30621 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30622 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30623 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30624 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30625 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30626 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30627 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30628 .code
30629 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30630 .endd
30631 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30632 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30633 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30634
30635 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30636 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30637 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30638 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30639 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30640 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30641
30642 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30643 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30644 .code
30645 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30646 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30647 .endd
30648 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30649 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30650 statement can then check the IP address.
30651
30652 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30653 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30654 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30655 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30656 .code
30657 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30658 message = $host_data
30659 .endd
30660 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30661
30662 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30663 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30664 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30665 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30666 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30667 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30668 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30669 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30670 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30671 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30672
30673 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30674 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30675 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30676 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30677 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30678 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30679 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30680
30681 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30682 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30683 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30684 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30685 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30686 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30687 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30688 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30689
30690 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30691 .cindex "rate limiting"
30692 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30693 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30694
30695 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30696 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30697 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30698 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30699 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30700 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30701
30702 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30703 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30704 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30705 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30706 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30707 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30708 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30709
30710 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30711 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30712 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30713 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30714 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30715 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30716 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30717 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30718 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30719 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30720 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30721 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30722 influence the sender checking.
30723
30724 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30725 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30726
30727 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30728 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30729 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30730 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30731 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30732 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30733 .code
30734 senders = :
30735 .endd
30736 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30737 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30738
30739 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30740 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30741 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30742 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30743 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30744 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30745
30746 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30747 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30748 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30749 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30750 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30751 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30752 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30753 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30754 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30755 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30756
30757 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30758 .cindex "CSA verification"
30759 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30760 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30761 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30762
30763 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30764 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30765 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30766 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30767 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30768 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30769 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30770 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30771 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30772 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30773
30774 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30775 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30776 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30777
30778 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30779 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30780 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30781 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30782 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30783 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30784 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30785 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30786 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30787 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30788 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30789 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30790 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30791 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30792 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30793
30794 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30795 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30796 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30797 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30798 .code
30799 deny senders = :
30800 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30801 !verify = header_sender
30802 .endd
30803
30804 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30805 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30806 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30807 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30808 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30809 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30810 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30811 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30812 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30813 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30814 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30815 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30816 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30817 appropriate.
30818
30819 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30820 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30821 .code
30822 To: @
30823 .endd
30824 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30825 common as they used to be.
30826
30827 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30828 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30829 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30830 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30831 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30832 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30833 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30834 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30835 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30836 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30837 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30838 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30839 independently of this condition.
30840
30841 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30842 option), this condition is always true.
30843
30844
30845 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30846 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30847 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30848 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30849 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30850 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30851 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30852 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30853 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30854
30855 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30856 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30857
30858
30859 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30860 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30861 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30862 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30863 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30864 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30865 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30866 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30867 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30868 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30869 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30870 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30871 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30872 value for the child address.
30873
30874 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30875 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30876 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30877 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30878 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30879 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30880 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30881 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30882 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30883 original IP address.
30884
30885 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30886 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30887
30888 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30889 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30890
30891 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30892 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30893 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30894 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
30895 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
30896 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30897 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30898 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30899 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30900
30901 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30902 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30903 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30904 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30905 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30906 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30907 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30908
30909 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30910 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30911 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30912
30913 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30914 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30915 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30916 verified as a sender.
30917
30918 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30919 (eg. is generated from the received message)
30920 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30921 .code
30922 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30923 .endd
30924 .endlist
30925
30926
30927
30928 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30929 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30930 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30931 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30932 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30933 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30934 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30935 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30936 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30937 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30938 .code
30939 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30940 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30941 .endd
30942 the following records are looked up:
30943 .code
30944 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30945 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30946 .endd
30947 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30948 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30949 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30950 use two separate conditions:
30951 .code
30952 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30953 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30954 .endd
30955 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30956 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30957 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30958 processed.
30959
30960 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30961 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30962 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30963 following special items in the list:
30964 .display
30965 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30966 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30967 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30968 .endd
30969 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30970 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30971 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30972 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30973 .code
30974 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30975 .endd
30976 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30977 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30978 .code
30979 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30980 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30981 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30982 .endd
30983 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30984 .cindex DNS TTL
30985 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30986 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30987 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30988 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30989 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30990 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30991
30992 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
30993 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
30994 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
30995
30996
30997
30998 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30999 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31000 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31001 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31002 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31003 .code
31004 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31005 .endd
31006 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31007 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31008 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31009 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31010
31011
31012
31013
31014 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31015 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31016 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31017 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31018 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31019 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31020 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31021 .code
31022 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31023 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31024 .endd
31025 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31026 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31027 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31028 up by this example is
31029 .code
31030 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31031 .endd
31032 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31033 addresses. For example:
31034 .code
31035 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31036 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31037 .endd
31038 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31039 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31040
31041
31042
31043
31044 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31045 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31046 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31047 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31048 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31049 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31050 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31051 either to double the separators like this:
31052 .code
31053 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31054 .endd
31055 or to change the separator character, like this:
31056 .code
31057 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31058 .endd
31059 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31060 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31061 occurs. Consider this condition:
31062 .code
31063 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31064 .endd
31065 The DNS lookups that occur are:
31066 .code
31067 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31068 a.domain.black.list.tld
31069 .endd
31070 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31071 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31072 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31073 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31074 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31075 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31076 error for a previous item.
31077
31078 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31079 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31080 .code
31081 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31082 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31083 .endd
31084 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31085 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31086 .code
31087 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31088 $sender_address_domain \
31089 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31090 see $dnslist_text.
31091 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31092 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31093 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31094 .endd
31095 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31096 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31097 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31098 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31099 .code
31100 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31101 .endd
31102 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31103 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31104
31105 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31106 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31107
31108
31109
31110
31111 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31112 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31113 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31114 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31115 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31116 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31117 .display
31118 127.1.0.1 RBL
31119 127.1.0.2 DUL
31120 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31121 127.1.0.4 RSS
31122 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31123 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31124 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31125 .endd
31126 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31127 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31128 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31129
31130
31131 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31132 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31133 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31134 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31135 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31136 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31137 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31138 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31139 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31140 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31141 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31142 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31143 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31144 cases, for example:
31145 .code
31146 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31147 .endd
31148 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31149 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31150 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31151 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31152 .code
31153 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31154 .endd
31155 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31156 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31157
31158 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31159 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31160 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31161 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31162 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31163 information.
31164
31165 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31166 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31167 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31168 .code
31169 deny hosts = !+local_networks
31170 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31171 at $dnslist_domain
31172 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31173 .endd
31174
31175
31176
31177 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31178 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31179 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31180 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31181 For example,
31182 .code
31183 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31184 .endd
31185 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31186 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31187 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31188 describes how multiple records are handled.
31189
31190 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31191 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31192 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31193 .code
31194 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31195 .endd
31196 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31197 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31198 first. For example:
31199 .code
31200 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31201 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31202 .endd
31203
31204 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31205 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31206 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31207 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31208 tested. For example:
31209 .code
31210 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31211 .endd
31212 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31213 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31214 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31215 .code
31216 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31217 .endd
31218 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31219 an odd number.
31220
31221
31222
31223 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31224 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31225 condition. Whereas
31226 .code
31227 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31228 .endd
31229 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31230 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31231 .code
31232 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31233 .endd
31234 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31235 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31236 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31237 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31238
31239 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31240 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31241
31242 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31243 previous example is precisely equivalent to
31244 .code
31245 deny dnslists = a.b.c
31246 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31247 .endd
31248 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31249 Consider this example:
31250 .code
31251 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31252 list.dsbl.org : \
31253 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31254 relays.ordb.org
31255 .endd
31256 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31257 .code
31258 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31259 list.dsbl.org
31260 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31261 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31262 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31263 .endd
31264 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31265
31266
31267
31268
31269 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31270 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31271 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31272 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31273 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31274 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31275 .code
31276 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31277 .endd
31278 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31279 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31280 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31281 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31282 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31283 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31284
31285 .ilist
31286 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31287 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31288 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31289 .next
31290 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31291 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31292 changed to:
31293 .code
31294 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31295 .endd
31296 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31297 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31298 .code
31299 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31300 .endd
31301 for the condition to be true.
31302 .endlist
31303
31304 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31305 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31306 .ilist
31307 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31308 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31309 .code
31310 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31311 .endd
31312 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31313 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31314 .next
31315 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31316 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31317 .code
31318 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31319 .endd
31320 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31321 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31322 .code
31323 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31324 .endd
31325 for the condition to be false.
31326 .endlist
31327 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31328 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31329
31330
31331
31332
31333 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31334 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31335 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31336 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31337 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31338 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31339 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31340 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31341 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31342 lists.
31343
31344 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31345 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31346 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31347 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31348 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31349 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31350 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31351 .code
31352 deny message = \
31353 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31354 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31355 dnslists = \
31356 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31357 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31358 .endd
31359 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31360 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31361 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31362 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31363 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31364 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31365
31366 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31367 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31368 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31369 .code
31370 deny dnslists = \
31371 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31372 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31373 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31374 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31375 .endd
31376 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31377 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31378 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31379
31380
31381
31382 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31383 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31384 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31385 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31386 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
31387 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31388 .code
31389 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31390 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31391 .endd
31392 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31393 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31394 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31395 .code
31396 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31397 .endd
31398 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31399 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31400
31401 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31402 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31403 .code
31404 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31405 dnslists = some.list.example
31406 .endd
31407
31408 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31409 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31410 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31411 .code
31412 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31413 .endd
31414
31415 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31416 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31417 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31418 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31419 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31420 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31421 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31422 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31423 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31424 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31425 .display
31426 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31427 .endd
31428 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31429 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31430
31431 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31432 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31433 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31434 of &'p'&.
31435
31436 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31437 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31438 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31439 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31440 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31441 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31442 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31443 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31444 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31445
31446 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31447 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31448 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31449 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31450
31451 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31452 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31453 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31454 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31455 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31456 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31457 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31458 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31459 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31460 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31461
31462 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31463 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31464 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31465 ACL.
31466
31467 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31468 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31469 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31470 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31471 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31472 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31473
31474 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31475 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31476 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31477 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31478 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31479 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31480 the &%count=%& option.
31481
31482
31483 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31484 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31485 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31486 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31487 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31488
31489 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31490 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31491 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31492 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31493
31494 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31495 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31496 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31497 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31498 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31499 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31500 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31501
31502 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31503 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31504 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31505 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31506 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31507 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31508 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31509
31510 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31511 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31512 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31513 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31514 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
31515
31516 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31517 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31518 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31519 multiple different commands.
31520
31521 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31522 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31523 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31524 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31525 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31526
31527 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31528
31529
31530 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31531 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31532 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31533 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31534 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31535
31536 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31537 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31538
31539 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31540 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31541 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31542 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31543 new rate.
31544 .code
31545 acl_check_connect:
31546 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31547 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31548 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31549 # ...
31550 acl_check_mail:
31551 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31552 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31553 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31554 .endd
31555
31556 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31557 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31558 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31559 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31560 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31561 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31562 checks.
31563
31564 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31565 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31566 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31567 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31568 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31569
31570
31571 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31572 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31573 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31574 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31575 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31576 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31577 rest of the ACL.
31578
31579 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31580 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31581 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31582 up to the given limit.
31583 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31584 consists of refusing the message, and
31585 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31586 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31587 likely not what is wanted.
31588
31589 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31590 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31591 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31592 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31593 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31594 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31595 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31596 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31597 .code
31598 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31599 .endd
31600
31601
31602 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31603 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31604 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31605 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31606 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31607 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31608 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31609 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31610 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31611
31612 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31613 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31614 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31615 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31616 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31617 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31618
31619 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31620 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31621 rate.
31622
31623 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31624 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31625 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31626 required increases with larger limits.
31627
31628 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31629 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31630 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31631 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31632 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31633 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31634 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31635 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31636 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31637 as intended.
31638
31639
31640 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31641 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31642 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31643 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31644 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31645 message. For example:
31646 .code
31647 # Log all senders' rates
31648 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31649 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31650
31651 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31652 # at the decimal point.
31653 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31654 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31655 $sender_rate_limit }s
31656
31657 # Keep authenticated users under control
31658 deny authenticated = *
31659 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31660
31661 # System-wide rate limit
31662 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31663 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31664
31665 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31666 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31667 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31668 messages per $sender_rate_period
31669 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31670 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31671 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31672 .endd
31673 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31674 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31675 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31676 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31677 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31678 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31679 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31680
31681
31682
31683 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31684 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31685 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31686 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31687 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31688 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31689 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31690 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31691 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31692 .code
31693 verify = sender/callout
31694 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31695 .endd
31696 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31697 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31698 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31699 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31700 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31701 The available options are as follows:
31702
31703 .ilist
31704 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31705 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31706 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31707 .next
31708 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31709 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31710 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31711 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31712 .next
31713 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31714 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31715 .next
31716 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31717 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31718 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31719 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31720 .endlist
31721
31722 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31723 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31724 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31725 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31726 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31727 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31728 coding like this:
31729 .code
31730 warn !verify = sender
31731 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31732 .endd
31733 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31734 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31735 verification failure.
31736
31737 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31738 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31739
31740 .ilist
31741 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31742 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31743 .next
31744 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31745 .next
31746 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31747 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31748 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31749 .next
31750 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31751 .next
31752 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31753 .endlist
31754
31755 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31756 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31757
31758 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
31759 address verification to:
31760
31761 .ilist
31762 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
31763 .endlist
31764
31765
31766
31767
31768 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31769 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31770 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31771 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31772 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31773 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31774 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31775 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31776 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31777 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31778 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31779 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31780 sender's domain.
31781
31782 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31783 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31784 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31785 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31786 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31787 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31788
31789 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31790 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31791 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31792 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31793 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31794
31795 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31796 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31797 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31798 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31799 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31800 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31801 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31802 supplies a host list.
31803 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31804
31805 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31806 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31807 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31808 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31809 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31810 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31811 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31812
31813 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31814 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31815 following SMTP commands are sent:
31816 .display
31817 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31818 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
31819 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31820 &`QUIT`&
31821 .endd
31822 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31823 set to &"lmtp"&.
31824
31825 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31826 settings.
31827
31828 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31829 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31830 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31831 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31832 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31833 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31834
31835 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31836 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31837 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31838 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31839 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31840
31841 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31842 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31843 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31844 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31845 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31846
31847
31848
31849
31850 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31851 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31852 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31853 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31854 .code
31855 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31856 .endd
31857 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31858 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31859 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31860
31861
31862 .vlist
31863 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31864 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31865 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31866 For example:
31867 .code
31868 verify = sender/callout=5s
31869 .endd
31870 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31871 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31872 the &%connect%& parameter.
31873
31874
31875 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31876 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31877 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31878 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31879 .code
31880 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31881 .endd
31882 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31883
31884 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
31885 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31886 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31887 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31888 updated in this circumstance.
31889
31890 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31891 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31892 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31893 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31894 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31895 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31896
31897
31898 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31899 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31900 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31901 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31902 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31903 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31904 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31905 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31906 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31907 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31908 .code
31909 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31910 .endd
31911 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31912
31913
31914 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31915 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31916 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31917 For example:
31918 .code
31919 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31920 .endd
31921 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31922 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31923 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31924 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31925 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
31926
31927
31928 .vitem &*no_cache*&
31929 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31930 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31931 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31932
31933 .vitem &*postmaster*&
31934 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31935 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31936 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31937 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31938 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31939 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31940 made, until the cache record expires.
31941
31942 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31943 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31944 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31945 For example:
31946 .code
31947 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31948 .endd
31949 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31950 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31951 .code
31952 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31953 .endd
31954 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31955 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31956 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31957 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31958
31959
31960 .vitem &*random*&
31961 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31962 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31963 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31964 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31965 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31966 .code
31967 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31968 .endd
31969 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31970 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31971 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31972 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31973 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31974
31975 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31976 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31977 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31978 .code
31979 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31980 .endd
31981 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31982 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31983 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31984 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31985 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31986
31987 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31988 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31989 .code
31990 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31991 .endd
31992 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31993 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31994 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31995 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31996 usefulness of callout caching.
31997
31998 .vitem &*hold*&
31999 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32000 .code
32001 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32002 .endd
32003 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32004 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32005 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32006 when that is used for the connections.
32007 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32008 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32009 if the use_sender option is used,
32010 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32011 and if no other callouts intervene.
32012 .endlist
32013
32014 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32015 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32016 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32017 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32018 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32019 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32020 these circumstances.
32021
32022 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32023 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32024 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32025 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32026 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32027 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32028 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32029
32030 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32031 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32032 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32033 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32034
32035
32036
32037
32038 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32039 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32040 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32041 .cindex "caching" "callout"
32042 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32043 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32044 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32045 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32046 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32047 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32048
32049 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32050 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32051 is not available.
32052
32053 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32054 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32055 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32056
32057 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32058 commands up to and including
32059 .code
32060 MAIL FROM:<>
32061 .endd
32062 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32063 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32064 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32065 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32066 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32067 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32068 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32069
32070 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32071 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32072 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32073 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32074 will eventually be noticed.
32075
32076 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32077 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32078 behaviour will be the same.
32079
32080
32081
32082 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32083 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32084 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32085 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32086 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32087 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32088 you might see:
32089 .code
32090 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32091 250 OK
32092 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32093 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32094 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32095 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32096 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32097 550 Sender verification failed
32098 .endd
32099 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32100 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32101 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32102 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32103 example:
32104 .code
32105 verify = sender/no_details
32106 .endd
32107
32108 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32109 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32110 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32111 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32112 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32113 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32114 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32115
32116 .ilist
32117 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32118 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32119 verification also fails.
32120 .next
32121 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32122 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32123 .endlist
32124
32125 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32126 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32127 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32128 .code
32129 A.Wol: aw123
32130 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32131 .endd
32132 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32133 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32134 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32135 verification to succeed.
32136
32137 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32138 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32139 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32140 option. For example:
32141 .code
32142 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32143 .endd
32144 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32145 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32146
32147 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32148 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32149 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32150 address and a report is output for each of them.
32151
32152
32153
32154 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32155 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32156 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32157 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32158 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32159 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32160 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32161 .code
32162 verify = csa
32163 .endd
32164 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32165 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32166 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32167 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32168 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32169 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32170
32171 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32172 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32173 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32174 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32175
32176 .ilist
32177 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32178 .next
32179 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32180 .next
32181 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32182 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32183 .next
32184 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32185 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32186 .endlist
32187
32188 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32189 use for the DNS query. The default is:
32190 .code
32191 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32192 .endd
32193 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32194 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32195 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32196 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32197 meaningful to say:
32198 .code
32199 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32200 .endd
32201 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32202 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32203 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32204
32205 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32206 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32207 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32208 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32209 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32210 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32211 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32212 of legitimate HELO domains.
32213
32214 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32215 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32216 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32217 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32218 lookup such as:
32219 .code
32220 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32221 .endd
32222 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32223 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32224 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32225
32226
32227
32228
32229 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32230 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
32231 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32232 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32233 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32234 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32235 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32236 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32237
32238 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32239 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32240 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32241 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32242 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32243 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32244 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32245 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32246
32247 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32248 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32249 like this:
32250 .code
32251 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32252 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32253 }{$value}}
32254 .endd
32255 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32256 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32257 use this:
32258 .code
32259 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32260 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32261 senders = :
32262 recipients = +batv_senders
32263
32264 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32265 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32266 senders = :
32267 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32268 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32269 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32270 .endd
32271 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32272 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32273 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32274 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32275 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32276
32277 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32278 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32279 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32280 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32281 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32282 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32283 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32284
32285 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32286 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32287 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32288 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32289 .code
32290 batv_redirect:
32291 driver = redirect
32292 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32293 .endd
32294 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32295 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32296 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32297 local addresses.
32298
32299 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32300 can be used:
32301 .code
32302 external_smtp_batv:
32303 driver = smtp
32304 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32305 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32306 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32307 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32308 {$value}fail}}}
32309 .endd
32310 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32311
32312
32313
32314 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32315 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32316 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32317 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32318 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32319 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32320 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32321 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32322 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32323 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32324
32325 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32326 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32327 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32328 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32329 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32330 same host is fulfilling both functions,
32331 . ///
32332 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
32333 . ///
32334 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32335 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32336 system to arbitrary domains.
32337
32338
32339 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32340 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32341 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32342 example, suppose you want to do the following:
32343
32344 .ilist
32345 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32346 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32347 &'my.dom2.example'&.
32348 .next
32349 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32350 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32351 .next
32352 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32353 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32354 .endlist
32355
32356
32357 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32358 .code
32359 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32360 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32361 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32362 .endd
32363 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32364 command:
32365 .code
32366 acl_check_rcpt:
32367 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32368 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32369 .endd
32370 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32371 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32372 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32373 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32374 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32375 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32376 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32377
32378
32379
32380 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32381 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32382 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32383 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32384 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32385 .ecindex IIDacl
32386
32387
32388
32389 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32390 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32391
32392 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32393 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32394 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32395 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32396 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32397 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32398 specification.
32399
32400 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32401 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32402 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32403 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32404 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32405
32406 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32407 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32408 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32409
32410 .ilist
32411 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32412 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32413 .next
32414 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32415 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32416 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32417 .next
32418 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32419 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32420 .next
32421 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32422 conditions.
32423 .next
32424 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32425 .endlist
32426
32427 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32428 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32429 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32430 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32431 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32432 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32433
32434 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32435 temporarily created in a file called:
32436 .display
32437 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32438 .endd
32439 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32440 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32441 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32442 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32443 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32444 .code
32445 control = no_mbox_unspool
32446 .endd
32447 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32448 same directory by default.
32449
32450
32451
32452 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32453 .cindex "virus scanning"
32454 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32455 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32456 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32457 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32458 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32459 in memory and thus are much faster.
32460
32461 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32462 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32463
32464 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32465 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32466 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32467 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32468 .display
32469 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32470 .endd
32471 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32472 .code
32473 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32474 .endd
32475 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32476 before use.
32477 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32478 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32479 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32480
32481 .vlist
32482 .vitem &%avast%&
32483 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32484 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32485 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32486 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32487 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32488 This scanner type takes one option,
32489 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32490 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32491 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32492 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32493 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32494 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32495 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32496
32497 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32498 If &`pass_unscanned`&
32499 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32500 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32501 care.
32502
32503 For example:
32504 .code
32505 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32506 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32507 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32508 .endd
32509 If you omit the argument, the default path
32510 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32511 is used.
32512 If you use a remote host,
32513 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32514 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32515 For information about available commands and their options you may use
32516 .code
32517 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32518 FLAGS
32519 SENSITIVITY
32520 PACK
32521 .endd
32522
32523 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32524 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32525 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32526
32527 .vitem &%aveserver%&
32528 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32529 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32530 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32531 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32532 example:
32533 .code
32534 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32535 .endd
32536
32537
32538 .vitem &%clamd%&
32539 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32540 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32541 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32542 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32543 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32544
32545 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32546 a UNIX socket specification,
32547 a TCP socket specification,
32548 or a (global) option.
32549
32550 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32551 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32552 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32553 and the second a port number,
32554 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32555 These per-server options are supported:
32556 .code
32557 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32558 .endd
32559
32560 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32561 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32562
32563 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32564
32565 Examples:
32566 .code
32567 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32568 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32569 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32570 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32571 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32572 .endd
32573 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32574 &`local`&
32575 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32576 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32577 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32578 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32579
32580 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32581 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32582 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32583 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32584 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32585 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32586 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32587 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32588 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32589 .code
32590 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32591 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32592 (Connection refused)
32593 .endd
32594
32595 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32596 contributing the code for this scanner.
32597
32598 .vitem &%cmdline%&
32599 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32600 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32601 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32602 type takes 3 mandatory options:
32603
32604 .olist
32605 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32606 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32607
32608 .next
32609 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32610 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32611 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32612 the &"trigger"& expression.
32613
32614 .next
32615 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32616 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32617 &"name"& expression.
32618 .endlist olist
32619
32620 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32621 .code
32622 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32623 .endd
32624 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32625 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32626 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32627 configuration setting:
32628 .code
32629 av_scanner = cmdline:\
32630 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32631 found in file:'(.+)'
32632 .endd
32633 .vitem &%drweb%&
32634 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32635 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32636 takes one option,
32637 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32638 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32639 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32640 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32641 For example:
32642 .code
32643 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32644 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32645 .endd
32646 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32647 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32648
32649 .vitem &%f-protd%&
32650 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32651 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32652 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32653 (or port-range).
32654 For example:
32655 .code
32656 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32657 .endd
32658 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32659
32660 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32661 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32662 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32663 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32664 For example:
32665 .code
32666 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32667 .endd
32668 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32669
32670 .vitem &%fsecure%&
32671 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32672 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32673 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32674 .code
32675 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32676 .endd
32677 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32678 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32679
32680 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32681 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32682 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32683 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32684 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32685 For example:
32686 .code
32687 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32688 .endd
32689 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32690
32691 .vitem &%mksd%&
32692 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32693 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
32694 though some documentation was available in English.
32695 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
32696 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
32697 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
32698 to integrate.
32699 The only option for this scanner type is
32700 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32701 provided that mksd has
32702 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32703 .code
32704 av_scanner = mksd:2
32705 .endd
32706 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32707
32708 .vitem &%sock%&
32709 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32710 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32711 running on the local machine.
32712 There are four options:
32713 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32714 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32715 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32716 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32717 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32718 For example:
32719 .code
32720 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32721 .endd
32722 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32723 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32724 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32725 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32726 specify an empty element to get this.
32727
32728 .vitem &%sophie%&
32729 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32730 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32731 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
32732 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32733 client communication. For example:
32734 .code
32735 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32736 .endd
32737 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32738 the option.
32739 .endlist
32740
32741 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32742 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32743 ACL.
32744
32745 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32746 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32747 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32748 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32749 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32750 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32751 message.
32752
32753 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32754 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32755 The first element can then be one of
32756
32757 .ilist
32758 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32759 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32760 recommended usage.
32761 .next
32762 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32763 the condition fails immediately.
32764 .next
32765 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32766 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32767 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32768 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32769 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
32770 .endlist
32771
32772 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32773 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32774 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32775
32776 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32777 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32778 For example:
32779 .code
32780 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32781 .endd
32782 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32783
32784 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32785 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32786 is set to record the actual address used.
32787
32788 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32789 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32790 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32791 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32792 logging data.
32793
32794 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32795 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32796
32797 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32798 .code
32799 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32800 malware = *
32801 .endd
32802 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32803 .code
32804 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32805 malware = */defer_ok
32806 .endd
32807 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32808 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32809 .code
32810 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32811 .endd
32812 in the main Exim configuration.
32813 .code
32814 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32815 set acl_m0 = sophie
32816 malware = *
32817
32818 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32819 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32820 malware = *
32821 .endd
32822
32823
32824 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32825 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32826 .cindex "spam scanning"
32827 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32828 .cindex "Rspamd"
32829 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32830 score and a report for the message.
32831 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32832
32833 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32834 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32835 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
32836
32837 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32838 .code
32839 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32840 .endd
32841 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32842 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32843 nicely, however.
32844
32845 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32846 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32847 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32848 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32849 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32850 configuration as follows (example):
32851 .code
32852 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
32853 .endd
32854 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32855 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32856 iptables firewall, consider setting
32857 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32858 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32859 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32860 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32861 soon.
32862
32863
32864 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32865 on TCP port 11333)
32866 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32867 .code
32868 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32869 .endd
32870
32871 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32872 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32873 filename instead of an address/port pair:
32874 .code
32875 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32876 .endd
32877 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32878 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32879 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32880 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
32881 .code
32882 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32883 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32884 192.168.2.12 783
32885 .endd
32886 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32887 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32888 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32889 condition defers.
32890
32891 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32892 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32893 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
32894 take care to not double the separator.
32895
32896 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32897 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32898 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32899 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32900
32901 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32902 are options.
32903 The supported options are:
32904 .code
32905 pri=<priority> Selection priority
32906 weight=<value> Selection bias
32907 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32908 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32909 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32910 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32911 .endd
32912
32913 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32914 higher values being tried first.
32915 The default priority is 1.
32916
32917 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32918 Within a priority set
32919 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32920 The default value for selection bias is 1.
32921
32922 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32923 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32924 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32925 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32926
32927 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32928 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32929
32930 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32931 The default value is two minutes.
32932
32933 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32934 a failed connect is made.
32935 The default is to not retry.
32936
32937 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32938 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32939 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32940 expansion.
32941
32942 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32943 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32944 is set to record the actual address used.
32945
32946 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32947 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32948 .code
32949 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32950 spam = joe
32951 .endd
32952 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32953 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32954 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32955 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32956 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32957 right-hand side.
32958
32959 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32960 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32961 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32962 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32963 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32964 are not set.
32965 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32966 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32967 after the first),
32968 or the use of PRDR,
32969 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32970 are needed to use this feature.
32971
32972 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32973 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32974 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32975
32976
32977 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32978 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32979 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32980 example:
32981 .code
32982 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32983 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32984 spam = nobody
32985 .endd
32986
32987 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32988 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32989 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32990 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32991
32992 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32993 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32994 variables.
32995 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32996 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32997 available for use at delivery time.
32998
32999 .vlist
33000 .vitem &$spam_score$&
33001 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33002 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33003
33004 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33005 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33006 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33007 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33008 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33009
33010 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
33011 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33012 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33013 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33014 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33015 spam bar is 50 characters.
33016
33017 .vitem &$spam_report$&
33018 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33019 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33020 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33021 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33022 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33023 unencoded in headers.
33024
33025 .vitem &$spam_action$&
33026 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33027 spam score versus threshold.
33028 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33029
33030 .endlist
33031
33032 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33033 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33034 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33035
33036 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33037 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33038 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33039 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33040 spam condition, like this:
33041 .code
33042 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33043 spam = joe/defer_ok
33044 .endd
33045 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33046
33047 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33048 condition:
33049 .code
33050 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33051 warn spam = nobody:true
33052 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33053 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33054
33055 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33056 # is over threshold
33057 warn spam = nobody
33058 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33059
33060 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33061 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33062 spam = nobody:true
33063 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33064 .endd
33065
33066
33067
33068 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33069 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33070 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
33071 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33072 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33073 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33074 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33075 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33076 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33077 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33078 cases.
33079
33080 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33081 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33082 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33083 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33084 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33085 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33086 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33087
33088 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33089 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33090 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33091 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33092 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33093
33094 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33095 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33096 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33097 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33098 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33099 syntax is:
33100 .display
33101 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33102 .endd
33103 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33104 the value can be:
33105
33106 .olist
33107 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33108 .next
33109 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33110 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33111 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33112 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33113 .next
33114 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33115 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33116 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33117 the full path and filename.
33118 .next
33119 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33120 filename, and the default path is then used.
33121 .endlist
33122 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33123 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33124 a file with its original, proposed filename using
33125 .code
33126 decode = $mime_filename
33127 .endd
33128 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33129 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33130 automatically unlinked.
33131
33132 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33133 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33134 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33135 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33136 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33137
33138 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33139 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33140 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33141
33142 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33143 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33144 available in the MIME ACL:
33145
33146 .vlist
33147 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33148 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33149 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33150 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33151 contains the empty string.
33152
33153 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
33154 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33155 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33156 .code
33157 us-ascii
33158 gb2312 (Chinese)
33159 iso-8859-1
33160 .endd
33161 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33162 case-insensitively.
33163
33164 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33165 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33166 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33167 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33168 only used for display purposes.
33169
33170 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33171 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33172 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33173
33174 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33175 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33176 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33177
33178 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33179 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33180 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33181 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33182 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33183
33184 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33185 This variable contains the normalized content of the
33186 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33187 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33188
33189 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33190 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33191 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33192 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33193 .code
33194 text/plain
33195 text/html
33196 application/octet-stream
33197 image/jpeg
33198 audio/midi
33199 .endd
33200 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33201 empty string.
33202
33203 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33204 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33205 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33206 containing the decoded data.
33207 .endlist
33208
33209 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33210 .vlist
33211 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
33212 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33213 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33214 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33215 RFC2047
33216 or RFC2231
33217 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33218 If no filename was
33219 found, this variable contains the empty string.
33220
33221 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33222 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33223 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33224 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33225
33226 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33227 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33228 follows:
33229
33230 .olist
33231 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33232
33233 .next
33234 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33235 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33236
33237 .next
33238 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33239 and the rest are attachments.
33240
33241 .next
33242 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33243 .endlist olist
33244
33245 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33246 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33247 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33248 .code
33249 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33250 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33251 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33252 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33253 .endd
33254 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33255 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33256 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33257 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33258 want to carry out specific actions on them.
33259
33260 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33261 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33262 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33263 decoding is fully recursive.
33264
33265 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33266 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33267 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33268 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33269 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33270 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33271 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33272 .endlist
33273
33274
33275
33276 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33277 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33278 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33279 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33280 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33281
33282 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33283 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33284 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33285 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33286 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33287
33288 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33289 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33290 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33291 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33292 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
33293 32K characters are checked.
33294
33295 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33296 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33297 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33298 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33299 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33300 .code
33301 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33302 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33303 .endd
33304 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33305 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33306 matching regular expression.
33307 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33308 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33309
33310 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33311 CPU-intensive.
33312
33313 .ecindex IIDcosca
33314
33315
33316
33317
33318 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33319 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33320
33321 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33322 "Local scan function"
33323 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33324 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33325 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33326 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33327 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33328
33329 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33330 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33331 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33332 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33333 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33334
33335 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33336 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33337 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33338 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33339
33340 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33341 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33342 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33343 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33344
33345 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33346 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33347 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33348 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33349 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33350 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33351 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33352 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33353 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33354
33355
33356
33357 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33358 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33359 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33360 function is before building Exim, by setting
33361 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33362 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33363 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33364 directory, so you might set
33365 .code
33366 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33367 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33368 .endd
33369 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
33370 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33371 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33372 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33373 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33374 _src/local_scan.c_.
33375
33376 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33377 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33378 .code
33379 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33380 .endd
33381 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33382
33383
33384
33385
33386 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33387 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33388 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33389 You must include this line near the start of your code:
33390 .code
33391 #include "local_scan.h"
33392 .endd
33393 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33394 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33395 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33396 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33397 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33398 strings and pointers to character strings:
33399 .code
33400 #define CS (char *)
33401 #define CCS (const char *)
33402 #define CSS (char **)
33403 #define US (unsigned char *)
33404 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33405 #define USS (unsigned char **)
33406 .endd
33407 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33408 .code
33409 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33410 .endd
33411 The arguments are as follows:
33412
33413 .ilist
33414 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33415 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33416 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33417
33418 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33419 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33420 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33421 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33422 case this changes in some future version.
33423 .next
33424 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33425 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33426 .endlist
33427
33428 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33429
33430 .vlist
33431 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33432 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33433 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33434 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33435 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33436 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33437
33438 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33439 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33440 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33441
33442 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33443 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33444 queued without immediate delivery.
33445
33446 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33447 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33448 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33449 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33450 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33451 used.
33452
33453 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33454 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33455 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33456 problem"& is used.
33457
33458 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33459 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33460 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33461 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33462 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33463 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33464 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33465
33466 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33467 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33468 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33469 .endlist
33470
33471 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33472 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33473 &%-oe%& command line options.
33474
33475
33476
33477 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33478 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33479 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33480 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33481 want to do this, you must have the line
33482 .code
33483 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33484 .endd
33485 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33486 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33487 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33488 to define them.
33489
33490 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33491 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33492 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33493 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33494 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33495 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33496 .code
33497 static int my_integer_option = 42;
33498 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33499
33500 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33501 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33502 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33503 };
33504
33505 int local_scan_options_count =
33506 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33507 .endd
33508 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33509 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33510 .code
33511 begin local_scan
33512 my_integer = 99
33513 my_string = some string of text...
33514 .endd
33515 The available types of option data are as follows:
33516
33517 .vlist
33518 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
33519 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33520 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33521 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33522 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33523 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33524 values.)
33525
33526 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33527 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33528 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33529 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33530
33531 .vitem &*opt_int*&
33532 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33533 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33534 Exim.
33535
33536 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33537 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33538 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33539 printed with the suffix K or M.
33540
33541 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
33542 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33543 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33544 always output in octal.
33545
33546 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33547 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33548 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33549
33550 .vitem &*opt_time*&
33551 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33552 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33553 .endlist
33554
33555 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33556 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33557
33558
33559
33560 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33561 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33562 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33563 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33564 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33565 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33566 C variables are as follows:
33567
33568 .vlist
33569 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33570 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33571 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33572
33573 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33574 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33575 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33576
33577 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33578 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33579 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33580 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33581
33582 .ilist
33583 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33584 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33585 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33586
33587 .next
33588 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33589 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33590 of debugging bits.
33591 .endlist ilist
33592
33593 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33594 selected, you should use code like this:
33595 .code
33596 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33597 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33598 .endd
33599 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33600 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33601 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33602
33603 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33604 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33605 discussed below.
33606
33607 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33608 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33609
33610 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33611 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33612
33613 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33614 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33615 &%-bh%& command line option.
33616
33617 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33618 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33619 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33620
33621 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33622 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33623 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33624 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33625
33626 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33627 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33628 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33629
33630 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33631 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33632
33633 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33634 The number of accepted recipients.
33635
33636 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33637 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33638 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33639 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33640 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33641 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33642 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33643 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33644 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33645 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33646 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33647 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33648
33649 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33650 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33651
33652 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33653 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33654 locally-submitted messages.
33655
33656 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33657 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33658 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33659
33660 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33661 The name of the sending host, if known.
33662
33663 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33664 The port on the sending host.
33665
33666 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33667 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33668
33669 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33670 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33671
33672 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33673 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33674 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33675 .endlist
33676
33677
33678 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33679 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33680 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33681 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33682 their type to *.
33683
33684
33685 .vlist
33686 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33687 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33688
33689 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33690 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33691 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33692 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33693 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33694 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33695 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33696
33697 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33698 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33699 internal newlines.
33700
33701 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33702 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33703 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33704 .endlist
33705
33706
33707
33708 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33709 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33710
33711 .vlist
33712 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33713 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33714
33715 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33716 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33717 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33718 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33719
33720 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33721 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33722 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33723 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33724 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33725 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33726 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33727 is NULL for all recipients.
33728 .endlist
33729
33730
33731
33732 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33733 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33734 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33735 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33736 release:
33737
33738 .vlist
33739 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33740 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33741
33742 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33743 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33744 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33745 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33746
33747 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33748 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33749 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33750 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33751 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33752
33753 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33754
33755 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33756 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33757 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33758 return value is as follows:
33759
33760 .ilist
33761 >= 0
33762
33763 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33764 ending status.
33765
33766 .next
33767 < 0 and > &--256
33768
33769 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33770 signal number.
33771
33772 .next
33773 &--256
33774
33775 The process timed out.
33776 .next
33777 &--257
33778
33779 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33780 .endlist
33781
33782 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33783 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33784 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33785 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33786 forks a subprocess that is running
33787 .code
33788 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33789 .endd
33790 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33791 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33792 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33793 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33794
33795 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33796 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33797 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33798 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33799
33800
33801 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33802 *sender_authentication)*&
33803 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33804 that it runs is:
33805 .display
33806 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33807 .endd
33808 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33809
33810
33811 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33812 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33813 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33814 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33815 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33816 .code
33817 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33818 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33819 .endd
33820
33821 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33822 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33823 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33824 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33825 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33826 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33827 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33828 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33829
33830 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33831 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33832 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33833 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33834 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33835 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33836
33837 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33838 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33839 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33840 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33841
33842 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33843 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33844 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33845 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33846 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33847 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33848 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33849 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33850 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33851 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33852 .code
33853 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33854 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33855 .endd
33856 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33857 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33858
33859
33860 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33861 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33862 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33863 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33864 match the specification, the function does nothing.
33865
33866
33867 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33868 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33869 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33870 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33871 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33872 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33873 .code
33874 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33875 .endd
33876 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33877 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33878 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33879 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33880 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33881 zero-terminated.
33882
33883 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33884 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33885 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33886 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33887 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33888 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33889 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33890 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33891
33892 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33893 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33894 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33895 .display
33896 &`OK `& match succeeded
33897 &`FAIL `& match failed
33898 &`DEFER `& match deferred
33899 .endd
33900 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33901 inability to contact a database.
33902
33903 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33904 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33905 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33906 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33907 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33908
33909 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33910 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33911 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33912 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33913 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33914
33915 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33916 uschar&~*list)*&"
33917 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33918 expected to be
33919 .code
33920 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33921 .endd
33922 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33923 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33924 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33925 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33926 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33927 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33928 failed.
33929
33930 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33931 *format,&~...)*&"
33932 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33933 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33934 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33935 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33936 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33937 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33938
33939
33940 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33941 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33942 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33943 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33944
33945 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33946 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33947 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33948 value afterwards. For example:
33949 .code
33950 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33951 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33952 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33953 .endd
33954
33955 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33956 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33957 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33958 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33959 address.
33960 .endlist
33961
33962
33963 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33964 .vlist
33965 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33966 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33967 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33968 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33969 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33970 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33971 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33972 binary string is returned with an error message.
33973
33974 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33975 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33976 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33977
33978 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33979 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33980 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33981 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33982 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33983
33984 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33985 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33986 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33987
33988 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33989 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33990 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33991 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33992 with translation.
33993
33994
33995 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33996 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33997 below.
33998
33999 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34000 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34001 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34002 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34003 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34004 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34005 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34006 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34007 is involved.
34008
34009 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34010 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34011
34012 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34013 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34014 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34015 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34016 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34017 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34018 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34019 .code
34020 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34021 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34022 .endd
34023 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34024 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34025 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34026 multiple output lines.
34027
34028 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34029 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
34030 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34031 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34032 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34033 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34034 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34035 is an error.
34036
34037 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
34038 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34039 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
34040 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34041
34042 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
34043 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34044 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34045
34046 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34047 See below.
34048
34049 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34050 See below.
34051
34052 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34053 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34054 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34055 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34056 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34057 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34058 more discussion.
34059 .endlist
34060
34061
34062
34063 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34064 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34065 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34066 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34067 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34068 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34069 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34070 terminates.
34071
34072 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34073 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34074 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34075 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34076
34077 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34078 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34079 .code
34080 store_pool = POOL_PERM
34081 .endd
34082 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34083 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34084 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34085 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34086
34087 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34088 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34089 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34090 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34091 &%store_pool%&.
34092 .ecindex IIDlosca
34093
34094
34095
34096
34097 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34098 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34099
34100 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34101 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34102 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34103 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34104 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34105 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34106 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34107 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34108
34109 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34110 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34111 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34112 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34113 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34114
34115 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34116 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34117 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34118 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34119 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34120 prevent it happening on retries.
34121
34122 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34123 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34124 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34125 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34126 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34127 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34128 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34129 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34130
34131
34132 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34133 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34134 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34135 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34136 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34137 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34138 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34139 .code
34140 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34141 system_filter_user = exim
34142 .endd
34143 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34144 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34145 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34146 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34147 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34148 by the &%reply%& command.
34149
34150
34151 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34152 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34153 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34154 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34155
34156 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34157 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34158
34159
34160
34161 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34162 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34163 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34164 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34165 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34166 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34167 they cause errors.
34168
34169 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34170 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34171 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34172 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34173 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34174 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34175 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34176
34177 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34178 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34179 succeed, it will not be tried again.
34180 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34181 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34182
34183 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34184 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34185 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34186 to which users' filter files can refer.
34187
34188
34189
34190 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34191 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
34192 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34193 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34194 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34195
34196
34197
34198 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34199 .cindex "freezing messages"
34200 .cindex "message" "freezing"
34201 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
34202 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34203 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34204 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34205 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34206 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34207 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34208 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34209 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34210 .code
34211 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34212 .endd
34213 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34214
34215 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34216 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34217 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34218 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34219 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34220 run.
34221
34222 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34223 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34224 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34225 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34226
34227 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34228 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34229 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34230 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34231 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34232 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34233 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34234 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34235 message. For example:
34236 .code
34237 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34238 because it contains attachments that we are \
34239 not prepared to receive."
34240 .endd
34241
34242 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34243 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34244 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34245 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34246 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34247 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34248 use, for example
34249 .code
34250 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34251 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34252 .endd
34253 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34254 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34255 generated by the filter.
34256
34257 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34258 &%defer%&,
34259 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34260 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34261 as
34262 .code
34263 mail ...
34264 freeze
34265 .endd
34266 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34267 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34268 take place.
34269
34270
34271
34272 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34273 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34274 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34275 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34276 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34277 .code
34278 headers add <string>
34279 headers remove <string>
34280 .endd
34281 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34282 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34283 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34284 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34285 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34286
34287 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34288 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34289 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34290 example:
34291 .code
34292 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34293 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34294 X-header-2: ...."
34295 .endd
34296 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34297 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34298 space after input continuations is ignored.
34299
34300 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34301 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34302 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34303 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34304 header with the same name, they are all removed.
34305
34306 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34307 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34308 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34309 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34310 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34311 used for all recipients of the message.
34312
34313 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34314 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34315 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34316 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34317 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34318 until the message is actually being written (see section
34319 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34320
34321 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34322 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34323 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34324 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34325 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34326 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34327 modified more than once.
34328
34329 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34330 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34331 For example:
34332 .code
34333 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34334 headers remove "Subject"
34335 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34336 headers remove "Old-Subject"
34337 .endd
34338
34339
34340
34341 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34342 .cindex "envelope sender"
34343 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34344 .code
34345 errors_to <some address>
34346 .endd
34347 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34348 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34349 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34350 might use
34351 .code
34352 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34353 .endd
34354 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34355 address if its delivery failed.
34356
34357
34358
34359 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34360 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34361 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34362 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34363 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34364 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34365 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34366 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34367 which implements such a filter:
34368 .code
34369 central_filter:
34370 check_local_user
34371 driver = redirect
34372 domains = +local_domains
34373 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34374 no_verify
34375 allow_filter
34376 allow_freeze
34377 .endd
34378 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34379 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34380 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34381 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34382
34383 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34384 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34385 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34386 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34387 normal way.
34388 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
34389 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
34390 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
34391
34392
34393
34394
34395
34396
34397 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34398 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34399
34400 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34401 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34402 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34403 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34404 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34405 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34406 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34407 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34408
34409 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34410 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34411 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34412 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34413 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34414
34415 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34416 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34417 loopback interface specially in any way.
34418
34419 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34420 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34421
34422
34423
34424
34425 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34426 .cindex "message" "submission"
34427 .cindex "submission mode"
34428 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34429 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34430 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34431 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34432 .code
34433 control = submission
34434 .endd
34435 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34436 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34437 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34438 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34439 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34440 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34441 .code
34442 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34443 control = submission
34444 .endd
34445 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34446 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34447 is used to separate options. For example:
34448 .code
34449 control = submission/sender_retain
34450 .endd
34451 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34452 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34453 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34454 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34455 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34456 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34457 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34458
34459 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34460 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34461 example:
34462 .code
34463 control = submission/domain=some.domain
34464 .endd
34465 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34466 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34467 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34468 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34469 .code
34470 accept authenticated = *
34471 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34472 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34473 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34474 .endd
34475 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34476 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34477 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34478 .code
34479 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34480 .endd
34481 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34482 line would be:
34483 .code
34484 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34485 .endd
34486 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34487 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34488 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34489 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34490
34491 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34492 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34493 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34494 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34495 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34496 spoof another's address.
34497
34498 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34499 .cindex "line endings"
34500 .cindex "carriage return"
34501 .cindex "linefeed"
34502 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34503 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34504 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34505 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34506 use CRLF or just CR.
34507
34508 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34509 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34510 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34511 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34512 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34513 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34514 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34515 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34516 follows:
34517
34518 .ilist
34519 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34520 .next
34521 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34522 is ignored.
34523 .next
34524 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34525 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34526 terminator.
34527 .next
34528 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34529 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34530 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34531 people trying to play silly games.
34532 .next
34533 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34534 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34535 line.
34536 .endlist
34537
34538
34539
34540
34541
34542 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34543 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
34544 .cindex "address" "qualification"
34545 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34546 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34547 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34548 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34549 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34550
34551 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34552 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34553 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34554 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34555 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34556
34557 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34558 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34559 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34560 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34561 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34562 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34563 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34564 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34565
34566
34567
34568
34569 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34570 .cindex "&""From""& line"
34571 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34572 .cindex "sender" "address"
34573 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34574 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34575 .cindex "envelope sender"
34576 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34577 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34578 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34579 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34580 .code
34581 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34582 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34583 .endd
34584 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34585 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34586 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34587 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34588 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34589 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34590 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34591 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34592 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34593
34594 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34595 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34596 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34597 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34598 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34599 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34600 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34601
34602 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34603 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34604 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34605
34606 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34607 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34608 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34609 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34610
34611
34612
34613 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34614 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34615 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34616 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34617 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34618 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34619 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34620 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34621
34622 .blockquote
34623 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34624 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34625 .endblockquote
34626
34627 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34628 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34629 follows:
34630
34631 .ilist
34632 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34633 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34634 .next
34635 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34636 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34637 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34638 .next
34639 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34640 also removed.
34641 .next
34642 For a locally-submitted message,
34643 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34644 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34645 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34646 included in log lines in this case.
34647 .next
34648 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34649 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34650 .endlist
34651
34652
34653
34654
34655 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34656 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34657 includes the header line:
34658 .code
34659 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34660 .endd
34661
34662 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34663 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34664 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34665 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34666 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34667 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34668
34669
34670 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34671 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34672 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34673 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34674 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34675 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34676
34677 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34678 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34679 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34680 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34681 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34682 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34683 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34684 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34685 messages.
34686
34687
34688 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34689 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34690 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34691 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34692 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34693 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34694 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34695 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34696 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34697 messages.
34698
34699
34700 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34701 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34702 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34703 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34704 .cindex "message" "submission"
34705 .cindex "submission mode"
34706 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34707 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34708
34709 .ilist
34710 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34711 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34712 .next
34713 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34714 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34715 .olist
34716 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34717 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34718 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34719 .next
34720 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34721 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34722 .next
34723 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34724 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34725 .endlist
34726 .endlist
34727
34728 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34729
34730 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34731 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34732 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34733 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34734 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34735 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34736 &%qualify_domain%&.
34737
34738 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34739 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34740 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34741 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34742
34743
34744 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34745 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34746 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34747 .cindex "message" "submission"
34748 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34749 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34750 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34751 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34752 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34753 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34754 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34755 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34756 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34757 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34758
34759
34760 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34761 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34762 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34763 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34764 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34765 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34766
34767 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34768 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34769 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34770 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34771
34772 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34773 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34774 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34775
34776
34777 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34778 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34779 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34780 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34781 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34782 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34783 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34784 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34785 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34786 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34787 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34788 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34789
34790
34791
34792 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34793 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34794 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34795 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34796 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34797 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34798 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34799 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34800 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34801
34802
34803
34804 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34805 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34806 .cindex "message" "submission"
34807 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34808 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34809 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34810 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34811 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34812 control setting.
34813
34814 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34815 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34816 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34817 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34818 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34819 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34820 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34821 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34822 line is added to the message.
34823
34824 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34825 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34826 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34827 options true at the same time.
34828
34829 .cindex "submission mode"
34830 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34831 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34832 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34833 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34834
34835 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34836 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34837 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34838 created as follows:
34839
34840 .ilist
34841 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34842 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34843 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34844 .next
34845 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34846 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34847 .next
34848 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34849 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34850 .endlist
34851
34852 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34853 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34854 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34855 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34856
34857 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34858 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34859 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34860 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34861
34862
34863
34864 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34865 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34866 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34867 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34868 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34869 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34870 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34871 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34872 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34873
34874 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34875 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34876 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34877 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34878 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34879 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34880
34881 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34882 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34883 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34884
34885 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34886 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34887 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34888 .code
34889 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34890 X-added-second: another added header line
34891 .endd
34892 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34893
34894 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34895 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34896 Each header-line is separately expanded.
34897
34898 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34899 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34900 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34901 not part of the names. For example:
34902 .code
34903 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34904 .endd
34905
34906 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34907 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34908 Each item is separately expanded.
34909 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34910 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34911 will act as list separators.
34912
34913 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34914 items are expanded at routing time,
34915 and then associated with all addresses that are
34916 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34917 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34918 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34919
34920 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
34921 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34922 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34923 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34924
34925 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34926 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34927 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34928 requirements.
34929
34930 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34931 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34932 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34933 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34934 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34935 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34936 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34937
34938 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34939 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34940 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34941 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34942
34943 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34944 the following consequences:
34945
34946 .ilist
34947 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34948 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34949 to it, at all times.
34950 .next
34951 Header lines that are added by a router's
34952 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34953 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34954 .next
34955 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34956 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34957 .next
34958 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34959 a later router or by a transport.
34960 .next
34961 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34962 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34963 .code
34964 headers_remove = subject
34965 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34966 .endd
34967 .endlist
34968
34969 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34970 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34971
34972
34973
34974
34975
34976 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34977 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34978 .cindex "constructed address"
34979 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34980 the form
34981 .display
34982 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34983 .endd
34984 For example:
34985 .code
34986 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34987 .endd
34988 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34989 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34990 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34991 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34992 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34993 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34994 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34995 there is no password file entry.
34996
34997 .cindex "RFC 2047"
34998 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34999 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35000 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35001 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35002 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35003 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35004 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35005 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35006
35007
35008
35009 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35010 .cindex "case of local parts"
35011 .cindex "local part" "case of"
35012 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35013 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35014 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35015 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35016 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35017 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35018 router option.
35019
35020 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
35021 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35022 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35023 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35024 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35025 .code
35026 correct_case:
35027 driver = redirect
35028 domains = +local_domains
35029 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35030 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35031 @$domain
35032 .endd
35033 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35034 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35035 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35036 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35037 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35038
35039
35040
35041 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35042 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
35043 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
35044 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35045 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35046 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35047 empty components for compatibility.
35048
35049
35050
35051 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35052 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35053 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35054 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35055 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35056 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35057
35058 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35059 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35060 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35061 example, a header such as
35062 .code
35063 To: hare@teaparty
35064 .endd
35065 might get rewritten as
35066 .code
35067 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35068 .endd
35069 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35070 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35071 been routed.
35072
35073 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35074 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35075 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35076 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35077 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35078 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35079 .ecindex IIDmesproc
35080
35081
35082
35083 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35084 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35085
35086 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35087 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35088 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35089 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35090 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35091 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35092 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35093
35094 .ilist
35095 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35096 .next
35097 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35098 .next
35099 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35100 .endlist
35101
35102 For mail delivery, the following are available:
35103
35104 .ilist
35105 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35106 .next
35107 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35108 &"lmtp"&);
35109 .next
35110 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35111 transport);
35112 .next
35113 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35114 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35115 .endlist
35116
35117 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35118 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35119 used to contain the envelope information.
35120
35121
35122
35123 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35124 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35125 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35126 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35127 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35128 .cindex "EHLO"
35129 .cindex "HELO"
35130 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35131 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35132 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35133 processing is the same in both cases.
35134
35135 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35136 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35137 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35138 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35139 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35140 .cindex "transport" "filter"
35141 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35142 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35143 suppressed.
35144
35145 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35146 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35147 required for the transaction.
35148
35149 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35150 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35151 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35152 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35153 is called for verification.
35154
35155 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35156 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35157 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35158
35159 .cindex "carriage return"
35160 .cindex "linefeed"
35161 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35162 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35163 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35164 line terminator.
35165
35166 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35167 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35168 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35169 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35170 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35171 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35172 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35173 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35174 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35175
35176 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35177 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35178 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35179 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35180
35181 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35182 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35183 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35184 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35185
35186 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35187 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35188 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35189 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35190 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35191 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35192 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35193 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35194 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35195 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35196
35197 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35198 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35199
35200 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35201 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35202 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35203 square bracket of the IP address.
35204
35205
35206
35207
35208 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35209 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35210 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35211 .cindex "host" "error"
35212 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35213 message errors, and recipient errors.
35214
35215 .vlist
35216 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35217 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35218 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35219
35220 .ilist
35221 Connection refused or timed out,
35222 .next
35223 Any error response code on connection,
35224 .next
35225 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35226 .next
35227 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35228 .next
35229 I/O errors at any time,
35230 .next
35231 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35232 the &"."& at the end of the data.
35233 .endlist ilist
35234
35235 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35236 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35237 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35238 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35239 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35240 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35241 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35242 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35243
35244 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35245 .cindex "message" "error"
35246 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35247 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35248 message errors are:
35249
35250 .ilist
35251 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35252 the data,
35253 .next
35254 Timeout after MAIL,
35255 .next
35256 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35257 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35258 connection at any other time.
35259 .endlist ilist
35260
35261 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35262 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35263 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35264 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35265 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35266 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35267 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35268 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35269 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35270 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35271
35272 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35273 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35274 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35275 response to MAIL.
35276
35277 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35278 .cindex "recipient" "error"
35279 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35280 recipient errors are:
35281
35282 .ilist
35283 Any error response to RCPT,
35284 .next
35285 Timeout after RCPT.
35286 .endlist
35287
35288 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35289 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35290 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35291 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35292 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35293 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35294 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35295 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35296 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35297 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35298 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35299 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35300 the retry clock is reset.
35301
35302 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35303 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35304 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35305 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35306 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35307 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35308 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35309 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35310 recipient's retry time.
35311 .endlist
35312
35313 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35314 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35315 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35316 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35317 until the next delivery attempt.
35318
35319 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35320 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35321 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35322 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35323 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35324 is created.
35325
35326 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35327 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35328 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35329 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35330 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35331 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35332 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35333
35334 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35335 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35336 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35337 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35338 then to be treated as a host error.
35339
35340 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35341 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35342 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35343 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35344 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35345
35346
35347
35348
35349 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35350 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35351 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35352 .cindex "inetd"
35353 .cindex "daemon"
35354 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35355 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35356 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35357 .code
35358 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35359 .endd
35360 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35361 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35362 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35363 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35364 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35365 stream and exits with an error code.
35366
35367 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35368 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35369 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35370 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35371
35372 .cindex "carriage return"
35373 .cindex "linefeed"
35374 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35375 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35376 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35377 line terminator.
35378 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35379 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35380 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35381
35382 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35383 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35384 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35385 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35386 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35387 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35388 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35389 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35390
35391 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35392 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35393 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35394 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35395 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35396 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35397 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35398 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35399 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35400
35401 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35402 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35403 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35404
35405 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35406 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35407 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35408 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35409 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35410
35411 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35412 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35413 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35414 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35415 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35416 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35417 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35418
35419 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35420 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35421 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35422 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35423 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35424
35425 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35426 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35427 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35428 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35429 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35430 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35431 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35432 a delivery process.
35433
35434 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35435 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35436 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35437 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35438 however, available with &'inetd'&.
35439
35440 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35441 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35442 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35443 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35444
35445 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35446 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35447 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35448
35449
35450
35451 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35452 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35453 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35454 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35455 the error response to the last command. The default value for
35456 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35457 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35458 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35459
35460
35461 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35462 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35463 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35464 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35465 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35466 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35467 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35468 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35469 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35470 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35471 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35472
35473
35474
35475 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35476 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35477 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35478 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35479 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35480 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35481 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35482 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35483
35484 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35485 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35486 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35487 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35488 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35489 counted.
35490
35491 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35492 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35493 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35494
35495 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35496 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35497 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35498 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35499 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35500
35501
35502
35503
35504 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35505 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35506 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35507 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35508
35509 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35510 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35511 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35512 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
35513 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35514 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35515 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35516 SMTP response codes.
35517
35518 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35519 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35520 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35521 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35522 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35523 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35524 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35525 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35526 RCPT failures.
35527
35528
35529
35530 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35531 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35532 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35533 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35534 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35535 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35536 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35537
35538 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35539 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35540 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35541 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35542 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35543 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35544 argument. For example,
35545 .code
35546 ETRN #brigadoon
35547 .endd
35548 runs the command
35549 .code
35550 exim -R brigadoon
35551 .endd
35552 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35553 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35554 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35555 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35556 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35557
35558 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35559 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35560 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35561 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35562 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35563 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35564 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35565 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35566
35567 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35568 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35569 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35570 whatever the form of its argument. For
35571 example:
35572 .code
35573 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35574 $sender_host_address
35575 .endd
35576 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35577 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35578 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35579 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35580 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35581 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35582 for it to change them before running the command.
35583
35584
35585
35586 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35587 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35588 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35589 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35590 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35591 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35592 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35593 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35594 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35595 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35596 runs for RCPT commands:
35597 .code
35598 accept hosts = :
35599 .endd
35600 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35601
35602
35603
35604 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35605 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35606 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
35607 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35608 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35609 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35610 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35611 envelope along with the message.
35612
35613 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35614 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35615 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35616 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35617 can be used to specify it.
35618
35619 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35620 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35621 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35622 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35623 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35624
35625 .vindex "&$host$&"
35626 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35627 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35628 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35629 router:
35630 .code
35631 begin routers
35632 route_append:
35633 driver = manualroute
35634 transport = smtp_appendfile
35635 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35636
35637 begin transports
35638 smtp_appendfile:
35639 driver = appendfile
35640 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35641 batch_max = 1000
35642 use_bsmtp
35643 user = exim
35644 .endd
35645 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35646 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35647 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35648
35649
35650
35651 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35652 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35653 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
35654 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35655 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35656 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35657 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35658 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35659 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35660 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35661
35662 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35663 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35664
35665 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35666 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35667 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35668 make some use of automatically, for example:
35669 .code
35670 554 Unexpected end of file
35671 Transaction started in line 10
35672 Error detected in line 14
35673 .endd
35674 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35675 file, for example:
35676 .code
35677 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35678 The error message was:
35679
35680 501 '>' missing at end of address
35681
35682 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35683 The error was detected in line 12.
35684 The SMTP command at fault was:
35685
35686 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35687
35688 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35689 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35690 .endd
35691 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35692 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35693 accepted.
35694 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35695 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35696
35697
35698
35699 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35701
35702 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35703 "Customizing messages"
35704 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
35705 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35706 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35707 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35708 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35709
35710 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35711 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35712 option. Exim also adds the line
35713 .code
35714 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35715 .endd
35716 to all warning and bounce messages,
35717
35718
35719 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35720 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35721 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35722 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35723 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35724 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35725 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35726
35727 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35728 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35729 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35730 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35731 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35732 item.
35733
35734 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35735 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35736 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35737 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35738 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35739 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35740 option, rounded to a whole number.
35741
35742 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35743
35744 .ilist
35745 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35746 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35747 .next
35748 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35749 failing addresses with their error messages.
35750 .next
35751 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35752 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35753 .next
35754 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35755 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35756 .endlist
35757
35758 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35759 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35760 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35761 .code
35762 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35763 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35764 {: returning message to sender}}
35765 ****
35766 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35767
35768 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35769 {that you sent }{sent by
35770
35771 <$sender_address>
35772
35773 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35774 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35775 ****
35776 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35777 ****
35778 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35779 ------
35780 ****
35781 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35782 only the first
35783 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35784 ****
35785 .endd
35786 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35787 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35788 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35789 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35790 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35791 text sections:
35792
35793 .ilist
35794 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35795 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35796 .next
35797 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35798 the delayed addresses.
35799 .next
35800 The third item then ends the message.
35801 .endlist
35802
35803 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35804 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35805 .code
35806 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35807 $warn_message_delay
35808 ****
35809 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35810
35811 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35812 {that you sent }{sent by
35813
35814 <$sender_address>
35815
35816 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35817 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
35818
35819 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35820 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35821 The date of the message is: $h_date
35822
35823 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35824 ****
35825 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35826 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35827 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35828 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35829 the message will be returned to you.
35830 .endd
35831 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35832 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35833 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35834 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35835 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35836 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35837 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35838 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35839 handled them.
35840
35841
35842
35843
35844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35845 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35846
35847 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35848 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35849 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35850
35851
35852
35853 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35854 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35855 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35856 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35857 routing explicitly:
35858 .code
35859 send_to_smart_host:
35860 driver = manualroute
35861 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35862 transport = remote_smtp
35863 .endd
35864 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35865 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35866 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35867 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35868 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35869
35870
35871
35872
35873 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35874 .cindex "mailing lists"
35875 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35876 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35877 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35878
35879 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35880 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35881 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35882 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35883 .code
35884 lists:
35885 driver = redirect
35886 domains = lists.example
35887 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35888 forbid_pipe
35889 forbid_file
35890 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35891 no_more
35892 .endd
35893 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35894 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35895 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35896 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35897
35898 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35899 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35900 a mailing list.
35901
35902 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35903 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35904 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35905 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35906 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35907
35908 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35909 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35910 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35911 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35912 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35913 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35914 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35915 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35916 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35917
35918
35919
35920 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35921 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35922 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35923 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35924 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35925 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35926 addresses are not rigorously checked.
35927
35928 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35929 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35930 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35931 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35932 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35933
35934
35935
35936 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35937 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35938 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35939 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35940 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35941 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35942 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35943 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35944 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35945 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35946
35947 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35948 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35949 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35950 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35951 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35952 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35953 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35954 pre-existing messages.
35955
35956 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35957 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35958 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35959 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35960 one level of expansion anyway.
35961
35962
35963
35964 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35965 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35966 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35967 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35968 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35969 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35970
35971 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35972 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35973 .code
35974 lists_request:
35975 driver = redirect
35976 domains = lists.example
35977 local_part_suffix = -request
35978 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35979 no_more
35980
35981 lists_post:
35982 driver = redirect
35983 domains = lists.example
35984 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35985 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35986 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35987 forbid_pipe
35988 forbid_file
35989 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35990 no_more
35991
35992 lists_closed:
35993 driver = redirect
35994 domains = lists.example
35995 allow_fail
35996 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35997 .endd
35998 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35999 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36000 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36001 mailing list.
36002
36003 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36004 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36005 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36006 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36007 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36008 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36009 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36010 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36011 &"unrouteable address"& error.
36012
36013 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36014 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36015 the address, giving a suitable error message.
36016
36017
36018
36019
36020 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36021 .cindex "VERP"
36022 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36023 .cindex "envelope sender"
36024 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36025 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36026 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36027 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36028 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36029 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36030
36031 .oindex &%errors_to%&
36032 .oindex &%return_path%&
36033 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36034 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36035 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36036 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36037 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36038 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36039 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36040 .code
36041 verp_smtp:
36042 driver = smtp
36043 max_rcpt = 1
36044 return_path = \
36045 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36046 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36047 .endd
36048 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36049 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36050 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36051 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36052 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36053 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36054 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36055 rewritten as
36056 .code
36057 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36058 .endd
36059 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36060 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36061 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36062 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36063 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36064 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36065
36066 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36067 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36068 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36069 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36070 .code
36071 dnslookup:
36072 driver = dnslookup
36073 domains = ! +local_domains
36074 transport = \
36075 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36076 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36077 no_more
36078 .endd
36079 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36080 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36081 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36082 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36083 address.
36084
36085 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36086 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36087 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36088 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36089 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36090 .code
36091 verp_dnslookup:
36092 driver = dnslookup
36093 domains = ! +local_domains
36094 transport = remote_smtp
36095 errors_to = \
36096 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36097 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36098 no_more
36099 .endd
36100 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36101 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36102 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36103 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36104 them.
36105
36106 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36107 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36108 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36109 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36110 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36111 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36112 used).
36113
36114
36115
36116
36117
36118
36119 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36120 .cindex "virtual domains"
36121 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
36122 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36123 meanings:
36124
36125 .ilist
36126 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36127 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36128 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36129 .next
36130 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36131 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36132 have login accounts on that host.
36133 .endlist
36134
36135 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36136 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36137 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36138 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36139 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36140 to a router of this form:
36141 .code
36142 virtual:
36143 driver = redirect
36144 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36145 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36146 no_more
36147 .endd
36148 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36149 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36150 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36151 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36152 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36153 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36154
36155 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36156 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36157 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36158 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36159
36160 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36161 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36162 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36163 .code
36164 my_domains:
36165 driver = accept
36166 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36167 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36168 transport = my_mailboxes
36169 .endd
36170 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36171 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36172 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36173 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36174 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36175 follows:
36176 .code
36177 my_mailboxes:
36178 driver = appendfile
36179 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36180 user = mail
36181 .endd
36182 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36183 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36184
36185 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36186 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36187 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36188 information about the domains.
36189
36190
36191
36192 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36193 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36194 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36195 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
36196 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
36197 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36198 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36199 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36200 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36201 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36202 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36203 example, consider this router:
36204 .code
36205 userforward:
36206 driver = redirect
36207 check_local_user
36208 file = $home/.forward
36209 local_part_suffix = -*
36210 local_part_suffix_optional
36211 allow_filter
36212 .endd
36213 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36214 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36215 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36216 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36217 .code
36218 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36219 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36220 endif
36221 .endd
36222 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36223 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36224 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36225 control over which suffixes are valid.
36226
36227 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36228 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36229 another MTA:
36230 .code
36231 userforward:
36232 driver = redirect
36233 check_local_user
36234 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36235 local_part_suffix = -*
36236 local_part_suffix_optional
36237 allow_filter
36238 .endd
36239 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36240 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36241 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36242 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36243 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36244
36245
36246
36247 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36248 .cindex "vacation processing"
36249 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36250 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36251 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36252 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36253 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36254
36255 .ilist
36256 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36257 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36258 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36259 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36260 .code
36261 spqr, vacation-spqr
36262 .endd
36263 .next
36264 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36265 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36266 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36267 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36268 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36269 message.
36270 .endlist
36271
36272 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36273 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36274
36275
36276
36277 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36278 .cindex "message" "copying every"
36279 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36280 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36281 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36282 each day's messages.
36283
36284 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36285 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36286 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36287 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36288
36289
36290
36291 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36292 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36293 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36294 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36295 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36296 permanently connected.
36297
36298 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36299 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36300 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36301
36302
36303 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36304 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36305 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36306 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36307 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36308 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36309 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36310 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36311
36312 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36313 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36314 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36315 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36316 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36317 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36318 if required.
36319
36320 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36321 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36322 intermittent host. For example:
36323 .code
36324 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36325 .endd
36326 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36327 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36328 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36329 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36330 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36331 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36332 immediately.
36333
36334 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36335 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36336 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36337 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36338 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36339 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36340 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36341
36342
36343
36344 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36345 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36346 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36347 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36348 delivered immediately.
36349
36350 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36351 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36352 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36353 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36354 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36355 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36356 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36357 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36358 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36359 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36360 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36361 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36362 single SMTP connection.
36363
36364
36365
36366 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36367 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36368
36369 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36370 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36371 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
36372 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36373 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36374 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36375 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36376 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36377 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36378 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36379 messages this way.
36380
36381 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36382 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36383 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36384 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36385 email is not desirable.
36386
36387 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36388 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36389 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36390 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36391 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36392 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36393 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36394
36395 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36396 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36397 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36398 before sending a message to the smart host.
36399
36400 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36401 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36402 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36403
36404 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36405 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36406 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36407 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36408 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36409 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36410 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36411
36412 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36413 following ways:
36414
36415 .ilist
36416 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36417 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36418 .next
36419 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36420 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36421 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36422 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36423 successful, a zero return code is given.
36424 .next
36425 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36426 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36427 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36428 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36429 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36430 are.
36431 .next
36432 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36433 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36434 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36435 .next
36436 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36437 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36438 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36439 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36440 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36441 .next
36442 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36443 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36444 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36445 .next
36446 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36447 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36448 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36449 are ever generated.
36450 .next
36451 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36452 .next
36453 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36454 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36455 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36456 .endlist
36457
36458 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36459 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36460 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36461 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36462 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36463 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36464
36465
36466
36467
36468 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36469 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36470
36471 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36472 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36473 .cindex "log" "types of"
36474 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36475 and the panic log:
36476
36477 .ilist
36478 .cindex "main log"
36479 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36480 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36481 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36482 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36483 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36484 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36485 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36486 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36487 .next
36488 .cindex "reject log"
36489 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36490 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36491 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36492 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36493 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36494 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36495 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36496 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36497 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36498 false.
36499 .next
36500 .cindex "panic log"
36501 .cindex "system log"
36502 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36503 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36504 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36505 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36506 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36507 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36508 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36509 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36510 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36511 .endlist
36512
36513 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36514 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36515 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36516 .code
36517 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36518 by QUIT
36519 .endd
36520 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36521 ways of changing this:
36522
36523 .ilist
36524 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36525 you set
36526 .code
36527 timezone = UTC
36528 .endd
36529 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36530 .next
36531 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36532 example:
36533 .code
36534 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36535 .endd
36536 .endlist
36537
36538 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36539 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36540 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36541 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36542 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36543 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36544
36545
36546
36547
36548 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36549 .cindex "log" "destination"
36550 .cindex "log" "to file"
36551 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
36552 .cindex "syslog"
36553 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36554 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36555 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36556 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36557 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36558 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36559 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36560
36561 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36562 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36563 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36564 references to the host name:
36565 .code
36566 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36567 .endd
36568 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36569 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36570 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36571 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36572 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36573 log at all.
36574
36575 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36576 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36577 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36578 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36579 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36580 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36581 implying the use of a default path.
36582
36583 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36584 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36585 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36586 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36587 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36588 equivalent to the setting:
36589 .code
36590 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36591 .endd
36592 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36593 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36594 that is where the logs are written.
36595
36596 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
36597 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36598
36599 Here are some examples of possible settings:
36600 .display
36601 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36602 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36603 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36604 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36605 .endd
36606 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36607 error is logged.
36608
36609
36610
36611 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36612 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36613 .cindex "cycling logs"
36614 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36615 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36616 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36617 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36618 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36619 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36620 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36621
36622 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36623 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36624 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36625 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36626 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36627 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36628 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36629 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36630 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36631 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36632 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36633 renamed.
36634
36635
36636
36637 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36638 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36639 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36640 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36641 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36642 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36643 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36644 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36645 .code
36646 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36647 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36648 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36649 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36650 .endd
36651 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36652 examples of names generated by the above examples:
36653 .code
36654 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36655 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36656 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36657 /var/log/exim/main.200212
36658 .endd
36659 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36660 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36661 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36662 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36663
36664 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36665 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36666 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36667 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36668 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36669 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36670 log names:
36671 .code
36672 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36673 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36674 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36675 /var/log/exim/panic
36676 .endd
36677
36678
36679 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36680 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36681 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36682 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36683 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36684 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36685 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36686 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36687 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36688 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36689 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36690 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36691 the time and host name to each line.
36692 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36693
36694 .ilist
36695 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36696 .next
36697 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36698 .next
36699 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36700 .endlist
36701
36702 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36703 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36704 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36705 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36706
36707 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36708 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36709 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36710 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36711 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36712 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36713 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36714 RFC 3164, you should set
36715 .code
36716 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36717 .endd
36718 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36719 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36720
36721 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36722 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36723 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36724 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36725 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36726 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36727 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36728 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36729 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36730 .code
36731 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36732 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36733 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36734 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36735 [5/5] mple>)
36736 .endd
36737 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36738 (LOG_NOTICE):
36739 .code
36740 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36741 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36742 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36743 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36744 [5\18] .example>)
36745 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36746 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36747 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36748 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36749 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36750 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36751 [12\18] F From: <>
36752 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36753 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36754 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36755 [16\18] le>
36756 [17\18] B Bcc:
36757 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36758 .endd
36759 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36760 without modification.
36761
36762 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36763 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36764 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36765 where it is.
36766
36767
36768
36769 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36770 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36771 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36772 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36773 timestamp. The flags are:
36774 .display
36775 &`<=`& message arrival
36776 &`(=`& message fakereject
36777 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36778 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36779 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36780 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36781 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36782 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36783 .endd
36784
36785
36786 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36787 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36788 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36789 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36790 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36791 .code
36792 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36793 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36794 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36795 .endd
36796 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36797 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36798 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36799 .code
36800 R=<message id>
36801 .endd
36802 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36803
36804 .cindex "HELO"
36805 .cindex "EHLO"
36806 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36807 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36808 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36809 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36810 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36811 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36812 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36813 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36814 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36815 name in parentheses.
36816
36817 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36818 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36819 the log containing text like these examples:
36820 .code
36821 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36822 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36823 .endd
36824 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36825 on.
36826
36827 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36828 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36829 of Exim.
36830
36831 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36832 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36833 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36834 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36835 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36836 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36837 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36838 suite that was used.
36839
36840 .cindex log protocol
36841 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36842 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36843 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36844 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36845 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36846 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36847 authenticator name.
36848
36849 .cindex "size" "of message"
36850 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36851 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36852 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36853 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36854 other).
36855
36856 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36857 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36858
36859
36860
36861 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36862 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
36863 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36864 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36865 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36866 to fit it on the page:
36867 .code
36868 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36869 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
36870 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36871 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36872 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36873 .endd
36874 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36875 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36876 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36877 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36878 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36879
36880 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36881 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36882 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36883 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36884
36885 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36886 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36887 .display
36888 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36889 .endd
36890 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36891 parentheses afterwards.
36892
36893 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36894 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36895 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36896 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36897 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36898 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36899 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36900 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36901 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36902 TLS cipher information is still available.
36903
36904 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36905 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36906 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36907 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36908 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36909
36910 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36911 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36912
36913 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36914 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36915
36916
36917 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36918 .cindex "discarded messages"
36919 .cindex "message" "discarded"
36920 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36921 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36922 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36923 .code
36924 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36925 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36926 .endd
36927 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36928 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36929 .code
36930 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36931 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36932 .endd
36933
36934
36935 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36936 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36937 .code
36938 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36939 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36940 .endd
36941 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36942 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36943 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36944 .code
36945 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36946 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36947 .endd
36948 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36949 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36950 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36951
36952
36953
36954 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36955 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36956 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36957 following form is logged:
36958 .code
36959 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36960 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36961 .endd
36962 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36963 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36964 .code
36965 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36966 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36967 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36968 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36969 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36970 .endd
36971 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36972 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36973 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36974 flagged with &`**`&.
36975
36976
36977
36978 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36979 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36980 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36981 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36982 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36983
36984
36985
36986 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36987 A line of the form
36988 .code
36989 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36990 .endd
36991 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36992 at the end of its processing.
36993
36994
36995
36996
36997 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36998 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36999 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37000 the following table:
37001 .display
37002 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37003 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37004 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37005 &`CV `& certificate verification status
37006 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37007 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37008 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37009 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37010 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
37011 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37012 &`H `& host name and IP address
37013 &`I `& local interface used
37014 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37015 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37016 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37017 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37018 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37019 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37020 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37021 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37022 &`Q `& alternate queue name
37023 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37024 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37025 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37026 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37027 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37028 &`S `& size of message in bytes
37029 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37030 &`ST `& shadow transport name
37031 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37032 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37033 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37034 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37035 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
37036 .endd
37037
37038
37039 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37040 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37041 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37042
37043 .ilist
37044 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37045 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37046 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37047 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37048 during the first delivery attempt.
37049 .next
37050 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37051 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37052 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37053 .next
37054 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37055 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37056 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37057 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37058 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37059 doing.
37060 .next
37061 .cindex "error" "ignored"
37062 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37063 message:
37064 .olist
37065 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37066 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37067 .next
37068 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37069 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37070 .next
37071 A delivery set up by a router configured with
37072 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37073 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37074 .code
37075 errors_to = <>
37076 .endd
37077 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37078 .endlist olist
37079 .next
37080 .cindex DKIM "log line"
37081 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37082 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37083 .endlist ilist
37084
37085
37086
37087
37088
37089 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37090 .cindex "log" "selectors"
37091 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37092 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37093 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37094 example:
37095 .code
37096 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37097 .endd
37098 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37099 selection marked by asterisks:
37100 .display
37101 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37102 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37103 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37104 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37105 &` arguments `& command line arguments
37106 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37107 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37108 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
37109 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37110 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37111 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37112 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37113 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37114 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37115 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37116 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37117 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37118 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37119 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37120 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37121 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37122 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37123 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37124 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37125 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37126 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37127 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37128 &` pid `& Exim process id
37129 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37130 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37131 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37132 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37133 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37134 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37135 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37136 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37137 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37138 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37139 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37140 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37141 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37142 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37143 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37144 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37145 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37146 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37147 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37148 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37149 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37150 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37151 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37152 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37153 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37154
37155 &` all `& all of the above
37156 .endd
37157 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37158 section &<<SECID99>>&
37159
37160 More details on each of these items follows:
37161
37162 .ilist
37163 .cindex "8BITMIME"
37164 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37165 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37166 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37167 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37168 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37169 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37170 .next
37171 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37172 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37173 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37174 this log selector is set.
37175 .next
37176 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
37177 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37178 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37179 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37180 such users cannot access the log).
37181 .next
37182 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
37183 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37184 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37185 parentheses between them.
37186 .next
37187 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37188 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37189 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37190 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37191 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37192 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37193 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37194 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37195 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37196 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37197 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37198 between the caller and Exim.
37199 .next
37200 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37201 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37202 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37203 .next
37204 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37205 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37206 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37207 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37208 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37209 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37210 .next
37211 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37212 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37213 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37214 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37215 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37216 .next
37217 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37218 .cindex "size" "of message"
37219 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37220 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37221 .next
37222 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37223 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37224 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37225 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37226 .next
37227 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37228 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37229 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37230 .next
37231 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37232 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37233 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
37234 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37235 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37236 .next
37237 .cindex log dnssec
37238 .cindex dnssec logging
37239 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37240 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37241 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37242 It does not cover helo-name verification.
37243 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37244 .next
37245 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37246 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37247 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37248 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37249 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37250 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37251 .next
37252 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37253 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37254 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37255 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37256 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37257 .next
37258 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37259 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37260 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37261 client's ident port times out.
37262 .next
37263 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37264 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37265 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37266 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37267 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37268 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37269 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37270 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37271 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37272 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37273 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37274 .next
37275 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37276 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37277 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37278 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37279 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37280 on a proxied connection
37281 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37282 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37283 .next
37284 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37285 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
37286 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37287 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37288 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37289 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37290 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37291 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37292 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37293 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37294 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37295 .next
37296 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37297 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37298 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37299 .next
37300 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37301 .cindex millisecond logging
37302 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37303 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37304 appended to the seconds value.
37305 .next
37306 .new
37307 .cindex "log" "message id"
37308 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37309 .next
37310 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37311 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37312 (submission mode) without one.
37313 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37314 .wen
37315 .next
37316 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37317 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37318 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37319 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37320 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37321 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37322 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37323 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37324 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37325 .next
37326 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37327 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37328 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37329 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37330 containing => tags) following the IP address.
37331 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37332 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37333 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37334 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37335 local port is a random ephemeral port.
37336 .next
37337 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37338 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37339 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37340 immediately after the time and date.
37341 .next
37342 .cindex log pipelining
37343 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37344 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37345 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37346 The field is a single "L".
37347
37348 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37349 the field has a minus appended.
37350 .next
37351 .cindex "log" "queue run"
37352 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37353 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37354 .next
37355 .cindex "log" "queue time"
37356 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37357 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37358 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37359 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37360 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37361 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37362 message has been successfully received.
37363 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37364 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37365 .next
37366 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37367 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37368 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37369 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37370 .next
37371 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
37372 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37373 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37374 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37375 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37376 .next
37377 .cindex "log" "recipients"
37378 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37379 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37380 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37381 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37382 has taken place.
37383 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37384 in the list.
37385 .next
37386 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
37387 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37388 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37389 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37390 .next
37391 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37392 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37393 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37394 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37395 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37396 .next
37397 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
37398 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37399 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37400 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37401 attempt.
37402 .next
37403 .cindex "log" "return path"
37404 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37405 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37406 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37407 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37408 .next
37409 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37410 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37411 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37412 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37413 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37414 .next
37415 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37416 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37417 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37418 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37419 detail is lost.
37420 .next
37421 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
37422 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37423 it is too big.
37424 .next
37425 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37426 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37427 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37428 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37429 it.
37430 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37431 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37432 .next
37433 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37434 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37435 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37436 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37437 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37438 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37439 response.
37440 .next
37441 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37442 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37443 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37444 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37445 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37446 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37447 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37448 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37449 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37450 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37451
37452 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37453 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37454 reset if the daemon is restarted.
37455 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37456 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37457 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37458 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37459 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37460 .next
37461 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37462 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37463 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37464 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37465 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37466 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37467 .next
37468 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37469 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37470 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37471 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37472 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37473 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37474 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37475 already have their own log lines.
37476
37477 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37478 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37479 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37480 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37481 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37482 the same logging options.
37483
37484 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37485 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37486 .code
37487 C=EHLO,QUIT
37488 .endd
37489 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37490 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37491 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37492 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37493 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37494 .next
37495 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37496 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37497 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37498 was accepted or used.
37499 .next
37500 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37501 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37502 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37503 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37504 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37505 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37506 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37507 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37508 .next
37509 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37510 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37511 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37512 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37513 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37514 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37515 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37516 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37517 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37518 .next
37519 .cindex "log" "subject"
37520 .cindex "subject, logging"
37521 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37522 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37523 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37524 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37525 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37526 .next
37527 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37528 .cindex log DANE
37529 .cindex DANE logging
37530 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37531 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37532 verified
37533 using a CA trust anchor,
37534 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37535 and &`CV=no`& if not.
37536 .next
37537 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37538 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37539 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37540 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37541 .next
37542 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37543 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37544 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37545 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37546 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37547 .next
37548 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37549 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37550 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37551 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37552 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37553 .next
37554 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37555 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37556 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37557 .endlist
37558
37559
37560 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
37561 .cindex "message" "log file for"
37562 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37563 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37564 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37565 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37566 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37567 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37568 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37569 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37570 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37571 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37572 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37573
37574 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37575 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37576 &%message_logs%& option false.
37577 .ecindex IIDloggen
37578
37579
37580
37581
37582 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37583 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37584
37585 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37586 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37587 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37588 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37589 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37590
37591 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37592 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37593 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37594 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37595 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37596 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37597 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37598 various criteria"
37599 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37600 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37601 "extract statistics from the log"
37602 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37603 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37604 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37605 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37606 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37607 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37608 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37609 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37610 .endtable
37611
37612 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37613 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37614 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37615
37616
37617
37618
37619 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37620 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37621 .cindex "process, querying"
37622 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
37623 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37624 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37625 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37626 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37627 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37628 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37629 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37630 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37631
37632 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37633 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37634 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37635
37636
37637 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37638 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37639 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37640 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37641 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37642 options:
37643 .display
37644 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37645 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37646 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37647 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37648 .endd
37649 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37650 .code
37651 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
37652 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
37653 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37654 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
37655 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
37656 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37657 .endd
37658 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37659 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37660
37661
37662
37663 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37664 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37665 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
37666 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37667 .code
37668 exim -bpu
37669 .endd
37670 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37671 .code
37672 exim -bp
37673 .endd
37674 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37675 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37676
37677 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37678 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37679
37680 .vlist
37681 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37682 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37683 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37684 .code
37685 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
37686 .endd
37687 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37688 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37689 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37690
37691 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37692 Match against the size field.
37693
37694 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37695 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37696
37697 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37698 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37699
37700 .vitem &*-z*&
37701 Match only frozen messages.
37702
37703 .vitem &*-x*&
37704 Match only non-frozen messages.
37705 .endlist
37706
37707 The following options control the format of the output:
37708
37709 .vlist
37710 .vitem &*-c*&
37711 Display only the count of matching messages.
37712
37713 .vitem &*-l*&
37714 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37715 the default.
37716
37717 .vitem &*-i*&
37718 Display message ids only.
37719
37720 .vitem &*-b*&
37721 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37722
37723 .vitem &*-R*&
37724 Display messages in reverse order.
37725
37726 .vitem &*-a*&
37727 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37728 .endlist
37729
37730 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37731
37732
37733
37734 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37735 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37736 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37737 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37738 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
37739 running a command such as
37740 .code
37741 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37742 .endd
37743 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37744 it, as in the following example:
37745 .code
37746 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37747 .endd
37748 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37749 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37750 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37751 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37752
37753 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37754 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37755 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37756 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37757 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37758 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37759 sender.
37760
37761 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37762 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37763 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37764 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37765 level"& addresses).
37766
37767
37768
37769
37770 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37771 "SECTextspeinf"
37772 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37773 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37774 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37775 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37776 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37777 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37778 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37779 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37780 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37781 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37782 .display
37783 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37784 .endd
37785 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37786
37787 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37788 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37789 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
37790
37791 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37792 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37793 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37794 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37795 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37796
37797 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37798 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37799 regular expression.
37800
37801 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37802 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37803
37804 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37805 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37806 normally.
37807
37808 Example of &%-M%&:
37809 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37810 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37811 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37812 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37813 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37814 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37815 search term.
37816
37817 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37818 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37819 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37820 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37821 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37822
37823
37824 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37825 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37826 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37827 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37828 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37829 the &%--help%& option.
37830
37831
37832 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37833 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37834 .cindex "cycling logs"
37835 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37836 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37837 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37838 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37839 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37840 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37841 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37842 .ilist
37843 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37844 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37845 .next
37846 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37847 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37848 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37849 configuration.
37850 .endlist
37851
37852 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37853 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37854 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37855 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37856 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37857 logs are handled similarly.
37858
37859 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37860 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37861 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37862 any existing log files.
37863
37864 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37865 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37866 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37867 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37868 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37869 .code
37870 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37871 .endd
37872 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37873 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37874
37875
37876
37877 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37878 .cindex "statistics"
37879 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37880 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37881 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37882 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
37883 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
37884
37885 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37886 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37887 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37888 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37889 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37890 .code
37891 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37892 .endd
37893 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37894 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37895 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37896 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37897 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37898 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37899 also produced per user.
37900
37901 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37902 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37903 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37904 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37905 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37906
37907 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37908 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37909 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37910 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37911 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37912 an entirely separate message.
37913
37914 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37915 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37916 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37917 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37918 least one address that failed.
37919
37920 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37921 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37922 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37923 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
37924 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37925 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37926 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37927
37928 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37929 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37930 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37931
37932 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37933 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37934 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37935 .code
37936 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37937 .endd
37938
37939 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37940 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37941 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37942 .cindex "checking access"
37943 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37944 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37945 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37946 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37947 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37948 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37949
37950 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37951 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37952 .code
37953 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37954 .endd
37955 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37956 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37957 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37958 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37959 .code
37960 Rejected:
37961 550 Relay not permitted
37962 .endd
37963 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37964 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37965 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37966 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37967 you can use:
37968 .code
37969 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37970 -f himself@there.example
37971 .endd
37972 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37973 mandatory arguments.
37974
37975 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37976 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37977 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37978
37979
37980
37981 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37982 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37983 .cindex "building DBM files"
37984 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37985 .cindex "lower casing"
37986 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37987 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37988 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37989 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37990 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37991 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37992
37993 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37994 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37995 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37996 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37997 files.
37998
37999 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38000 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38001 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38002 well.
38003
38004 .cindex "USE_DB"
38005 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38006 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38007 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38008 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38009 .code
38010 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38011 .endd
38012 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38013 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38014
38015 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38016 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38017 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38018 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38019 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38020 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38021
38022 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38023 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38024 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38025 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38026 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38027 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38028 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38029 return code is 2.
38030
38031
38032
38033
38034 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38035 .cindex "retry" "times"
38036 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
38037 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38038 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38039 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38040 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38041 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38042 output. For example:
38043 .code
38044 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38045 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38046 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38047 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38048 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38049 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38050 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38051 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38052 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38053 past final cutoff time
38054 .endd
38055 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38056 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38057 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38058 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38059 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38060 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38061 run very often.
38062
38063 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38064 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38065 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38066 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38067 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38068 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38069
38070
38071
38072 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38073 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38074 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38075 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38076 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38077 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38078 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38079
38080 .ilist
38081 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
38082 .next
38083 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38084 for remote hosts
38085 .next
38086 &'callout'&: the callout cache
38087 .next
38088 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38089 .next
38090 &'misc'&: other hints data
38091 .endlist
38092
38093 The &'misc'& database is used for
38094
38095 .ilist
38096 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38097 .next
38098 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38099 &(smtp)& transport)
38100 .next
38101 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38102 in a transport)
38103 .endlist
38104
38105
38106
38107 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38108 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38109 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38110 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38111 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38112 .code
38113 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38114 .endd
38115 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38116 .code
38117 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
38118 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38119 .endd
38120 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38121 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38122 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38123 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38124 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38125 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38126 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38127 and a textual description of the error.
38128
38129 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38130 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38131 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38132 exceeded.
38133
38134 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38135 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38136 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38137 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38138 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38139 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38140 cross-references.
38141
38142
38143
38144 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38145 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38146 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38147 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38148 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38149 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38150 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38151 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38152 updated sufficiently often.
38153
38154 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38155 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38156 the retry database:
38157 .code
38158 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38159 .endd
38160 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38161 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38162 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38163 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38164 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38165 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38166 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38167 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38168 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38169 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38170 whenever it removes information from the database.
38171
38172 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38173 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38174 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38175 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38176 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38177
38178 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38179 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38180 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38181 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38182 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38183 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38184 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38185 tidied.
38186
38187 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38188 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38189
38190
38191
38192
38193 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38194 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38195 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38196 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38197 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38198 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38199 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38200 displayed.
38201
38202 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38203 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38204 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38205 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38206 by new data, for example:
38207 .code
38208 > 4 951102:1000
38209 .endd
38210 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38211 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38212 used as optional separators.
38213
38214
38215
38216
38217 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38218 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38219 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38220 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
38221 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38222 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38223 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38224 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38225 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38226 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38227 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38228 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38229 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38230
38231 .vlist
38232 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
38233 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38234
38235 .vitem &%-flock%&
38236 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38237 supports it.
38238
38239 .vitem &%-interval%&
38240 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38241 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38242
38243 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
38244 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38245
38246 .vitem &%-mbx%&
38247 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38248
38249 .vitem &%-q%&
38250 Suppress verification output.
38251
38252 .vitem &%-retries%&
38253 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38254 the lock (default 10).
38255
38256 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
38257 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38258 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38259 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38260 subsequently sees.
38261
38262 .vitem &%-timeout%&
38263 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38264 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38265 default), a non-blocking call is used.
38266
38267 .vitem &%-v%&
38268 Generate verbose output.
38269 .endlist
38270
38271 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38272 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38273 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38274 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38275 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38276 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38277 more than 30 minutes old.
38278
38279 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38280 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38281 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38282 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38283 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38284 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38285
38286 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38287 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38288 suppresses all output except error messages.
38289
38290 A command such as
38291 .code
38292 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38293 .endd
38294 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38295 .display
38296 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38297 <&'some commands'&>
38298 &`End`&
38299 .endd
38300 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38301 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38302 such as
38303 .code
38304 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38305 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38306 .endd
38307 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38308 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38309 .ecindex IIDutils
38310
38311
38312 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38313 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38314
38315 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38316 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38317 .cindex "X-windows"
38318 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
38319 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38320 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38321 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38322 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38323 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38324 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38325 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38326
38327
38328
38329 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38330 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38331 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38332 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38333 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38334 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38335 parameters are for.
38336
38337 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38338 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38339 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38340 .code
38341 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38342 .endd
38343 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38344 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38345 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38346 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38347 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38348
38349 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38350 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38351 .code
38352 Eximon*background: gray94
38353 .endd
38354 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38355 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38356 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38357 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38358 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38359 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38360 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38361 .code
38362 xrdb -merge <<End
38363 Eximon*highlight: gray
38364 End
38365 .endd
38366 .cindex "admin user"
38367 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38368 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38369
38370 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38371 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38372 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38373 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38374 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38375
38376 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38377 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38378 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38379 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38380 different parts of the display.
38381
38382
38383
38384
38385 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38386 .cindex "stripchart"
38387 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38388 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38389 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38390 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38391 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38392 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38393 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38394 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38395 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38396
38397 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38398 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38399 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38400 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38401
38402 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38403 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38404 to a single partition.
38405
38406 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38407 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38408 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38409 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38410 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38411 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38412 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38413
38414
38415
38416
38417 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38418 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38419 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38420 .cindex "window size"
38421 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38422 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38423 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38424 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38425 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38426 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38427
38428 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38429 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38430 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38431 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38432
38433 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38434 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38435 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38436 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38437 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38438 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38439
38440 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38441 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38442 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38443
38444
38445
38446 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
38447 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38448 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38449 the main log is maintained.
38450 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38451 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38452 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38453 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38454 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38455
38456 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38457 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38458 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38459 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38460 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38461 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38462 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38463 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38464 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38465 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38466 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38467
38468 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38469 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38470 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38471 It cannot go further back up the log.
38472
38473 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38474 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38475 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38476 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38477 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38478 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38479
38480 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38481 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38482 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38483 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38484 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38485 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38486
38487 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38488 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38489 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38490 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38491 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38492 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38493 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38494 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38495 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38496 window.
38497
38498
38499
38500 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38501 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38502 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38503 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38504 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38505 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38506 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38507 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38508 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38509 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38510
38511 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38512 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38513 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38514 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38515 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38516 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38517 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38518
38519 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38520 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38521 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38522 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38523 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38524 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38525 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38526
38527 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38528 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38529 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38530 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38531
38532 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38533 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38534 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38535 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38536 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38537 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38538 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38539 not shown.
38540
38541 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38542 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38543
38544 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38545 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38546 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38547 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38548 display is updated.
38549
38550
38551
38552 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38553 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38554 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38555 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38556 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38557 any selected text.
38558
38559 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38560 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38561 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38562 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38563 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38564 .code
38565 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38566 .endd
38567 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38568 follows:
38569
38570 .ilist
38571 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38572 in a new text window.
38573 .next
38574 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38575 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38576 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38577 .next
38578 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38579 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38580 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38581 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38582 .next
38583 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38584 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38585 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38586 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38587 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38588 .next
38589 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38590 that the message be frozen.
38591 .next
38592 .cindex "thawing messages"
38593 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
38594 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38595 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38596 that the message be thawed.
38597 .next
38598 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38599 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38600 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38601 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38602 .next
38603 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38604 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38605 message.
38606 .next
38607 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38608 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38609 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38610 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38611 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38612 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38613 which case no action is taken.
38614 .next
38615 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38616 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38617 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38618 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38619 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38620 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38621 case no action is taken.
38622 .next
38623 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38624 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38625 .next
38626 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38627 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38628 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38629 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38630 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38631 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38632 the address is qualified with that domain.
38633 .endlist
38634
38635 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38636 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38637 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38638 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38639 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38640 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38641 if no output is generated.
38642
38643 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38644 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38645 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38646 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38647
38648 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38649 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38650 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38651 .ecindex IIDeximon
38652
38653
38654
38655
38656
38657 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38658 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38659
38660 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38661 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38662 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38663 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38664
38665 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38666 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38667 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38668 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38669 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38670 its security as compared with other MTAs.
38671
38672 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38673 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38674 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38675 as soon as possible.
38676
38677
38678 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38679 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
38680 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38681 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38682 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38683 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38684
38685 .ilist
38686 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38687 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
38688 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
38689 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38690 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38691 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38692
38693 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38694 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38695 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38696 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38697 .next
38698
38699 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38700 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38701 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38702 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38703 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38704 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38705 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38706 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38707 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38708 separate commands.
38709
38710 .next
38711 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38712 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38713 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38714 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38715 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38716 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38717 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38718 .next
38719 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38720 is disabled.
38721 .next
38722 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38723 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38724 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38725 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38726 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38727 .endlist
38728
38729
38730
38731 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38732 .cindex "setuid"
38733 .cindex "root privilege"
38734 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38735 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38736 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38737 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38738 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38739 is required for two things:
38740
38741 .ilist
38742 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38743 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38744 not required.
38745 .next
38746 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38747 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38748 configuration.
38749 .endlist
38750
38751 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38752 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38753 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38754 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38755 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38756 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
38757 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38758 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38759
38760 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38761 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38762 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38763
38764 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38765 uid and gid in the following cases:
38766
38767 .ilist
38768 .oindex "&%-C%&"
38769 .oindex "&%-D%&"
38770 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38771 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38772 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38773 the calling process.
38774 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38775 option may not be used at all.
38776 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38777 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38778 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38779 .next
38780 .oindex "&%-be%&"
38781 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
38782 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
38783 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38784 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38785 calling process.
38786 .next
38787 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38788 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38789 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38790 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38791 testing address verification
38792 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
38793 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
38794 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38795 option).
38796 .next
38797 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38798 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38799 .endlist
38800
38801 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38802
38803 .ilist
38804 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38805 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38806 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38807 will be used during message reception.
38808 .next
38809 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38810 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38811 .next
38812 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38813 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38814 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38815 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38816 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38817 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38818 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38819 generating bounce and warning messages.
38820
38821 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38822 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38823 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38824 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38825 .next
38826 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38827 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38828 .endlist
38829
38830
38831
38832
38833 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38834 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38835 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38836 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38837 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38838 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38839 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38840 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38841 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38842 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38843 to any other uid.
38844
38845 .cindex SIGHUP
38846 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38847 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38848 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38849 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38850
38851 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38852 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38853 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38854 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38855 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38856
38857 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38858 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38859 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38860 effect.
38861
38862 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38863 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38864 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38865
38866 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38867 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38868 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38869 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38870 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38871 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38872 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38873 address this problem at this time.
38874
38875 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38876 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38877 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38878 be used in the most straightforward way.
38879
38880 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38881 number of restrictions on what you can do:
38882
38883 .ilist
38884 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38885 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38886 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38887 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38888 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38889 .next
38890 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38891 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38892 .next
38893 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38894 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38895 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38896 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38897 .next
38898 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38899 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38900
38901 .olist
38902 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38903 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38904 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38905 .next
38906 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38907 owned by the Exim user.
38908 .next
38909 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38910 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38911 mailboxes need to be created manually.
38912 .endlist olist
38913 .endlist ilist
38914
38915
38916 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38917 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38918 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38919 gives more security at essentially no cost.
38920
38921 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38922 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38923
38924
38925
38926
38927 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38928 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38929 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38930
38931
38932
38933 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38934 .cindex "security" "local commands"
38935 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38936 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38937 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38938 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38939 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38940
38941 .ilist
38942 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38943 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38944 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38945 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38946 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38947 .next
38948 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38949 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38950 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38951 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38952 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38953 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38954 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38955 .next
38956 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38957 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38958 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38959 .next
38960 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38961 taint checking might apply to their usage.
38962 .next
38963 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38964 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38965 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38966 .next
38967 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38968 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38969 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38970 of opaque strings.
38971 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38972 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38973 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38974 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38975 .endlist
38976
38977
38978
38979
38980 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38981 .cindex "security" "data sources"
38982 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38983 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38984 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
38985 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38986 are some issues to be aware of:
38987
38988 .ilist
38989 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38990 .next
38991 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38992 .next
38993 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38994 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38995 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38996 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38997 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38998 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38999 data.
39000 .next
39001 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39002 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39003 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39004 .next
39005 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39006 expected to yield one result.
39007 .endlist
39008
39009
39010
39011
39012 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39013 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39014 .cindex "IP source routing"
39015 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39016 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39017 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39018 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39019
39020
39021
39022 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39023 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39024 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39025
39026
39027
39028
39029 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39030 .cindex "trusted users"
39031 .cindex "admin user"
39032 .cindex "privileged user"
39033 .cindex "user" "trusted"
39034 .cindex "user" "admin"
39035 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39036 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39037 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39038 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39039 permit a remote host to be specified.
39040
39041 .oindex "&%-f%&"
39042 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39043 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39044 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39045 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39046 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39047 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39048
39049 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39050 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39051 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39052 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39053 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39054
39055 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39056 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39057 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39058 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39059 includes the contents of files on the spool.
39060
39061 .oindex "&%-M%&"
39062 .oindex "&%-q%&"
39063 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39064 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39065 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39066 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39067 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39068 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39069
39070 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39071 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39072 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39073 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39074 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39075 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39076 files.
39077
39078 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39079 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39080 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39081 This affects most of the checking options,
39082 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39083
39084
39085 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39086 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
39087 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39088 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39089 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39090 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39091
39092
39093
39094 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39095 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39096 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39097 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39098 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39099 this.
39100
39101
39102
39103 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39104 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39105 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39106 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39107 converted output.
39108
39109
39110
39111 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39112 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39113 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39114 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39115 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39116
39117
39118
39119 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39120 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39121 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39122 loading it.
39123
39124
39125 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39126 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39127 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39128 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39129 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39130 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39131 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39132
39133 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39134 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39135 string.
39136
39137
39138
39139 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39140 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39141 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39142 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39143
39144
39145
39146 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39147 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39148 enough to hold the result.
39149 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
39150
39151
39152
39153
39154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39155 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39156
39157 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39158 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39159 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39160 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39161 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
39162 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39163 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39164 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39165 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39166 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39167 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39168 themselves are recoverable.
39169
39170 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39171 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39172 and should not be used as such.
39173
39174 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39175 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39176 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39177
39178 .ilist
39179 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39180 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39181 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39182 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39183 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39184 .next
39185 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39186 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39187 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39188 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39189 .next
39190 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39191 .next
39192 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39193 signature.
39194 .endlist
39195 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39196
39197 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39198 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39199 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39200 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39201 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39202 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39203 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39204 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39205 attempt.
39206
39207 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39208 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39209 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39210 relics of crashes and can be removed.
39211
39212 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39213 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39214 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39215 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39216 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39217 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39218 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39219 normally the Exim user.
39220
39221 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39222 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39223 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39224 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39225 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39226 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39227 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39228 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39229
39230 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39231 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39232 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39233 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39234
39235 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39236 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39237
39238 .vlist
39239 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39240 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39241 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39242 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39243 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39244 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39245 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39246 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39247 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39248 newlines.
39249
39250 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39251 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39252 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39253 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39254 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39255 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39256
39257 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39258 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39259 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39260 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39261 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39262 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39263
39264 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39265 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39266 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39267
39268 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39269 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39270 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39271 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39272 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39273
39274 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39275 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39276 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39277 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39278 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39279
39280 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39281 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39282 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39283
39284 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39285 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39286 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39287
39288 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39289 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39290 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39291
39292 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39293 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39294 present if the number is greater than zero.
39295
39296 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39297 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39298 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39299
39300 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39301 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39302 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39303
39304 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39305 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39306 command.
39307
39308 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39309 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39310 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39311 messages.
39312
39313 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39314 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39315 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39316 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39317
39318 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39319 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39320 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39321
39322 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39323 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39324 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39325 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39326 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39327 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39328
39329 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39330 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39331 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39332 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39333 supplied by the remote host, if any.
39334
39335 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39336 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39337 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39338 generated messages.
39339
39340 .vitem &%-local%&
39341 The message is from a local sender.
39342
39343 .vitem &%-localerror%&
39344 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39345
39346 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39347 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39348 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39349 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39350
39351 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39352 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39353 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39354
39355 .vitem &%-N%&
39356 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39357 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39358 &%-N%& is assumed.
39359
39360 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39361 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39362 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39363
39364 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39365 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39366 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39367
39368 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39369 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39370 of &$spam_score_int$&.
39371
39372 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39373 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39374 rather than Unix-format.
39375 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39376 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39377
39378 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39379 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39380 certificate was verified by the server.
39381
39382 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39383 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39384 name of the cipher suite that was used.
39385
39386 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39387 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39388 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39389 certificate.
39390 .endlist
39391
39392 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39393 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39394 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39395 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39396 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39397 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39398 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39399 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39400 addresses are complete.
39401
39402 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39403 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39404 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39405 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39406 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39407 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39408 .code
39409 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39410 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39411 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39412 .endd
39413 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39414 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39415 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39416 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39417 example:
39418 .code
39419 4
39420 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39421 darcy@austen.fict.example
39422 rdo@foundation
39423 alice@wonderland.fict.example
39424 .endd
39425 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39426 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39427 line is of the following form:
39428 .display
39429 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39430 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39431 .endd
39432 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39433 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39434 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39435 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39436 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39437 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39438 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39439 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39440
39441
39442 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39443 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39444 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39445 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39446 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39447 following:
39448
39449 .table2 50pt
39450 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39451 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39452 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39453 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39454 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39455 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39456 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39457 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39458 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39459 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39460 .endtable
39461
39462 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39463 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39464 typical set of headers:
39465 .code
39466 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39467 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39468 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39469 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39470 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39471 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39472 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39473 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39474 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39475 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39476 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39477 .endd
39478 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39479 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39480 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39481 .ecindex IIDforspo1
39482 .ecindex IIDforspo2
39483 .ecindex IIDforspo3
39484
39485 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39486 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39487 an ASCII newline character.
39488 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39489 can have an alternate format.
39490 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39491 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39492 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39493 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39494 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39495 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39496
39497 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39498 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39499
39500 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39501 "DKIM and SPF Support"
39502 .cindex "DKIM"
39503
39504 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39505
39506 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39507 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39508 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39509 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39510
39511 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39512 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39513 any original DKIM signature.
39514
39515 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39516 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39517
39518 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39519 .olist
39520 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39521 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39522 (including transport filters)
39523 except cutthrough delivery.
39524 .next
39525 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39526 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39527 different signature contexts.
39528 .endlist
39529
39530 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39531 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39532 Exim's standard controls.
39533
39534 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39535 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39536
39537 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39538 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39539 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39540 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39541 .code
39542 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39543 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39544 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39545 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39546 .endd
39547
39548 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39549 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39550 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39551 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39552 senders).
39553
39554
39555 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39556 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39557
39558 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39559 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39560 .code
39561 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39562
39563 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39564 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39565 .endd
39566
39567 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39568 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39569 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39570 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39571 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39572
39573 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39574 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39575
39576 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39577 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39578 After expansion, this can be a list.
39579 Each element in turn,
39580 .new
39581 lowercased,
39582 .wen
39583 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39584 while expanding the remaining signing options.
39585 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39586 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39587
39588 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39589 This sets the key selector string.
39590 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39591 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39592 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39593 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39594 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39595 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39596
39597 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39598 This sets the private key to use.
39599 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39600 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39601 The result can either
39602 .ilist
39603 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39604 .next
39605 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39606 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39607 .next
39608 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39609 the private key
39610 .next
39611 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39612 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39613 is set.
39614 .endlist
39615
39616 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39617 .code
39618 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39619 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39620 .endd
39621 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39622 for the DNS TXT record.
39623 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39624
39625 Under GnuTLS:
39626 .code
39627 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39628 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39629 .endd
39630
39631 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39632 .code
39633 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39634 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39635 .endd
39636
39637 .new
39638 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
39639 .wen
39640 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39641 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39642 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39643 for some transition period.
39644 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39645 for EC keys.
39646
39647 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39648 .code
39649 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39650 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39651 .endd
39652
39653 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39654 .code
39655 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39656 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39657 .endd
39658
39659 .new
39660 Exim also supports an alternate format
39661 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
39662 of the standard, but not adopted.
39663 A future release will probably drop that support.
39664 .wen
39665
39666 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39667 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39668 .ilist
39669 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39670 .next
39671 &`sha256`& &-- the default
39672 .next
39673 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39674 .endlist
39675
39676 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39677 .code
39678 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39679 .endd
39680
39681 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39682 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39683 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39684 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39685 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39686 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39687
39688 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39689 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39690 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39691 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39692 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39693
39694 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39695 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39696 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39697 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39698 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39699 variables here.
39700
39701 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39702 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39703 list of header names.
39704 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39705 in the message signature.
39706 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39707 whether or not each header is present in the message.
39708 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39709 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39710
39711 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39712 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39713 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39714
39715 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39716 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39717 will be signed.
39718 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39719 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39720 name will be appended.
39721
39722 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
39723 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
39724 If not set, no such information will be included.
39725 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
39726 for the expiry tag
39727 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
39728 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
39729
39730 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
39731
39732
39733 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39734 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39735
39736 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
39737 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
39738 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39739 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39740 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39741
39742 The results of that verification are then made available to the
39743 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
39744 By default, this ACL is called once for each
39745 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39746 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39747 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39748 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39749 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39750
39751 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
39752 a large number of expansion variables
39753 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39754 runtime of the ACL.
39755
39756 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39757 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39758 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39759 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39760
39761 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39762 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39763 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39764 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39765 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39766 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39767 it defaults as:
39768 .code
39769 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39770 .endd
39771 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39772 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39773 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39774 .code
39775 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39776 .endd
39777 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39778 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39779 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39780 .code
39781 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39782 .endd
39783
39784 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39785 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39786
39787 .new
39788 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
39789 (such as the From: header)
39790 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
39791 and for the domain part if identities.
39792 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
39793 .wen
39794
39795 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39796 for each matching signature.
39797
39798
39799 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39800 available (from most to least important):
39801
39802
39803 .vlist
39804 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39805 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39806 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39807 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39808
39809 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39810 Within the DKIM ACL,
39811 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39812 .ilist
39813 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39814 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39815 .next
39816 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39817 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39818 .next
39819 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39820 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39821 .next
39822 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39823 .endlist
39824
39825 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39826 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39827 hash-method or key-size:
39828 .code
39829 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39830 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
39831 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39832 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
39833 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
39834 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39835 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39836 .endd
39837
39838 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
39839 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39840 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39841 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
39842
39843 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39844 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39845 "fail" or "invalid". One of
39846 .ilist
39847 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39848 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39849 .next
39850 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39851 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39852 .next
39853 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39854 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39855 means that the message body was modified in transit.
39856 .next
39857 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39858 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39859 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39860 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39861 .endlist
39862
39863 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39864
39865 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39866 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39867 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39868 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39869
39870 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39871 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39872 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39873 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39874
39875 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39876 The key record selector string.
39877
39878 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39879 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39880 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39881 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39882 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39883 for EC keys.
39884
39885 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39886 .code
39887 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39888
39889 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39890 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39891 .endd
39892
39893 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39894 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39895
39896 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39897 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39898
39899 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39900 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39901
39902 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39903 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39904 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39905 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39906 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39907 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39908
39909 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39910 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39911 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39912 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39913 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
39914 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
39915 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
39916 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
39917
39918 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39919 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39920 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39921
39922 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39923 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39924 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39925 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39926 integer size comparisons against this value.
39927 Note that Exim does not check this value.
39928
39929 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39930 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39931
39932 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39933 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39934
39935 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39936 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39937
39938 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39939 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39940 in the key record.
39941
39942 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39943 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39944 in the key record.
39945
39946 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39947 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39948
39949 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39950 Number of bits in the key.
39951
39952 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39953 .code
39954 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39955 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39956 .endd
39957
39958 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39959 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39960 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39961
39962 .endlist
39963
39964 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39965
39966 .vlist
39967 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39968 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39969 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39970 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39971 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39972
39973 .code
39974 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39975 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39976 sender_domains = gmail.com
39977 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39978 dkim_status = none
39979 .endd
39980
39981 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39982 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39983
39984 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
39985 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39986 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39987 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39988
39989 .code
39990 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39991 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39992 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39993 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39994 .endd
39995
39996 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39997 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39998 for more information of what they mean.
39999 .endlist
40000
40001
40002
40003
40004 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40005 .cindex SPF verification
40006
40007 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40008 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40009 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
40010 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https
40011
40012 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40013 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40014
40015 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40016 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40017 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40018 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40019 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40020
40021 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40022 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40023 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40024 &$authresults$& expansion item.
40025
40026
40027 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40028 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
40029 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40030 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40031 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40032 Valid strings are:
40033 .vlist
40034 .vitem &%pass%&
40035 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40036
40037 .vitem &%fail%&
40038 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40039 domain in the envelope-from address.
40040
40041 .vitem &%softfail%&
40042 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40043 is a forgery.
40044
40045 .vitem &%none%&
40046 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40047
40048 .vitem &%neutral%&
40049 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40050 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40051 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40052
40053 .vitem &%permerror%&
40054 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40055 You may deny messages when this occurs.
40056
40057 .vitem &%temperror%&
40058 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40059 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40060 .endlist
40061
40062 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40063 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40064 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40065 short-circuit fashion.
40066
40067 Example:
40068 .code
40069 deny spf = fail
40070 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40071 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40072 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40073 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
40074 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40075 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40076 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40077 ip=$sender_host_address
40078 .endd
40079
40080 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40081 variables:
40082
40083 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
40084 .vlist
40085 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40086 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40087 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40088 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40089 it for logging purposes.
40090
40091 .vitem &$spf_received$&
40092 .vindex &$spf_received$&
40093 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40094 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40095 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40096 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40097
40098 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40099 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40100
40101 .vitem &$spf_result$&
40102 .vindex &$spf_result$&
40103 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40104 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40105 temperror.
40106
40107 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40108 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40109 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40110 and required in order to obtain a result.
40111
40112 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40113 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40114 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40115 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40116 .endlist
40117
40118
40119 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40120 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40121 .cindex SPF "best guess"
40122 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40123 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40124 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40125 capability.
40126 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40127 for a description of what it means.
40128 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https:
40129
40130 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40131 of the spf one. For example:
40132
40133 .code
40134 deny spf_guess = fail
40135 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40136 .endd
40137
40138 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40139 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40140 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40141 reject message.
40142
40143 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40144 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40145
40146 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40147 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40148 &%spf_guess%& option.
40149 For example, the following:
40150
40151 .code
40152 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40153 .endd
40154
40155 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40156
40157
40158 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40159 .cindex lookup spf
40160 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40161 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
40162
40163 .code
40164 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40165 .endd
40166
40167 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40168 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40169 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
40170
40171
40172
40173
40174 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40175 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40176
40177 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40178 "Proxy support"
40179 .cindex "proxy support"
40180 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
40181
40182 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40183 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40184
40185
40186 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40187 .cindex proxy inbound
40188 .cindex proxy "server side"
40189 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40190 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40191
40192 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40193 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40194 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40195 in Local/Makefile.
40196
40197 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40198 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40199
40200 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40201 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40202 to distribute load.
40203 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40204 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40205 There is no logging if a host passes or
40206 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40207 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40208
40209 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40210 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40211 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40212 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40213 automatically determines which version is in use.
40214
40215 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40216 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40217 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40218 Exim and the proxy server.
40219
40220 The following expansion variables are usable
40221 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40222 of the proxy):
40223 .display
40224 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40225 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40226 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40227 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40228 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40229 .endd
40230 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40231 there was a protocol error.
40232 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40233 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40234
40235 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40236 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40237 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40238 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40239 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40240 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40241 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40242 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40243 A possible solution is:
40244 .display
40245 # Set max number of connections per host
40246 LIMIT = 5
40247 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40248 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40249
40250 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40251 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40252 .endd
40253
40254
40255
40256 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40257 .cindex proxy outbound
40258 .cindex proxy "client side"
40259 .cindex proxy SOCKS
40260 .cindex SOCKS proxy
40261 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40262 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40263 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40264 Local/Makefile.
40265
40266 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40267 on an smtp transport.
40268 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40269 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40270 Each proxy specifier is a list
40271 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
40272 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40273
40274 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40275 The list of options is in the following table:
40276 .display
40277 &'auth '& authentication method
40278 &'name '& authentication username
40279 &'pass '& authentication password
40280 &'port '& tcp port
40281 &'tmo '& connection timeout
40282 &'pri '& priority
40283 &'weight '& selection bias
40284 .endd
40285
40286 More details on each of these options follows:
40287
40288 .ilist
40289 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
40290 .cindex proxy authentication
40291 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40292 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40293 for access to the proxy.
40294 Default is &"none"&.
40295 .next
40296 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40297 Default is empty.
40298 .next
40299 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40300 Default is empty.
40301 .next
40302 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40303 Default is 1080.
40304 .next
40305 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40306 Default is 5.
40307 .next
40308 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40309 higher values being tried first.
40310 The default priority is 1.
40311 .next
40312 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40313 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40314 weighted by this value.
40315 The default value for selection bias is 1.
40316 .endlist
40317
40318 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40319 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40320 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40321
40322 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
40323 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40324 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40325 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40326
40327 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40328 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40329
40330 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40331 "Internationalisation""
40332 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
40333 .cindex EAI
40334 .cindex i18n
40335 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40336
40337 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
40338 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
40339 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
40340
40341 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
40342 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
40343 requirement, upon libidn2.
40344
40345 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
40346 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
40347 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
40348 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
40349 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
40350 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
40351
40352 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
40353 international handling for the message is enabled and
40354 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
40355
40356 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
40357 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
40358 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
40359 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
40360
40361 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
40362 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
40363 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
40364 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
40365
40366 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
40367 components expanded to a-label form,
40368 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
40369 form of the name.
40370
40371 .cindex log protocol
40372 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
40373 .cindex i18n logging
40374 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
40375 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
40376
40377 The following expansion operators can be used:
40378 .code
40379 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
40380 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
40381 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
40382 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
40383 .endd
40384
40385 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
40386 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
40387 The RCPT ACL
40388 may use the following modifier:
40389 .display
40390 control = utf8_downconvert
40391 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
40392 .endd
40393 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
40394 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
40395 Message Submission Agent context.
40396 If a value is appended it may be:
40397 .display
40398 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
40399 &`0 `& no downconversion
40400 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
40401 .endd
40402
40403 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
40404 is initially set to -1.
40405
40406 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
40407 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
40408 and it overrides any previously set value.
40409
40410
40411 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
40412 Configurations supporting these should inspect
40413 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
40414
40415 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
40416 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
40417 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
40418
40419 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
40420 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
40421
40422
40423
40424 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
40425 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
40426 the following expansion operator can be used:
40427 .code
40428 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
40429 .endd
40430
40431 The string is converted from the charset specified by
40432 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
40433 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
40434 to the
40435 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
40436 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
40437 (which has to be a single character)
40438 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
40439 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
40440
40441 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
40442 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
40443
40444 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
40445 by many other IMAP servers.
40446
40447 Examples:
40448 .display
40449 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
40450 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
40451 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
40452 .endd
40453
40454 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
40455 must be representable in UTF-16.
40456
40457
40458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40459 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40460
40461 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
40462 "Events"
40463 .cindex events
40464
40465 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
40466 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
40467 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
40468 processing actions.
40469
40470 Most installations will never need to use Events.
40471 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
40472 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40473
40474 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
40475 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
40476 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
40477
40478 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
40479 An example might look like:
40480 .cindex logging custom
40481 .code
40482 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
40483 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
40484 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
40485 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
40486 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
40487 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
40488 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
40489 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
40490 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
40491 } {}}
40492 .endd
40493
40494 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
40495 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
40496 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
40497
40498 The current list of events is:
40499 .display
40500 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
40501 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
40502 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40503 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
40504 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
40505 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
40506 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40507 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
40508 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
40509 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
40510 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
40511 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
40512 .endd
40513 New event types may be added in future.
40514
40515 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
40516 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
40517 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
40518
40519 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
40520 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
40521 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
40522
40523 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
40524 should define the event action.
40525
40526 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
40527 with the event type:
40528 .display
40529 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
40530 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
40531 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
40532 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
40533 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
40534 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
40535 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
40536 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
40537 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
40538 .endd
40539
40540 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
40541
40542 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
40543 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
40544 the course of its processing:
40545 .ilist
40546 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
40547 transport call
40548 .next
40549 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
40550 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
40551 .endlist
40552 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
40553 a useful way of writing to the main log.
40554
40555 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
40556 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
40557 following will be forced:
40558 .display
40559 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
40560 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
40561 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
40562 .endd
40563 All other message types ignore the result string, and
40564 no other use is made of it.
40565
40566 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
40567 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
40568 the target system.
40569
40570 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
40571 chain element received on the connection.
40572 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
40573 loaded locally.
40574
40575 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40576 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40577
40578 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
40579 "Adding drivers or lookups"
40580 .cindex "adding drivers"
40581 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
40582 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
40583 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
40584 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
40585
40586 .olist
40587 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
40588 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
40589 .next
40590 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
40591 .display
40592 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
40593 .endd
40594 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
40595 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
40596 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
40597 .next
40598 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
40599 .code
40600 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
40601 .endd
40602 .next
40603 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
40604 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
40605 .next
40606 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
40607 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
40608 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
40609 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
40610 simple form that most lookups have.
40611 .next
40612 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
40613 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
40614 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
40615 .next
40616 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
40617 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
40618 .next
40619 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
40620 &_src_&.
40621 .next
40622 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
40623 as for other drivers and lookups.
40624 .endlist
40625
40626 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
40627 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
40628 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
40629 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
40630 searched using a binary chop procedure.
40631
40632 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
40633 the interface that is expected.
40634
40635
40636
40637
40638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40640
40641 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40642 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
40643 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
40644 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
40645 . processors.
40646 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40647
40648 .literal xml
40649 <?sdop
40650 format="newpage"
40651 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
40652 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
40653 ?>
40654 .literal off
40655
40656 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
40657 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
40658 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
40659
40660
40661 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40662 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////